4 @setfilename ../../info/org
5 @settitle The Org Manual
10 @c Use proper quote and backtick for code sections in PDF output
11 @c Cf. Texinfo manual 14.2
12 @set txicodequoteundirected
13 @set txicodequotebacktick
15 @c Version and Contact Info
16 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
17 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
19 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
20 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
25 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
27 @c Macro definitions for commands and keys
28 @c =======================================
30 @c The behavior of the key/command macros will depend on the flag cmdnames
31 @c When set, commands names are shown. When clear, they are not shown.
35 @c Below we define the following macros for Org key tables:
37 @c orgkey{key} A key item
38 @c orgcmd{key,cmd} Key with command name
39 @c xorgcmd{key,cmmand} Key with command name as @itemx
40 @c orgcmdnki{key,cmd} Like orgcmd, but do not index the key
41 @c orgcmdtkc{text,key,cmd} Like orgcmd,special text instead of key
42 @c orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, use "or"
43 @c orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,cmd} Two keys with one command name, but
44 @c different functions, so format as @itemx
45 @c orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as orgcmdkkc, but use "or short"
46 @c xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,cmd} Same as previous, but use @itemx
47 @c orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,cmd1,cmd2} Two keys and two commands
49 @c a key but no command
61 @c one key with a command
62 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
63 @macro orgcmd{key,command}
68 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
71 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
80 @c One key with one command, formatted using @itemx
81 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY COMMAND
82 @macro xorgcmd{key,command}
87 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
90 @itemx @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
99 @c one key with a command, bit do not index the key
100 @c Inserts: @item KEY COMMAND
101 @macro orgcmdnki{key,command}
105 @item @kbd{\key\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
108 @item @kbd{\key\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
116 @c one key with a command, and special text to replace key in item
117 @c Inserts: @item TEXT COMMAND
118 @macro orgcmdtkc{text,key,command}
123 @item @kbd{\text\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
126 @item @kbd{\text\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
135 @c two keys with one command
136 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or KEY2 COMMAND
137 @macro orgcmdkkc{key1,key2,command}
143 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
146 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
152 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or} @ @kbd{\key2\}
156 @c Two keys with one command name, but different functions, so format as
158 @c Inserts: @item KEY1
159 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND
160 @macro orgcmdkxkc{key1,key2,command}
167 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
171 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
182 @c Same as previous, but use "or short"
183 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
184 @macro orgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
190 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
193 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
199 @item @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
203 @c Same as previous, but use @itemx
204 @c Inserts: @itemx KEY1 or short KEY2 COMMAND
205 @macro xorgcmdkskc{key1,key2,command}
211 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command\}
214 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command\})
220 @itemx @kbd{\key1\} @ @r{or short} @ @kbd{\key2\}
224 @c two keys with two commands
225 @c Inserts: @item KEY1 COMMAND1
226 @c @itemx KEY2 COMMAND2
227 @macro orgcmdkkcc{key1,key2,command1,command2}
234 @item @kbd{\key1\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command1\}
235 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @hskip 0pt plus 1filll @code{\command2\}
238 @item @kbd{\key1\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command1\})
239 @itemx @kbd{\key2\} @tie{}@tie{}@tie{}@tie{}(@code{\command2\})
249 @c -----------------------------------------------------------------------------
252 @c @hyphenation{time-stamp time-stamps time-stamp-ing time-stamp-ed}
255 @c Subheadings inside a table.
256 @macro tsubheading{text}
258 @subsubheading \text\
266 This manual is for Org version @value{VERSION}.
268 Copyright @copyright{} 2004-2011 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
271 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
272 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
273 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
274 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
275 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
276 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
278 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
279 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
280 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
282 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
283 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
284 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
285 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
291 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
295 @title The Org Manual
297 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
298 @author by Carsten Dominik
299 with contributions by David O'Toole, Bastien Guerry, Philip Rooke, Dan Davison, Eric Schulte, and Thomas Dye
301 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
303 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
307 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
311 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
318 * Introduction:: Getting started
319 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
320 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
321 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
322 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
323 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
324 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
325 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
326 * Capture - Refile - Archive:: The ins and outs for projects
327 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
328 * Markup:: Prepare text for rich export
329 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
330 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
331 * Working With Source Code:: Export, evaluate, and tangle code blocks
332 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
333 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
334 * MobileOrg:: Viewing and capture on a mobile device
335 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
336 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
337 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
338 * Command and Function Index:: Command names and some internal functions
339 * Variable Index:: Variables mentioned in the manual
342 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
346 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
347 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
348 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
349 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
350 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
354 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
355 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
356 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
357 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
358 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
359 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
360 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
361 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
362 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
363 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
364 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
368 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
369 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
370 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
371 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
372 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
373 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
377 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
378 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
379 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
380 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
381 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
382 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
383 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
384 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
385 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
389 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
390 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
391 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
392 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
393 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
394 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
395 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
396 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
400 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
404 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
405 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
406 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
407 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
408 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
409 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
411 Extended use of TODO keywords
413 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
414 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
415 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
416 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
417 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
418 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
419 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
423 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
424 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
425 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
429 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
430 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
431 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
433 Properties and columns
435 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
436 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
437 * Property searches:: Matching property values
438 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
439 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
440 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
444 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
445 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
446 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
450 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
451 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
455 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
456 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
457 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
458 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
459 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
460 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
461 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
465 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
466 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
468 Deadlines and scheduling
470 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
471 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
475 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
476 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
477 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
479 Capture - Refile - Archive
481 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
482 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
483 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
484 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
485 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
486 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
490 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
491 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
492 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
496 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
497 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
501 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
502 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
506 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
507 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
508 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
509 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
510 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
511 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
512 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
513 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
515 The built-in agenda views
517 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
518 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
519 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
520 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
521 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
522 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
524 Presentation and sorting
526 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
527 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
528 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
532 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
533 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
534 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
536 Markup for rich export
538 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
539 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
540 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
541 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
542 * Index entries:: Making an index
543 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
544 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
546 Structural markup elements
548 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
549 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
550 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
551 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
553 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
554 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
555 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
556 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
557 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
561 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
562 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
563 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
564 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
565 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
569 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
570 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
571 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
572 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
573 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
574 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
575 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
576 * OpenDocumentText export:: Exporting to OpenDocumentText
577 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
578 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
579 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
580 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
584 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
585 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
586 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
587 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
588 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
589 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
590 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
591 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
592 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
593 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
595 @LaTeX{} and PDF export
597 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
598 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
599 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
600 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
601 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
602 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
606 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
607 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
608 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
609 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
610 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
611 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
615 * OpenDocumentText export commands:: How to invoke OpenDocumentText export
616 * Applying Custom Styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
617 * Converting to Other formats:: How to convert to formats like doc, docx etc
618 * Links in OpenDocumentText export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
619 * Tables in OpenDocumentText export:: How Tables are handled
620 * Images in OpenDocumentText export:: How to insert figures
621 * Additional Documentation:: How to handle special characters
625 * Configuration:: Defining projects
626 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
627 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
628 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
632 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
633 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
634 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
635 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
636 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
637 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
638 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
639 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
643 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
644 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
646 Working with source code
648 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
649 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
650 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
651 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
652 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
653 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
654 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
655 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
656 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
657 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
658 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
659 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
663 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
664 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
666 Using header arguments
668 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
669 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
670 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
671 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
672 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
673 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
675 Specific header arguments
677 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
678 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
679 be collected and handled
680 * file:: Specify a path for file output
681 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
682 directory for code block execution
683 * exports:: Export code and/or results
684 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
685 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
686 files during tangling
687 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
689 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
691 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
692 expansion during tangling
693 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
694 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
695 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
696 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
697 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
698 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
699 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
700 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
701 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
702 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
706 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
707 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
708 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
709 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
710 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
711 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
712 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
713 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
714 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
715 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
716 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
718 Interaction with other packages
720 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
721 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
725 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
726 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
727 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
728 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
729 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
730 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
731 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
732 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
733 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
734 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
736 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
738 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
739 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
740 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
741 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
745 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
746 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
747 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
752 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
753 @chapter Introduction
757 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
758 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
759 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
760 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
761 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
764 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
768 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
769 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
771 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
772 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
773 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
774 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
775 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
776 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
777 timestamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
778 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
779 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
780 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
781 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
782 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
783 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
786 As a project planning environment, Org works by adding metadata to outline
787 nodes. Based on this data, specific entries can be extracted in queries and
788 create dynamic @i{agenda views}.
790 Org mode contains the Org Babel environment which allows you to work with
791 embedded source code blocks in a file, to facilitate code evaluation,
792 documentation, and literate programming techniques.
794 Org's automatic, context-sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
795 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
796 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
797 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in @LaTeX{}. The structure
798 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
799 the minor Orgstruct mode.
801 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
802 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
803 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
804 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways and for different
808 @r{@bullet{} an outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
809 @r{@bullet{} an ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
810 @r{@bullet{} a TODO list editor}
811 @r{@bullet{} a full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
812 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
813 @r{@bullet{} an environment in which to implement David Allen's GTD system}
814 @r{@bullet{} a simple hypertext system, with HTML and @LaTeX{} export}
815 @r{@bullet{} a publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
816 @r{@bullet{} an environment for literate programming}
821 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
822 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
823 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials, etc@. This page is located at
824 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
826 @cindex print edition
827 The version 7.3 of this manual is available as a
828 @uref{http://www.network-theory.co.uk/org/manual/, paperback book from Network
834 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
835 @section Installation
839 @b{Important:} @i{If you are using a version of Org that is part of the Emacs
840 distribution or an XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly
841 to @ref{Activation}. To see what version of Org (if any) is part of your
842 Emacs distribution, type @kbd{M-x load-library RET org} and then @kbd{M-x
845 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
846 or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, you must take the following steps
847 to install it: go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
848 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
849 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
850 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
851 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
852 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
853 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
856 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
860 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
861 step for this directory:
864 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
867 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
873 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
874 all. If you want to install Org into the system directories, use (as
881 Installing Info files is system dependent, because of differences in the
882 @file{install-info} program. The following should correctly install the Info
883 files on most systems, please send a bug report if not@footnote{The output
884 from install-info (if any) is also system dependent. In particular Debian
885 and its derivatives use two different versions of install-info and you may
889 This is not dpkg install-info anymore, but GNU install-info
890 See the man page for ginstall-info for command line arguments
893 @noindent which can be safely ignored.}.
899 Then add the following line to @file{.emacs}. It is needed so that
900 Emacs can autoload functions that are located in files not immediately loaded
901 when Org-mode starts.
903 (require 'org-install)
906 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
909 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
913 @cindex global key bindings
914 @cindex key bindings, global
916 To make sure files with extension @file{.org} use Org mode, add the following
917 line to your @file{.emacs} file.
919 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
921 @noindent Org mode buffers need font-lock to be turned on - this is the
922 default in Emacs@footnote{If you don't use font-lock globally, turn it on in
923 Org buffer with @code{(add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock)}}.
925 The four Org commands @command{org-store-link}, @command{org-capture},
926 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} should be accessible through
927 global keys (i.e.@: anywhere in Emacs, not just in Org buffers). Here are
928 suggested bindings for these keys, please modify the keys to your own
931 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
932 (global-set-key "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
933 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
934 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
937 @cindex Org-mode, turning on
938 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
939 into Org-mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
943 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
946 @vindex org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file
947 @noindent which will select Org-mode for this buffer no matter what
948 the file's name is. See also the variable
949 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
951 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is @i{active}. To make
952 use of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode}
953 (@code{zmacs-regions} in XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default,
954 in Emacs 22 you need to do this yourself with
956 (transient-mark-mode 1)
958 @noindent If you do not like @code{transient-mark-mode}, you can create an
959 active region by using the mouse to select a region, or pressing
960 @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} twice before moving the cursor.
962 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
969 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
970 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
971 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be passed to the
972 list after a moderator has approved it@footnote{Please consider subscribing
973 to the mailing list, in order to minimize the work the mailing list
974 moderators have to do.}.
976 For bug reports, please first try to reproduce the bug with the latest
977 version of Org available---if you are running an outdated version, it is
978 quite possible that the bug has been fixed already. If the bug persists,
979 prepare a report and provide as much information as possible, including the
980 version information of Emacs (@kbd{M-x emacs-version @key{RET}}) and Org
981 (@kbd{M-x org-version @key{RET}}), as well as the Org related setup in
982 @file{.emacs}. The easiest way to do this is to use the command
984 @kbd{M-x org-submit-bug-report}
986 @noindent which will put all this information into an Emacs mail buffer so
987 that you only need to add your description. If you re not sending the Email
988 from within Emacs, please copy and paste the content into your Email program.
990 If an error occurs, a backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to
991 create one). Often a small example file helps, along with clear information
995 @item What exactly did you do?
996 @item What did you expect to happen?
997 @item What happened instead?
999 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this program.
1001 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
1003 @cindex backtrace of an error
1004 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
1005 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
1006 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{backtrace}.
1007 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
1008 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
1012 Reload uncompiled versions of all Org-mode Lisp files. The backtrace
1013 contains much more information if it is produced with uncompiled code.
1016 C-u M-x org-reload RET
1019 or select @code{Org -> Refresh/Reload -> Reload Org uncompiled} from the
1022 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
1023 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
1025 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
1026 document the steps you take.
1028 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
1029 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
1030 attach it to your bug report.
1033 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
1034 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
1036 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
1037 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
1042 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
1046 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
1047 meaning are written with all capitals.
1050 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
1051 special meaning are written with all capitals.
1054 The manual lists both the keys and the corresponding commands for accessing
1055 functionality. Org mode often uses the same key for different functions,
1056 depending on context. The command that is bound to such keys has a generic
1057 name, like @code{org-metaright}. In the manual we will, wherever possible,
1058 give the function that is internally called by the generic command. For
1059 example, in the chapter on document structure, @kbd{M-@key{right}} will be
1060 listed to call @code{org-do-demote}, while in the chapter on tables, it will
1061 be listed to call org-table-move-column-right.
1063 If you prefer, you can compile the manual without the command names by
1064 unsetting the flag @code{cmdnames} in @file{org.texi}.
1066 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
1067 @chapter Document structure
1068 @cindex document structure
1069 @cindex structure of document
1071 Org is based on Outline mode and provides flexible commands to
1072 edit the structure of the document.
1075 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
1076 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
1077 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
1078 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
1079 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
1080 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
1081 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
1082 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
1083 * Blocks:: Folding blocks
1084 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
1085 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
1088 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
1091 @cindex Outline mode
1093 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
1094 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
1095 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
1096 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
1097 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
1098 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
1099 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
1100 command, @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
1102 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
1105 @cindex outline tree
1106 @vindex org-special-ctrl-a/e
1107 @vindex org-special-ctrl-k
1108 @vindex org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree
1110 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in Org
1111 start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See the variables
1112 @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e}, @code{org-special-ctrl-k}, and
1113 @code{org-ctrl-k-protect-subtree} to configure special behavior of @kbd{C-a},
1114 @kbd{C-e}, and @kbd{C-k} in headlines.}. For example:
1117 * Top level headline
1124 * Another top level headline
1127 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
1128 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
1129 starters. @ref{Clean view}, describes a setup to realize this.
1131 @vindex org-cycle-separator-lines
1132 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
1133 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
1134 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
1135 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
1136 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
1138 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
1139 @section Visibility cycling
1140 @cindex cycling, visibility
1141 @cindex visibility cycling
1142 @cindex trees, visibility
1143 @cindex show hidden text
1146 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
1147 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
1148 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
1150 @cindex subtree visibility states
1151 @cindex subtree cycling
1152 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
1153 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
1154 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
1156 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1157 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
1160 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
1161 '-----------------------------------'
1164 @vindex org-cycle-emulate-tab
1165 @vindex org-cycle-global-at-bob
1166 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
1167 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
1168 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
1169 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
1170 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
1171 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
1173 @cindex global visibility states
1174 @cindex global cycling
1175 @cindex overview, global visibility state
1176 @cindex contents, global visibility state
1177 @cindex show all, global visibility state
1178 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-global-cycle}
1179 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
1180 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
1183 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
1184 '--------------------------------------'
1187 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
1188 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
1189 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
1191 @cindex show all, command
1192 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB},show-all}
1193 Show all, including drawers.
1194 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-reveal}
1195 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
1196 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
1197 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
1198 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
1199 level, all sibling headings. With double prefix arg, also show the entire
1200 subtree of the parent.
1201 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,show-branches}
1202 Expose all the headings of the subtree, CONTENT view for just one subtree.
1203 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
1204 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
1207 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
1210 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
1212 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
1213 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
1214 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
1215 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
1216 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
1217 the previously used indirect buffer.
1218 @orgcmd{C-c C-x v,org-copy-visible}
1219 Copy the @i{visible} text in the region into the kill ring.
1222 @vindex org-startup-folded
1223 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
1224 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
1225 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
1226 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
1228 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
1229 OVERVIEW, i.e.@: only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
1230 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
1231 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
1238 #+STARTUP: showeverything
1241 @cindex property, VISIBILITY
1243 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
1244 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
1245 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
1248 @orgcmd{C-u C-u @key{TAB},org-set-startup-visibility}
1249 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e.@: whatever is
1250 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
1254 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
1256 @cindex motion, between headlines
1257 @cindex jumping, to headlines
1258 @cindex headline navigation
1259 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
1262 @orgcmd{C-c C-n,outline-next-visible-heading}
1264 @orgcmd{C-c C-p,outline-previous-visible-heading}
1266 @orgcmd{C-c C-f,org-forward-same-level}
1267 Next heading same level.
1268 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-backward-same-level}
1269 Previous heading same level.
1270 @orgcmd{C-c C-u,outline-up-heading}
1271 Backward to higher level heading.
1272 @orgcmd{C-c C-j,org-goto}
1273 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
1274 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
1275 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
1276 @vindex org-goto-auto-isearch
1278 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
1279 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1280 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
1281 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
1282 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
1283 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
1284 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
1286 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
1289 @vindex org-goto-interface
1291 See also the variable @code{org-goto-interface}.
1294 @node Structure editing, Sparse trees, Motion, Document Structure
1295 @section Structure editing
1296 @cindex structure editing
1297 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
1298 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
1299 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
1300 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
1301 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
1302 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
1303 @cindex copying, of subtrees
1304 @cindex sorting, of subtrees
1305 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
1308 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1309 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1310 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a plain
1311 list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force creation of
1312 a new headline, use a prefix argument. When this command is used in the
1313 middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes the new
1314 headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the
1315 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the command is used at the
1316 beginning of a headline, the new headline is created before the current line.
1317 If at the beginning of any other line, the content of that line is made the
1318 new heading. If the command is used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e.@:
1319 behind the ellipses at the end of a headline), then a headline like the
1320 current one will be inserted after the end of the subtree.
1321 @orgcmd{C-@key{RET},org-insert-heading-respect-content}
1322 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
1323 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
1324 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
1325 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
1326 @vindex org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change
1327 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. See also the
1328 variable @code{org-treat-insert-todo-heading-as-state-change}.
1329 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading-respect-content}
1330 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
1331 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
1333 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1334 In a new entry with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the entry to
1335 become a child of the previous one. The next @key{TAB} makes it a parent,
1336 and so on, all the way to top level. Yet another @key{TAB}, and you are back
1337 to the initial level.
1338 @orgcmd{M-@key{left},org-do-promote}
1339 Promote current heading by one level.
1340 @orgcmd{M-@key{right},org-do-demote}
1341 Demote current heading by one level.
1342 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-promote-subtree}
1343 Promote the current subtree by one level.
1344 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-demote-subtree}
1345 Demote the current subtree by one level.
1346 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-move-subtree-up}
1347 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
1349 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-move-subtree-down}
1350 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
1351 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-cut-subtree}
1352 Kill subtree, i.e.@: remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
1353 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
1354 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-copy-subtree}
1355 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
1356 sequential subtrees.
1357 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-paste-subtree}
1358 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
1359 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
1360 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
1361 headline marker like @samp{****}.
1362 @orgcmd{C-y,org-yank}
1363 @vindex org-yank-adjusted-subtrees
1364 @vindex org-yank-folded-subtrees
1365 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
1366 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
1367 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
1368 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, no level adjustment will take place,
1369 but the yanked tree will be folded unless doing so would swallow text
1370 previously visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal
1371 @code{yank} to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to
1372 force a normal yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a
1373 yank, it will yank previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and
1375 @orgcmd{C-c C-x c,org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}
1376 Clone a subtree by making a number of sibling copies of it. You will be
1377 prompted for the number of copies to make, and you can also specify if any
1378 timestamps in the entry should be shifted. This can be useful, for example,
1379 to create a number of tasks related to a series of lectures to prepare. For
1380 more details, see the docstring of the command
1381 @code{org-clone-subtree-with-time-shift}.
1382 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
1383 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
1384 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-sort-entries-or-items}
1385 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
1386 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
1387 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
1388 alphabetically, numerically, by time (first timestamp with active preferred,
1389 creation time, scheduled time, deadline time), by priority, by TODO keyword
1390 (in the sequence the keywords have been defined in the setup) or by the value
1391 of a property. Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can also supply
1392 your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix,
1393 sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes, duplicate
1394 entries will also be removed.
1395 @orgcmd{C-x n s,org-narrow-to-subtree}
1396 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
1397 @orgcmd{C-x n b,org-narrow-to-block}
1398 Narrow buffer to current block.
1399 @orgcmd{C-x n w,widen}
1400 Widen buffer to remove narrowing.
1401 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-toggle-heading}
1402 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1403 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1404 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1405 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1406 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1407 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1410 @cindex region, active
1411 @cindex active region
1412 @cindex transient mark mode
1413 When there is an active region (Transient Mark mode), promotion and
1414 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1415 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1416 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1417 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1418 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1422 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Structure editing, Document Structure
1423 @section Sparse trees
1424 @cindex sparse trees
1425 @cindex trees, sparse
1426 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1427 @cindex occur, command
1429 @vindex org-show-hierarchy-above
1430 @vindex org-show-following-heading
1431 @vindex org-show-siblings
1432 @vindex org-show-entry-below
1433 An important feature of Org-mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1434 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1435 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1436 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1437 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1438 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1439 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1440 and you will see immediately how it works.
1442 Org-mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1443 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1446 @orgcmd{C-c /,org-sparse-tree}
1447 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1448 @orgcmd{C-c / r,org-occur}
1449 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
1450 Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1451 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1452 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1453 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1454 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1455 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1456 editing command@footnote{This depends on the option
1457 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1458 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1459 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1460 @orgcmdkkc{M-g n,M-g M-n,next-error}
1461 Jump to the next sparse tree match in this buffer.
1462 @orgcmdkkc{M-g p,M-g M-p,previous-error}
1463 Jump to the previous sparse tree match in this buffer.
1468 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
1469 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1470 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1471 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1472 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1476 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1477 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1480 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1481 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1483 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1484 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1487 @cindex printing sparse trees
1488 @cindex visible text, printing
1489 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1490 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1491 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1492 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1493 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1494 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1496 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1497 @section Plain lists
1499 @cindex lists, plain
1500 @cindex lists, ordered
1501 @cindex ordered lists
1503 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1504 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of checkboxes
1505 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists, and every exporter
1506 (@pxref{Exporting}) can parse and format them.
1508 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1511 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1512 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1513 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1514 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star may
1515 be hard to distinguish from true headlines. In short: even though @samp{*}
1516 is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.} as
1519 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1520 @vindex org-alphabetical-lists
1521 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1522 a right parenthesis@footnote{You can filter out any of them by configuring
1523 @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}.}, such as @samp{1.} or
1524 @samp{1)}@footnote{You can also get @samp{a.}, @samp{A.}, @samp{a)} and
1525 @samp{A)} by configuring @code{org-alphabetical-lists}. To minimize
1526 confusion with normal text, those are limited to one character only. Beyond
1527 that limit, bullets will automatically fallback to numbers.}. If you want a
1528 list to start with a different value (e.g.@: 20), start the text of the item
1529 with @code{[@@20]}@footnote{If there's a checkbox in the item, the cookie
1530 must be put @emph{before} the checkbox. If you have activated alphabetical
1531 lists, you can also use counters like @code{[@@b]}.}. Those constructs can
1532 be used in any item of the list in order to enforce a particular numbering.
1534 @emph{Description} list items are unordered list items, and contain the
1535 separator @samp{ :: } to distinguish the description @emph{term} from the
1539 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1540 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1541 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1542 list. An item ends before the next line that is less or equally indented
1543 than its bullet/number.
1545 @vindex org-list-ending-method
1546 @vindex org-list-end-regexp
1547 @vindex org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists
1548 Two methods@footnote{To disable either of them, configure
1549 @code{org-list-ending-method}.} are provided to terminate lists. A list ends
1550 whenever every item has ended, which means before any line less or equally
1551 indented than items at top level. It also ends before two blank
1552 lines@footnote{See also @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.}. In
1553 that case, all items are closed. For finer control, you can end lists with
1554 any pattern set in @code{org-list-end-regexp}. Here is an example:
1558 ** Lord of the Rings
1559 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1560 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1561 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1562 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1563 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1564 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1566 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1567 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1568 Important actors in this film are:
1569 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1570 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1571 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in @i{The Goonies}.
1575 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to deal with
1576 them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling settings for Emacs. For
1577 XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones' @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on,
1578 put into @file{.emacs}: @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them
1579 properly (@pxref{Exporting}). Since indentation is what governs the
1580 structure of these lists, many structural constructs like @code{#+BEGIN_...}
1581 blocks can be indented to signal that they belong to a particular item.
1583 @vindex org-list-demote-modify-bullet
1584 @vindex org-list-indent-offset
1585 If you find that using a different bullet for a sub-list (than that used for
1586 the current list-level) improves readability, customize the variable
1587 @code{org-list-demote-modify-bullet}. To get a greater difference of
1588 indentation between items and theirs sub-items, customize
1589 @code{org-list-indent-offset}.
1591 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1592 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line of
1593 an item (the line with the bullet or number). Some of them imply the
1594 application of automatic rules to keep list structure intact. If some of
1595 these actions get in your way, configure @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
1596 to disable them individually.
1599 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1600 @vindex org-cycle-include-plain-lists
1601 Items can be folded just like headline levels. Normally this works only if
1602 the cursor is on a plain list item. For more details, see the variable
1603 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. If this variable is set to
1604 @code{integrate}, plain list items will be treated like low-level
1605 headlines. The level of an item is then given by the
1606 indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always subordinate to real
1607 headlines, however; the hierarchies remain completely separated.
1608 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
1609 @vindex org-M-RET-may-split-line
1610 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1611 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1612 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1613 of an item, that item is @emph{split} in two, and the second part becomes the
1614 new item@footnote{If you do not want the item to be split, customize the
1615 variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed
1616 @emph{before item's body}, the new item is created @emph{before} the current
1618 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1620 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1621 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-cycle}
1622 In a new item with no text yet, the first @key{TAB} demotes the item to
1623 become a child of the previous one. Subsequent @key{TAB}s move the item to
1624 meaningful levels in the list and eventually get it back to its initial
1626 @kindex S-@key{down}
1629 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1630 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1631 @vindex org-list-use-circular-motion
1632 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list@footnote{If you want to
1633 cycle around items that way, you may customize
1634 @code{org-list-use-circular-motion}.}, but only if
1635 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1636 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1639 @kindex M-@key{down}
1642 Move the item including subitems up/down@footnote{See
1643 @code{org-liste-use-circular-motion} for a cyclic behavior.} (swap with
1644 previous/next item of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering
1646 @kindex M-@key{left}
1647 @kindex M-@key{right}
1649 @itemx M-@key{right}
1650 Decrease/increase the indentation of an item, leaving children alone.
1651 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1652 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1653 @item M-S-@key{left}
1654 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1655 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1656 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation. When
1657 these commands are executed several times in direct succession, the initially
1658 selected region is used, even if the new indentation would imply a different
1659 hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break the command chain with a cursor
1662 As a special case, using this command on the very first item of a list will
1663 move the whole list. This behavior can be disabled by configuring
1664 @code{org-list-automatic-rules}. The global indentation of a list has no
1665 influence on the text @emph{after} the list.
1668 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1669 state of the checkbox. In any case, verify bullets and indentation
1670 consistency in the whole list.
1672 @vindex org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator
1673 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
1675 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1676 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}) or a subset of them,
1677 depending on @code{org-plain-list-ordered-item-terminator}, the type of list,
1678 and its position@footnote{See @code{bullet} rule in
1679 @code{org-list-automatic-rules} for more information.}. With a numeric
1680 prefix argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an
1681 active region when calling this, selected text will be changed into an item.
1682 With a prefix argument, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1683 first line already was a list item, any item marker will be removed from the
1684 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1685 converted into a list item.
1688 Turn a plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a subheading at
1689 its location). @xref{Structure editing}, for a detailed explanation.
1692 Turn the whole plain list into a subtree of the current heading. Checkboxes
1693 (@pxref{Checkboxes}) will become TODO (resp. DONE) keywords when unchecked
1695 @kindex S-@key{left}
1696 @kindex S-@key{right}
1697 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1698 @vindex org-support-shift-select
1699 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1700 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1701 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1704 Sort the plain list. You will be prompted for the sorting method:
1705 numerically, alphabetically, by time, or by custom function.
1708 @node Drawers, Blocks, Plain lists, Document Structure
1712 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1715 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1716 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org-mode has @emph{drawers}.
1717 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1718 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1719 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1723 ** This is a headline
1724 Still outside the drawer
1726 This is inside the drawer.
1731 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will hide and
1732 show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line. In order to
1733 look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the drawer line and
1734 press @key{TAB} there. Org-mode uses the @code{PROPERTIES} drawer for
1735 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and you can also arrange
1736 for state change notes (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}) and clock times
1737 (@pxref{Clocking work time}) to be stored in a drawer @code{LOGBOOK}. If you
1738 want to store a quick note in the LOGBOOK drawer, in a similar way to state changes, use
1743 Add a time-stamped note to the LOGBOOK drawer.
1746 @node Blocks, Footnotes, Drawers, Document Structure
1749 @vindex org-hide-block-startup
1750 @cindex blocks, folding
1751 Org-mode uses begin...end blocks for various purposes from including source
1752 code examples (@pxref{Literal examples}) to capturing time logging
1753 information (@pxref{Clocking work time}). These blocks can be folded and
1754 unfolded by pressing TAB in the begin line. You can also get all blocks
1755 folded at startup by configuring the variable @code{org-hide-block-startup}
1756 or on a per-file basis by using
1758 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1759 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
1761 #+STARTUP: hideblocks
1762 #+STARTUP: nohideblocks
1765 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Blocks, Document Structure
1769 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1770 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1771 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1772 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e.@: a footnote is
1773 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1774 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1775 inside a footnote, use the @LaTeX{} idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1776 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1779 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1781 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1784 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1785 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1786 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1787 encouraged because of possible conflicts with @LaTeX{} snippets (@pxref{Embedded
1788 LaTeX}). Here are the valid references:
1792 A plain numeric footnote marker. Compatible with @file{footnote.el}, but not
1793 recommended because something like @samp{[1]} could easily be part of a code
1796 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1797 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1798 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1799 A @LaTeX{}-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1801 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1802 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1803 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use
1804 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1807 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
1808 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you can create names yourself.
1809 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1810 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords. See the docstring of that variable
1813 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1818 The footnote action command.
1820 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1821 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1823 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
1824 @vindex org-footnote-section
1825 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
1826 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1827 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1828 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1829 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1830 separately into the location determined by the variable
1831 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1833 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1836 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1837 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1838 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1839 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}. Automatic}
1840 @r{sorting after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the}
1841 @r{variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1842 r @r{Renumber the simple @code{fn:N} footnotes. Automatic renumbering}
1843 @r{after each insertion/deletion can be configured using the variable}
1844 @r{@code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.}
1845 S @r{Short for first @code{r}, then @code{s} action.}
1846 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1847 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1848 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1849 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g.@: sending}
1850 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1851 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1852 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1855 Depending on the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}@footnote{the
1856 corresponding in-buffer options are @code{fnadjust} and @code{nofnadjust}.},
1857 renumbering and sorting footnotes can be automatic after each insertion or
1862 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1863 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1864 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1868 @item C-c C-o @r{or} mouse-1/2
1869 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1870 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1873 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1874 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1875 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1876 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1878 If you like the intuitive way the Org-mode structure editing and list
1879 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes like
1880 Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode @code{orgstruct-mode} makes
1881 this possible. Toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x orgstruct-mode}, or
1882 turn it on by default, for example in Message mode, with one of:
1885 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1886 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct++)
1889 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to Org like a
1890 headline or the first line of a list item, most structure editing commands
1891 will work, even if the same keys normally have different functionality in the
1892 major mode you are using. If the cursor is not in one of those special
1893 lines, Orgstruct mode lurks silently in the shadows. When you use
1894 @code{orgstruct++-mode}, Org will also export indentation and autofill
1895 settings into that mode, and detect item context after the first line of an
1898 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1901 @cindex editing tables
1903 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1904 calculations are supported using the Emacs @file{calc} package
1906 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1909 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1914 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1915 * Column width and alignment:: Overrule the automatic settings
1916 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1917 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1918 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1919 * Org-Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1922 @node Built-in table editor, Column width and alignment, Tables, Tables
1923 @section The built-in table editor
1924 @cindex table editor, built-in
1926 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with @samp{|} as
1927 the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a table. @samp{|}
1928 is also the column separator@footnote{To insert a vertical bar into a table
1929 field, use @code{\vert} or, inside a word @code{abc\vert@{@}def}.}. A table
1930 might look like this:
1933 | Name | Phone | Age |
1934 |-------+-------+-----|
1935 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1936 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1939 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1940 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1941 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1942 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1943 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1944 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1945 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1946 create the above table, you would only type
1953 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1954 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1955 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1957 @vindex org-enable-table-editor
1958 @vindex org-table-auto-blank-field
1959 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1960 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1961 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1962 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1963 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1964 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1965 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1966 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1969 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1970 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
1971 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1972 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1973 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1974 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1975 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1976 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1977 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1979 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1980 table. But it is easier just to start typing, like
1981 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1983 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1984 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-table-align}
1985 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1987 @orgcmd{<TAB>,org-table-next-field}
1988 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1991 @orgcmd{S-@key{TAB},org-table-previous-field}
1992 Re-align, move to previous field.
1994 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-table-next-row}
1995 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1996 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1997 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1999 @orgcmd{M-a,org-table-beginning-of-field}
2000 Move to beginning of the current table field, or on to the previous field.
2001 @orgcmd{M-e,org-table-end-of-field}
2002 Move to end of the current table field, or on to the next field.
2004 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
2005 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{left},M-@key{right},org-table-move-column-left,org-table-move-column-right}
2006 Move the current column left/right.
2008 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{left},org-table-delete-column}
2009 Kill the current column.
2011 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{right},org-table-insert-column}
2012 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
2014 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-move-row-up,org-table-move-row-down}
2015 Move the current row up/down.
2017 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{up},org-table-kill-row}
2018 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
2020 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{down},org-table-insert-row}
2021 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
2022 created below the current one.
2024 @orgcmd{C-c -,org-table-insert-hline}
2025 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
2026 is created above the current line.
2028 @orgcmd{C-c @key{RET},org-table-hline-and-move}
2029 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
2032 @orgcmd{C-c ^,org-table-sort-lines}
2033 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
2034 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
2035 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
2036 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
2037 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
2038 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
2039 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
2040 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
2041 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
2043 @tsubheading{Regions}
2044 @orgcmd{C-c C-x M-w,org-table-copy-region}
2045 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point and
2046 mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. If there is no active region,
2047 copy just the current field. The process ignores horizontal separator lines.
2049 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-w,org-table-cut-region}
2050 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
2051 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
2053 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-y,org-table-paste-rectangle}
2054 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
2055 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
2056 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
2057 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
2060 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-table-wrap-region}
2061 Split the current field at the cursor position and move the rest to the line
2062 below. If there is an active region, and both point and mark are in the same
2063 column, the text in the column is wrapped to minimum width for the given
2064 number of lines. A numeric prefix argument may be used to change the number
2065 of desired lines. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument,
2066 the current field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field
2069 @tsubheading{Calculations}
2070 @cindex formula, in tables
2071 @cindex calculations, in tables
2072 @cindex region, active
2073 @cindex active region
2074 @cindex transient mark mode
2075 @orgcmd{C-c +,org-table-sum}
2076 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
2077 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
2078 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
2080 @orgcmd{S-@key{RET},org-table-copy-down}
2081 @vindex org-table-copy-increment
2082 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
2083 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
2084 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
2085 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
2086 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
2087 increment. This key is also used by shift-selection and related modes
2088 (@pxref{Conflicts}).
2090 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
2091 @orgcmd{C-c `,org-table-edit-field}
2092 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields that
2093 are not fully visible (@pxref{Column width and alignment}). When called with
2094 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
2095 edited in place. When called with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes, make the editor
2096 window follow the cursor through the table and always show the current
2097 field. The follow mode exits automatically when the cursor leaves the table,
2098 or when you repeat this command with @kbd{C-u C-u C-c `}.
2100 @item M-x org-table-import
2101 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB or whitespace
2102 separated. Use, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
2103 from a database, because these programs generally can write
2104 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
2105 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
2106 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
2108 @orgcmd{C-c |,org-table-create-or-convert-from-region}
2109 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
2110 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
2111 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
2113 @item M-x org-table-export
2114 @findex org-table-export
2115 @vindex org-table-export-default-format
2116 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Use for data
2117 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
2118 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
2119 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
2120 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
2121 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
2122 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
2123 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions}, for a
2124 detailed description.
2127 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
2128 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
2132 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
2135 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
2136 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
2138 @node Column width and alignment, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
2139 @section Column width and alignment
2140 @cindex narrow columns in tables
2141 @cindex alignment in tables
2143 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor. And
2144 also the alignment of a column is determined automatically from the fraction
2145 of number-like versus non-number fields in the column.
2147 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text, leading to
2148 inconveniently wide columns. Or maybe you want to make a table with several
2149 columns having a fixed width, regardless of content. To set@footnote{This
2150 feature does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere
2151 in the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
2152 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next re-align
2153 will then set the width of this column to this value.
2157 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2159 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
2160 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
2161 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
2162 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
2163 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
2168 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
2169 Note that the full text is still in the buffer but is hidden.
2170 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field---a tool-tip window
2171 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
2172 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
2173 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
2176 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
2177 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
2178 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
2179 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
2180 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
2181 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
2182 on a per-file basis with:
2189 If you would like to overrule the automatic alignment of number-rich columns
2190 to the right and of string-rich column to the left, you can use @samp{<r>},
2191 @samp{c}@footnote{Centering does not work inside Emacs, but it does have an
2192 effect when exporting to HTML.} or @samp{<l>} in a similar fashion. You may
2193 also combine alignment and field width like this: @samp{<l10>}.
2195 Lines which only contain these formatting cookies will be removed
2196 automatically when exporting the document.
2198 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Column width and alignment, Tables
2199 @section Column groups
2200 @cindex grouping columns in tables
2202 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
2203 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
2204 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
2205 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
2206 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
2207 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
2208 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
2209 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
2210 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
2211 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
2214 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2215 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2216 | / | < | | > | < | > |
2217 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
2218 | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
2219 | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
2220 |---+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2221 #+TBLFM: $2=$1^2::$3=$1^3::$4=$1^4::$5=sqrt($1)::$6=sqrt(sqrt(($1)))
2224 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
2225 every vertical line you would like to have:
2228 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
2229 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
2233 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
2234 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
2236 @cindex minor mode for tables
2238 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
2239 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
2240 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
2241 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
2242 example in Message mode, use
2245 (add-hook 'message-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
2248 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
2249 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
2250 construct @LaTeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
2251 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
2252 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
2254 @node The spreadsheet, Org-Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
2255 @section The spreadsheet
2256 @cindex calculations, in tables
2257 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
2258 @cindex @file{calc} package
2260 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
2261 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
2262 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's implementation
2263 is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example, Org knows the concept
2264 of a @emph{column formula} that will be applied to all non-header fields in a
2265 column without having to copy the formula to each relevant field. There is
2266 also a formula debugger, and a formula editor with features for highlighting
2267 fields in the table corresponding to the references at the point in the
2268 formula, moving these references by arrow keys
2271 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
2272 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
2273 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
2274 * Durations and time values:: How to compute durations and time values
2275 * Field and range formulas:: Formula for specific (ranges of) fields
2276 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
2277 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
2278 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
2279 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
2282 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
2283 @subsection References
2286 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
2287 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
2288 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
2289 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
2290 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
2292 @subsubheading Field references
2293 @cindex field references
2294 @cindex references, to fields
2296 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
2297 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
2298 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
2299 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2300 However, Org prefers@footnote{Org will understand references typed by the
2301 user as @samp{B4}, but it will not use this syntax when offering a formula
2302 for editing. You can customize this behavior using the variable
2303 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.} to use another, more general
2304 representation that looks like this:
2306 @@@var{row}$@var{column}
2309 Column specifications can be absolute like @code{$1},
2310 @code{$2},...@code{$@var{N}}, or relative to the current column (i.e.@: the
2311 column of the field which is being computed) like @code{$+1} or @code{$-2}.
2312 @code{$<} and @code{$>} are immutable references to the first and last
2313 column, respectively, and you can use @code{$>>>} to indicate the third
2314 column from the right.
2316 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal separator
2317 lines (hlines). Like with columns, you can use absolute row numbers
2318 @code{@@1}, @code{@@2},...@code{@@@var{N}}, and row numbers relative to the
2319 current row like @code{@@+3} or @code{@@-1}. @code{@@<} and @code{@@>} are
2320 immutable references the first and last@footnote{For backward compatibility
2321 you can also use special names like @code{$LR5} and @code{$LR12} to refer in
2322 a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the table.
2323 However, this syntax is deprecated, it should not be used for new documents.
2324 Use @code{@@>$} instead.} row in the table, respectively. You may also
2325 specify the row relative to one of the hlines: @code{@@I} refers to the first
2326 hline, @code{@@II} to the second, etc@. @code{@@-I} refers to the first such
2327 line above the current line, @code{@@+I} to the first such line below the
2328 current line. You can also write @code{@@III+2} which is the second data line
2329 after the third hline in the table.
2331 @code{@@0} and @code{$0} refer to the current row and column, respectively,
2332 i.e. to the row/column for the field being computed. Also, if you omit
2333 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current row/column is
2336 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
2337 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
2338 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
2339 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
2340 references because the same reference operator can reference different
2341 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
2343 Here are a few examples:
2346 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column (same as @code{C2})}
2347 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row (same as @code{E&})}
2348 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
2349 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
2350 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
2351 @@>$5 @r{field in the last row, in column 5}
2354 @subsubheading Range references
2355 @cindex range references
2356 @cindex references, to ranges
2358 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
2359 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
2360 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
2361 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
2362 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
2363 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
2366 $1..$3 @r{first three fields in the current row}
2367 $P..$Q @r{range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
2368 $<<<..$>> @r{start in third column, continue to the one but last}
2369 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields (same as @code{A2..C4})}
2370 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
2371 @@I..II @r{between first and second hline, short for @code{@@I..@@II}}
2374 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
2375 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
2376 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
2377 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
2378 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
2380 @subsubheading Field coordinates in formulas
2381 @cindex field coordinates
2382 @cindex coordinates, of field
2383 @cindex row, of field coordinates
2384 @cindex column, of field coordinates
2386 For Calc formulas and Lisp formulas @code{@@#} and @code{$#} can be used to
2387 get the row or column number of the field where the formula result goes.
2388 The traditional Lisp formula equivalents are @code{org-table-current-dline}
2389 and @code{org-table-current-column}. Examples:
2392 if(@@# % 2, $#, string("")) @r{column number on odd lines only}
2393 $3 = remote(FOO, @@@@#$2) @r{copy column 2 from table FOO into}
2394 @r{column 3 of the current table}
2397 @noindent For the second example, table FOO must have at least as many rows
2398 as the current table. Note that this is inefficient@footnote{The computation time scales as
2399 O(N^2) because table FOO is parsed for each field to be copied.} for large
2402 @subsubheading Named references
2403 @cindex named references
2404 @cindex references, named
2405 @cindex name, of column or field
2406 @cindex constants, in calculations
2409 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
2410 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
2411 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
2412 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
2416 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
2420 @vindex constants-unit-system
2421 @pindex constants.el
2422 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
2423 constants in table formulas: for a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
2424 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
2425 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
2426 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
2427 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
2428 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{constants.el} can
2429 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
2430 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
2431 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
2432 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
2433 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
2434 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
2435 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
2438 @subsubheading Remote references
2439 @cindex remote references
2440 @cindex references, remote
2441 @cindex references, to a different table
2442 @cindex name, of column or field
2443 @cindex constants, in calculations
2446 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2447 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2450 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2454 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2455 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2456 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2457 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2458 described above for example @code{@@3$3} or @code{$somename}, valid in the
2461 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2462 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2463 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2464 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2466 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2467 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2468 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2469 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2470 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2471 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2472 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2473 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2474 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2475 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2476 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2477 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2479 @cindex format specifier
2480 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2481 @vindex org-calc-default-modes
2482 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2483 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2484 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2485 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2486 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 8)} to keep tables
2487 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2488 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2491 p20 @r{set the internal Calc calculation precision to 20 digits}
2492 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{Normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed}
2493 @r{format of the result of Calc passed back to Org.}
2494 @r{Calc formatting is unlimited in precision as}
2495 @r{long as the Calc calculation precision is greater.}
2496 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2497 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2498 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2499 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2504 Unless you use large integer numbers or high-precision-calculation
2505 and -display for floating point numbers you may alternatively provide a
2506 @code{printf} format specifier to reformat the Calc result after it has been
2507 passed back to Org instead of letting Calc already do the
2508 formatting@footnote{The @code{printf} reformatting is limited in precision
2509 because the value passed to it is converted into an @code{integer} or
2510 @code{double}. The @code{integer} is limited in size by truncating the
2511 signed value to 32 bits. The @code{double} is limited in precision to 64
2512 bits overall which leaves approximately 16 significant decimal digits.}.
2516 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2517 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2518 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2519 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2520 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2521 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2522 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2523 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2524 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2525 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2526 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{Taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2529 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2532 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{"teen" if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2535 Note that you can also use two org-specific flags @code{T} and @code{t} for
2536 durations computations @ref{Durations and time values}.
2538 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Durations and time values, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2539 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2540 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2542 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful for
2543 string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's functionality is not
2544 enough. If a formula starts with a single-quote followed by an opening
2545 parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a Lisp form. The evaluation should
2546 return either a string or a number. Just as with @file{calc} formulas, you
2547 can specify modes and a printf format after a semicolon. With Emacs Lisp
2548 forms, you need to be conscious about the way field references are
2549 interpolated into the form. By default, a reference will be interpolated as
2550 a Lisp string (in double-quotes) containing the field. If you provide the
2551 @samp{N} mode switch, all referenced elements will be numbers (non-number
2552 fields will be zero) and interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If
2553 you provide the @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally,
2554 without quotes. I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string
2555 by the Lisp form, enclose the reference operator itself in double-quotes,
2556 like @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2557 embed them in list or vector syntax. Here are a few examples---note how the
2558 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in Lisp:
2561 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2562 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2563 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2565 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2566 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2569 @node Durations and time values, Field and range formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2570 @subsection Durations and time values
2571 @cindex Duration, computing
2572 @cindex Time, computing
2573 @vindex org-table-duration-custom-format
2575 If you want to compute time values use the @code{T} flag, either in Calc
2576 formulas or Elisp formulas:
2580 | Task 1 | Task 2 | Total |
2581 |---------+----------+----------|
2582 | 2:12 | 1:47 | 03:59:00 |
2583 | 3:02:20 | -2:07:00 | 0.92 |
2584 #+TBLFM: @@2$3=$1+$2;T::@@3$3=$1+$2;t
2588 Input duration values must be of the form @code{[HH:MM[:SS]}, where seconds
2589 are optional. With the @code{T} flag, computed durations will be displayed
2590 as @code{[HH:MM:SS} (see the first formula above). With the @code{t} flag,
2591 computed durations will be displayed according to the value of the variable
2592 @code{org-table-duration-custom-format}, which defaults to @code{'hours} and
2593 will display the result as a fraction of hours (see the second formula in the
2596 Negative duration values can be manipulated as well, and integers will be
2597 considered as seconds in addition and subtraction.
2599 @node Field and range formulas, Column formulas, Durations and time values, The spreadsheet
2600 @subsection Field and range formulas
2601 @cindex field formula
2602 @cindex range formula
2603 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2604 @cindex formula, for range of fields
2606 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the field,
2607 preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=vsum(@@II..III)}. When you press
2608 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2609 the formula will be stored as the formula for this field, evaluated, and the
2610 current field will be replaced with the result.
2613 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:} directly
2614 below the table. If you type the equation in the 4th field of the 3rd data
2615 line in the table, the formula will look like @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When
2616 inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows with the appropriate commands,
2617 @i{absolute references} (but not relative ones) in stored formulas are
2618 modified in order to still reference the same field. To avoid this from
2619 happening, in particular in range references, anchor ranges at the table
2620 borders (using @code{@@<}, @code{@@>}, @code{$<}, @code{$>}), or at hlines
2621 using the @code{@@I} notation. Automatic adaptation of field references does
2622 of cause not happen if you edit the table structure with normal editing
2623 commands---then you must fix the equations yourself.
2625 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the following
2629 @orgcmd{C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2630 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2631 formula with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2632 it to the current field, and stores it.
2635 The left-hand side of a formula can also be a special expression in order to
2636 assign the formula to a number of different fields. There is no keyboard
2637 shortcut to enter such range formulas. To add them, use the formula editor
2638 (@pxref{Editing and debugging formulas}) or edit the @code{#+TBLFM:} line
2643 Column formula, valid for the entire column. This is so common that Org
2644 treats these formulas in a special way, see @ref{Column formulas}.
2646 Row formula, applies to all fields in the specified row. @code{@@>=} means
2649 Range formula, applies to all fields in the given rectangular range. This
2650 can also be used to assign a formula to some but not all fields in a row.
2652 Named field, see @ref{Advanced features}.
2655 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field and range formulas, The spreadsheet
2656 @subsection Column formulas
2657 @cindex column formula
2658 @cindex formula, for table column
2660 When you assign a formula to a simple column reference like @code{$3=}, the
2661 same formula will be used in all fields of that column, with the following
2662 very convenient exceptions: (i) If the table contains horizontal separator
2663 hlines, everything before the first such line is considered part of the table
2664 @emph{header} and will not be modified by column formulas. (ii) Fields that
2665 already get a value from a field/range formula will be left alone by column
2666 formulas. These conditions make column formulas very easy to use.
2668 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2669 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2670 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the field,
2671 the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column, evaluated
2672 and the current field replaced with the result. If the field contains only
2673 @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is used. For each
2674 column, Org will only remember the most recently used formula. In the
2675 @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like @samp{$4=$1+$2}. The
2676 left-hand side of a column formula can not be the name of column, it must be
2677 the numeric column reference or @code{$>}.
2679 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2683 @orgcmd{C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2684 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2685 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2686 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2687 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g.@: @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2688 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2691 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2692 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2693 @cindex formula editing
2694 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2696 @vindex org-table-use-standard-references
2697 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2698 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2699 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2700 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2701 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2702 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2703 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2706 @orgcmdkkc{C-c =,C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2707 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2708 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas}, and @ref{Field and range formulas}.
2709 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c =,org-table-eval-formula}
2710 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2711 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2712 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2713 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2714 @orgcmd{C-c ?,org-table-field-info}
2715 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2716 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2718 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2720 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using overlays
2721 (@command{org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays}). These are updated each
2722 time the table is aligned; you can force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2724 @findex org-table-toggle-formula-debugger
2726 Toggle the formula debugger on and off
2727 (@command{org-table-toggle-formula-debugger}). See below.
2728 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-table-edit-formulas}
2729 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2730 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2731 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2732 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2733 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2734 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2736 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-x C-s,org-table-fedit-finish}
2737 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2738 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2739 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-table-fedit-abort}
2740 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2741 @orgcmd{C-c C-r,org-table-fedit-toggle-ref-type}
2742 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2743 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2744 @orgcmd{@key{TAB},org-table-fedit-lisp-indent}
2745 Pretty-print or indent Lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2746 a Lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2747 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2748 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2749 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},lisp-complete-symbol}
2750 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs Lisp mode.
2752 @kindex S-@key{down}
2753 @kindex S-@key{left}
2754 @kindex S-@key{right}
2755 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-up
2756 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-down
2757 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-left
2758 @findex org-table-fedit-ref-right
2759 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2760 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2761 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2762 This also works for relative references and for hline references.
2763 @orgcmdkkcc{M-S-@key{up},M-S-@key{down},org-table-fedit-line-up,org-table-fedit-line-down}
2764 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2766 @orgcmdkkcc{M-@key{up},M-@key{down},org-table-fedit-scroll-down,org-table-fedit-scroll-up}
2767 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2769 @findex org-table-toggle-coordinate-overlays
2771 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2775 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2776 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{#+TBLFM}
2777 line)---during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2778 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2779 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2782 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2783 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line or with the normal
2784 recalculation commands in the table.
2786 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2787 @cindex formula debugging
2788 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2789 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2790 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2791 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2792 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2793 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2794 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2796 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2797 @subsection Updating the table
2798 @cindex recomputing table fields
2799 @cindex updating, table
2801 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2802 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features}, for a way to make
2803 recalculation at least semi-automatic.
2805 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2809 @orgcmd{C-c *,org-table-recalculate}
2810 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2811 from left to right, and all field/range formulas in the current row.
2817 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2818 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2820 @orgcmdkkc{C-u C-u C-c *,C-u C-u C-c C-c,org-table-iterate}
2821 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2822 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2823 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2824 @item M-x org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2825 @findex org-table-recalculate-buffer-tables
2826 Recompute all tables in the current buffer.
2827 @item M-x org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2828 @findex org-table-iterate-buffer-tables
2829 Iterate all tables in the current buffer, in order to converge table-to-table
2833 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2834 @subsection Advanced features
2836 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2837 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2838 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2841 @orgcmd{C-#,org-table-rotate-recalc-marks}
2842 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{ },
2843 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2844 change all marks in the region.
2847 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2848 makes use of these features:
2852 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2853 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2854 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2855 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2856 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2857 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2858 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2859 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2860 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2861 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2862 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2863 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2864 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2865 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2866 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2870 @noindent @b{Important}: please note that for these special tables,
2871 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2872 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2873 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2876 @cindex marking characters, tables
2877 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2880 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2881 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2883 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2884 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2885 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2886 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2888 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2891 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2892 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2893 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2894 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2897 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2898 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2899 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2900 lines will be left alone by this command.
2902 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2903 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2904 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2906 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2907 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2910 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2911 @samp{<N>} markers or column group markers.
2914 Finally, just to whet your appetite for what can be done with the
2915 fantastic @file{calc.el} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2916 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2921 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2922 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2923 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2924 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2925 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2926 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2927 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2928 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2929 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2930 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2931 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2935 @node Org-Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2937 @cindex graph, in tables
2938 @cindex plot tables using Gnuplot
2941 Org-Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2942 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2943 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2944 this in action, ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot mode installed
2945 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2949 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2950 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2951 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2952 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2953 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2954 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2955 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2956 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2960 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the table's headers as labels.
2961 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2962 be exercised through the @code{#+PLOT:} lines preceding a table. See below
2963 for a complete list of Org-plot options. For more information and examples
2964 see the Org-plot tutorial at
2965 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.html}.
2967 @subsubheading Plot Options
2971 Specify any @command{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2974 Specify the title of the plot.
2977 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2980 Specify the columns to graph as a Lisp style list, surrounded by parentheses
2981 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2982 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the @code{ind}
2986 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2989 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2990 (e.g.@: @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2991 Defaults to @code{lines}.
2994 If you want to plot to a file, specify @code{"@var{path/to/desired/output-file}"}.
2997 List of labels to be used for the @code{deps} (defaults to the column headers
3001 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the Gnuplot script.
3004 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
3005 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
3008 Specify format of Org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by Gnuplot.
3009 Defaults to @samp{%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S}.
3012 If you want total control, you can specify a script file (place the file name
3013 between double-quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
3014 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
3015 the path to the generated data file. Note: even if you set this option, you
3016 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
3020 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
3024 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
3025 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
3028 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
3029 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
3030 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
3031 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
3032 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
3033 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
3034 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
3035 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
3038 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
3039 @section Link format
3041 @cindex format, of links
3043 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
3044 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
3047 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
3051 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
3052 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
3053 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
3054 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
3055 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
3056 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
3057 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
3058 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
3061 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
3062 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
3063 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
3064 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
3065 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
3066 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
3067 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
3069 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
3070 @section Internal links
3071 @cindex internal links
3072 @cindex links, internal
3073 @cindex targets, for links
3075 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3076 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in the
3077 current file. The most important case is a link like
3078 @samp{[[#my-custom-id]]} which will link to the entry with the
3079 @code{CUSTOM_ID} property @samp{my-custom-id}. Such custom IDs are very good
3080 for HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}) where they produce pretty section
3081 links. You are responsible yourself to make sure these custom IDs are unique
3084 Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My Target][Find my target]]}
3085 lead to a text search in the current file.
3087 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the link,
3088 or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). Links to custom IDs will
3089 point to the corresponding headline. The preferred match for a text link is
3090 a @i{dedicated target}: the same string in double angular brackets. Targets
3091 may be located anywhere; sometimes it is convenient to put them into a
3092 comment line. For example
3098 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
3099 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
3100 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
3101 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
3104 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for a headline that is exactly
3105 the link text but may also include a TODO keyword and tags@footnote{To insert
3106 a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used. Just type a
3107 star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and press
3108 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be offered as
3109 completions.}. In non-Org files, the search will look for the words in the
3110 link text. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
3112 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
3113 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
3114 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
3118 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
3121 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
3122 @subsection Radio targets
3123 @cindex radio targets
3124 @cindex targets, radio
3125 @cindex links, radio targets
3127 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
3128 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
3129 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
3130 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
3131 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
3132 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
3133 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
3134 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3135 cursor on or at a target.
3137 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
3138 @section External links
3139 @cindex links, external
3140 @cindex external links
3141 @cindex links, external
3149 @cindex WANDERLUST links
3151 @cindex USENET links
3156 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
3157 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
3158 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
3159 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
3160 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
3163 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
3164 doi:10.1000/182 @r{DOI for an electronic resource}
3165 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
3166 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
3167 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
3168 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3169 file:/myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{file, path on remote machine}
3170 /myself@@some.where:papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
3171 file:sometextfile::NNN @r{file with line number to jump to}
3172 file:projects.org @r{another Org file}
3173 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in Org file}
3174 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in Org file}
3175 docview:papers/last.pdf::NNN @r{open file in doc-view mode at page NNN}
3176 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
3177 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
3178 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
3179 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
3180 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
3181 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
3182 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
3183 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
3184 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
3185 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
3186 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
3187 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
3188 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
3189 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
3190 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
3191 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
3192 info:org#External%20links @r{Info node link (with encoded space)}
3193 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
3194 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive Elisp command}
3195 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
3198 For customizing Org to add new link types @ref{Adding hyperlink types}.
3200 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
3201 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
3202 format}), for example:
3205 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
3209 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
3210 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
3211 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
3213 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
3215 @cindex square brackets, around links
3216 @cindex plain text external links
3217 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
3218 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
3219 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
3220 about the end of the link, enclose them in square brackets.
3222 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
3223 @section Handling links
3224 @cindex links, handling
3226 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
3227 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
3230 @orgcmd{C-c l,org-store-link}
3231 @cindex storing links
3232 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
3233 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
3234 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
3235 buffer (see below). What kind of link will be created depends on the current
3238 @b{Org-mode buffers}@*
3239 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
3240 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, which will also
3241 be the description@footnote{If the headline contains a timestamp, it will be
3242 removed from the link and result in a wrong link -- you should avoid putting
3243 timestamp in the headline.}.
3245 @vindex org-link-to-org-use-id
3246 @cindex property, CUSTOM_ID
3247 @cindex property, ID
3248 If the headline has a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property, a link to this custom ID
3249 will be stored. In addition or alternatively (depending on the value of
3250 @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}), a globally unique @code{ID} property will be
3251 created and/or used to construct a link. So using this command in Org
3252 buffers will potentially create two links: a human-readable from the custom
3253 ID, and one that is globally unique and works even if the entry is moved from
3254 file to file. Later, when inserting the link, you need to decide which one
3257 @b{Email/News clients: VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus}@*
3258 Pretty much all Emacs mail clients are supported. The link will point to the
3259 current article, or, in some GNUS buffers, to the group. The description is
3260 constructed from the author and the subject.
3262 @b{Web browsers: W3 and W3M}@*
3263 Here the link will be the current URL, with the page title as description.
3265 @b{Contacts: BBDB}@*
3266 Links created in a BBDB buffer will point to the current entry.
3269 @vindex org-irc-link-to-logs
3270 For IRC links, if you set the variable @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to
3271 @code{t}, a @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for
3272 the current conversation is created. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to
3273 the user/channel/server under the point will be stored.
3276 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
3277 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
3278 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
3279 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
3280 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
3281 and to do the search for particular file types---see @ref{Custom searches}.
3282 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion---see @ref{Installation}.
3285 When the cursor is in an agenda view, the created link points to the
3286 entry referenced by the current line.
3289 @orgcmd{C-c C-l,org-insert-link}
3290 @cindex link completion
3291 @cindex completion, of links
3292 @cindex inserting links
3293 @vindex org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion
3294 Insert a link@footnote{ Note that you don't have to use this command to
3295 insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type or paste them
3296 straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are automatically
3297 enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the optional
3298 descriptive text.}. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer.
3299 You can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
3300 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. The link will be inserted
3301 into the buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be
3302 removed from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use
3303 a triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
3304 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
3305 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
3306 becomes the default description.
3308 @b{Inserting stored links}@*
3309 All links stored during the
3310 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
3311 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}).
3313 @b{Completion support}@* Completion with @key{TAB} will help you to insert
3314 valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes
3315 defined through link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). If you
3316 press @key{RET} after inserting only the @var{prefix}, Org will offer
3317 specific completion support for some link types@footnote{This works by
3318 calling a special function @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link}.} For
3319 example, if you type @kbd{file @key{RET}}, file name completion (alternative
3320 access: @kbd{C-u C-c C-l}, see below) will be offered, and after @kbd{bbdb
3321 @key{RET}} you can complete contact names.
3323 @cindex file name completion
3324 @cindex completion, of file names
3325 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
3326 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
3327 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
3328 directory of the current Org file, if the linked file is in the current
3329 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
3330 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
3331 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
3332 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
3334 @item C-c C-l @ @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
3335 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
3336 link and description parts of the link.
3338 @cindex following links
3339 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
3340 @vindex org-file-apps
3341 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
3342 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
3343 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
3344 cursor is on an internal link, this command runs the corresponding search.
3345 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
3346 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a timestamp, it compiles the agenda for that
3347 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
3348 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
3349 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
3350 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
3351 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
3352 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.@*
3353 If the cursor is on a headline, but not on a link, offer all links in the
3354 headline and entry text.
3356 @vindex org-return-follows-link
3357 When @code{org-return-follows-link} is set, @kbd{@key{RET}} will also follow
3364 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
3365 would. Under Emacs 22 and later, @kbd{mouse-1} will also follow a link.
3369 @vindex org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer
3370 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
3371 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
3372 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
3374 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-v,org-toggle-inline-images}
3375 @cindex inlining images
3376 @cindex images, inlining
3377 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
3378 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3379 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
3380 Toggle the inline display of linked images. Normally this will only inline
3381 images that have no description part in the link, i.e.@: images that will also
3382 be inlined during export. When called with a prefix argument, also display
3383 images that do have a link description. You can ask for inline images to be
3384 displayed at startup by configuring the variable
3385 @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}@footnote{with corresponding
3386 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{inlineimages} and @code{inlineimages}}.
3387 @orgcmd{C-c %,org-mark-ring-push}
3389 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
3390 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
3392 @orgcmd{C-c &,org-mark-ring-goto}
3393 @cindex links, returning to
3394 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
3395 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
3396 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
3397 previously recorded positions.
3399 @orgcmdkkcc{C-c C-x C-n,C-c C-x C-p,org-next-link,org-previous-link}
3400 @cindex links, finding next/previous
3401 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
3402 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
3403 bindings for this are really too long; you might want to bind this also
3404 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
3406 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
3408 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
3409 (define-key org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
3413 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
3414 @section Using links outside Org
3416 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
3417 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
3418 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
3422 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
3423 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
3426 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
3427 @section Link abbreviations
3428 @cindex link abbreviations
3429 @cindex abbreviation, links
3431 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
3432 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
3433 abbreviated link looks like this
3436 [[linkword:tag][description]]
3440 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
3441 where the tag is optional.
3442 The @i{linkword} must be a word, starting with a letter, followed by
3443 letters, numbers, @samp{-}, and @samp{_}. Abbreviations are resolved
3444 according to the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}
3445 that relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
3449 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
3450 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
3451 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
3452 ("gmap" . "http://maps.google.com/maps?q=%s")
3453 ("omap" . "http://nominatim.openstreetmap.org/search?q=%s&polygon=1")
3454 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
3458 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
3459 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
3460 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
3461 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
3463 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
3464 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
3465 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]}, show the map location of the Free Software
3466 Foundation @code{[[gmap:51 Franklin Street, Boston]]} or of Carsten office
3467 @code{[[omap:Science Park 904, Amsterdam, The Netherlands]]} and find out
3468 what the Org author is doing besides Emacs hacking with
3469 @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
3471 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
3472 can define them in the file with
3476 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
3477 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
3481 In-buffer completion (@pxref{Completion}) can be used after @samp{[} to
3482 complete link abbreviations. You may also define a function
3483 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
3484 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
3485 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
3487 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
3488 @section Search options in file links
3489 @cindex search option in file links
3490 @cindex file links, searching
3492 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
3493 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
3494 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
3495 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
3496 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
3497 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
3498 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
3499 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
3501 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
3502 link, together with an explanation:
3505 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
3506 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
3507 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
3508 [[file:~/xx.org::#my-custom-id]]
3509 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
3516 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
3517 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
3518 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
3519 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
3522 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
3524 Link to a heading with a @code{CUSTOM_ID} property
3526 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
3527 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
3528 target file is in Org-mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
3529 sparse tree with the matches.
3530 @c If the target file is a directory,
3531 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
3534 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
3535 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
3536 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
3537 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
3539 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
3540 @section Custom Searches
3541 @cindex custom search strings
3542 @cindex search strings, custom
3544 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
3545 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
3546 cases. For example, Bib@TeX{} database files have many entries like
3547 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
3548 because the only unique identification for a Bib@TeX{} entry is the
3551 @vindex org-create-file-search-functions
3552 @vindex org-execute-file-search-functions
3553 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
3554 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
3555 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
3556 to be added to the hook variables
3557 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
3558 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
3559 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
3560 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
3561 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
3563 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
3567 Org-mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
3568 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
3569 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
3570 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
3571 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
3572 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
3573 item emerged is always present.
3575 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3576 throughout your notes file. Org-mode compensates for this by providing
3577 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3580 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3581 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3582 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3583 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3584 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3585 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3588 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3589 @section Basic TODO functionality
3591 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3592 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3595 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3599 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3602 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
3603 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3604 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3607 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3608 '--------------------------------'
3611 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3612 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3614 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-t}
3615 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3616 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3617 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords}, and @ref{Setting tags}, for
3620 @kindex S-@key{right}
3621 @kindex S-@key{left}
3622 @item S-@key{right} @ @r{/} @ S-@key{left}
3623 @vindex org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change
3624 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3625 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3626 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction
3627 with @code{shift-selection-mode}. See also the variable
3628 @code{org-treat-S-cursor-todo-selection-as-state-change}.
3629 @orgcmd{C-c / t,org-show-todo-key}
3630 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3631 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3632 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds the
3633 entire buffer, but shows all TODO items (with not-DONE state) and the
3634 headings hierarchy above them. With a prefix argument (or by using @kbd{C-c
3635 / T}), search for a specific TODO. You will be prompted for the keyword, and
3636 you can also give a list of keywords like @code{KWD1|KWD2|...} to list
3637 entries that match any one of these keywords. With a numeric prefix argument
3638 N, show the tree for the Nth keyword in the variable
3639 @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix arguments, find all TODO states,
3640 both un-done and done.
3641 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
3642 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items (with not-DONE states)
3643 from all agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new
3644 buffer will be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3645 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3646 @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3647 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
3648 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3652 @vindex org-todo-state-tags-triggers
3653 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3654 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3656 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3657 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3658 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3660 @vindex org-todo-keywords
3661 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3662 DONE. Org-mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3663 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3664 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3667 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3668 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3671 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3672 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3673 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3674 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3675 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3676 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3677 * TODO dependencies:: When one task needs to wait for others
3680 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3681 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3682 @cindex TODO workflow
3683 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3685 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3686 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3687 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org-mode in a
3691 (setq org-todo-keywords
3692 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3695 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3696 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3697 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3699 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3700 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3701 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3702 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3703 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3704 Or you can use @kbd{S-@key{left}} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3705 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3706 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3707 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3708 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3709 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes}, for more information.
3711 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3712 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3714 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3715 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3717 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3718 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3719 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3720 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3721 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3722 be set up like this:
3725 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3728 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3729 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3730 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org-mode supports this style by adapting
3731 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3732 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3733 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3734 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3735 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3736 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3737 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3738 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c / t}. For example, to see all things
3739 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c / t}. To collect Lucy's items
3740 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3741 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c a t}.
3743 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3744 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3745 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3747 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3748 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3749 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3750 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3751 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3755 (setq org-todo-keywords
3756 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3757 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3758 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3761 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org-mode to keep track
3762 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3763 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3764 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3765 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3766 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3767 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3770 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3771 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3772 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3773 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3774 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3775 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3776 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3777 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3778 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3779 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3780 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3781 @kindex S-@key{right}
3782 @kindex S-@key{left}
3785 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3786 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3787 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3788 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
3789 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3792 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3793 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3795 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3796 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3797 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3798 key after each keyword, in parentheses. For example:
3801 (setq org-todo-keywords
3802 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3803 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3804 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3807 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo
3808 If you then press @kbd{C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the entry
3809 will be switched to this state. @kbd{SPC} can be used to remove any TODO
3810 keyword from an entry.@footnote{Check also the variable
3811 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows you to change the TODO
3812 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you like to
3813 mingle the two concepts. Note that this means you need to come up with
3814 unique keys across both sets of keywords.}
3816 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3817 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3818 @cindex keyword options
3819 @cindex per-file keywords
3824 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3825 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3826 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3827 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3828 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3832 #+TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3834 @noindent (you may also write @code{#+SEQ_TODO} to be explicit about the
3835 interpretation, but it means the same as @code{#+TODO}), or
3837 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3840 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3844 #+TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3848 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3850 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3851 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3853 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3854 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3855 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3856 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3857 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3858 known to Org-mode@footnote{Org-mode parses these lines only when
3859 Org-mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3860 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org-mode
3861 for the current buffer.}.
3863 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3864 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3865 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3867 @vindex org-todo @r{(face)}
3868 @vindex org-done @r{(face)}
3869 @vindex org-todo-keyword-faces
3870 Org-mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3871 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3872 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3873 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3874 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3875 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3879 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3880 '(("TODO" . org-warning) ("STARTED" . "yellow")
3881 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3885 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED @emph{should}
3886 work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If necessary, define a
3887 special face and use that. A string is interpreted as a color. The variable
3888 @code{org-faces-easy-properties} determines if that color is interpreted as a
3889 foreground or a background color.
3891 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3892 @subsection TODO dependencies
3893 @cindex TODO dependencies
3894 @cindex dependencies, of TODO states
3896 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3897 @cindex property, ORDERED
3898 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3899 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3900 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3901 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3902 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3903 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3904 from changing state to DONE while they have children that are not DONE.
3905 Furthermore, if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children
3906 will be blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an
3910 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3919 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3920 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3924 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
3925 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
3926 @cindex property, ORDERED
3927 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the current entry. A property is used
3928 for this behavior because this should be local to the current entry, not
3929 inherited like a tag. However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of
3930 this property with a tag for better visibility, customize the variable
3931 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
3932 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-u C-c C-t}
3933 Change TODO state, circumventing any state blocking.
3936 @vindex org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks
3937 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3938 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3939 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3941 @cindex checkboxes and TODO dependencies
3942 @vindex org-enforce-todo-dependencies
3943 You can also block changes of TODO states by looking at checkboxes
3944 (@pxref{Checkboxes}). If you set the variable
3945 @code{org-enforce-todo-checkbox-dependencies}, an entry that has unchecked
3946 checkboxes will be blocked from switching to DONE.
3948 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3949 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3950 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3953 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3954 @section Progress logging
3955 @cindex progress logging
3956 @cindex logging, of progress
3958 Org-mode can automatically record a timestamp and possibly a note when
3959 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3960 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3961 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3962 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3966 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3967 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3968 * Tracking your habits:: How consistent have you been?
3971 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3972 @subsection Closing items
3974 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3975 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3976 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}
3979 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3983 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3984 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3985 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3986 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3987 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3988 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3991 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3995 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3996 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3998 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3999 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
4000 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
4001 giving you an overview of what has been done.
4003 @node Tracking TODO state changes, Tracking your habits, Closing items, Progress logging
4004 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
4005 @cindex drawer, for state change recording
4007 @vindex org-log-states-order-reversed
4008 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
4009 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
4010 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow states}), you
4011 might want to keep track of when a state change occurred and maybe take a
4012 note about this change. You can either record just a timestamp, or a
4013 time-stamped note for a change. These records will be inserted after the
4014 headline as an itemized list, newest first@footnote{See the variable
4015 @code{org-log-states-order-reversed}}. When taking a lot of notes, you might
4016 want to get the notes out of the way into a drawer (@pxref{Drawers}).
4017 Customize the variable @code{org-log-into-drawer} to get this
4018 behavior---the recommended drawer for this is called @code{LOGBOOK}. You can
4019 also overrule the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
4020 @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
4022 Since it is normally too much to record a note for every state, Org-mode
4023 expects configuration on a per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by
4024 adding special markers @samp{!} (for a timestamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note)
4025 in parentheses after each keyword. For example, with the setting
4028 (setq org-todo-keywords
4029 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
4033 @vindex org-log-done
4034 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
4035 request that a time is recorded when the entry is set to
4036 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org-mode will record two timestamps
4037 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
4038 However, it will never prompt for two notes---if you have configured
4039 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
4040 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
4041 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: the
4042 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
4043 entering the state, a timestamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
4044 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
4045 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
4046 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
4047 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
4048 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
4051 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
4054 #+TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
4057 @cindex property, LOGGING
4058 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
4059 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
4060 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
4061 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
4062 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
4063 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
4066 * TODO Log each state with only a time
4068 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
4070 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
4072 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
4074 * TODO No logging at all
4080 @node Tracking your habits, , Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging
4081 @subsection Tracking your habits
4084 Org has the ability to track the consistency of a special category of TODOs,
4085 called ``habits''. A habit has the following properties:
4089 You have enabled the @code{habits} module by customizing the variable
4092 The habit is a TODO item, with a TODO keyword representing an open state.
4094 The property @code{STYLE} is set to the value @code{habit}.
4096 The TODO has a scheduled date, usually with a @code{.+} style repeat
4097 interval. A @code{++} style may be appropriate for habits with time
4098 constraints, e.g., must be done on weekends, or a @code{+} style for an
4099 unusual habit that can have a backlog, e.g., weekly reports.
4101 The TODO may also have minimum and maximum ranges specified by using the
4102 syntax @samp{.+2d/3d}, which says that you want to do the task at least every
4103 three days, but at most every two days.
4105 You must also have state logging for the @code{DONE} state enabled, in order
4106 for historical data to be represented in the consistency graph. If it is not
4107 enabled it is not an error, but the consistency graphs will be largely
4111 To give you an idea of what the above rules look like in action, here's an
4112 actual habit with some history:
4116 SCHEDULED: <2009-10-17 Sat .+2d/4d>
4117 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-15 Thu]
4118 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-12 Mon]
4119 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-10 Sat]
4120 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-04 Sun]
4121 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-10-02 Fri]
4122 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-29 Tue]
4123 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-25 Fri]
4124 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-19 Sat]
4125 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-16 Wed]
4126 - State "DONE" from "TODO" [2009-09-12 Sat]
4129 :LAST_REPEAT: [2009-10-19 Mon 00:36]
4133 What this habit says is: I want to shave at most every 2 days (given by the
4134 @code{SCHEDULED} date and repeat interval) and at least every 4 days. If
4135 today is the 15th, then the habit first appears in the agenda on Oct 17,
4136 after the minimum of 2 days has elapsed, and will appear overdue on Oct 19,
4137 after four days have elapsed.
4139 What's really useful about habits is that they are displayed along with a
4140 consistency graph, to show how consistent you've been at getting that task
4141 done in the past. This graph shows every day that the task was done over the
4142 past three weeks, with colors for each day. The colors used are:
4146 If the task wasn't to be done yet on that day.
4148 If the task could have been done on that day.
4150 If the task was going to be overdue the next day.
4152 If the task was overdue on that day.
4155 In addition to coloring each day, the day is also marked with an asterisk if
4156 the task was actually done that day, and an exclamation mark to show where
4157 the current day falls in the graph.
4159 There are several configuration variables that can be used to change the way
4160 habits are displayed in the agenda.
4163 @item org-habit-graph-column
4164 The buffer column at which the consistency graph should be drawn. This will
4165 overwrite any text in that column, so it is a good idea to keep your habits'
4166 titles brief and to the point.
4167 @item org-habit-preceding-days
4168 The amount of history, in days before today, to appear in consistency graphs.
4169 @item org-habit-following-days
4170 The number of days after today that will appear in consistency graphs.
4171 @item org-habit-show-habits-only-for-today
4172 If non-nil, only show habits in today's agenda view. This is set to true by
4176 Lastly, pressing @kbd{K} in the agenda buffer will cause habits to
4177 temporarily be disabled and they won't appear at all. Press @kbd{K} again to
4178 bring them back. They are also subject to tag filtering, if you have habits
4179 which should only be done in certain contexts, for example.
4181 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
4185 If you use Org-mode extensively, you may end up with enough TODO items that
4186 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
4187 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like this
4190 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
4194 @vindex org-priority-faces
4195 By default, Org-mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
4196 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie is
4197 treated just like priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only for
4198 sorting in the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they
4199 have no inherent meaning to Org-mode. The cookies can be highlighted with
4200 special faces by customizing the variable @code{org-priority-faces}.
4202 Priorities can be attached to any outline node; they do not need to be TODO
4208 @findex org-priority
4209 Set the priority of the current headline (@command{org-priority}). The
4210 command prompts for a priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}.
4211 When you press @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the
4212 headline. The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline
4213 and agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
4215 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-priority-up,org-priority-down}
4216 @vindex org-priority-start-cycle-with-default
4217 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
4218 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default}.}. Note that these keys are
4219 also used to modify timestamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
4220 @ref{Conflicts}, for a discussion of the interaction with
4221 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
4224 @vindex org-highest-priority
4225 @vindex org-lowest-priority
4226 @vindex org-default-priority
4227 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
4228 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
4229 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
4230 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
4231 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
4234 @cindex #+PRIORITIES
4239 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
4240 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
4241 @cindex tasks, breaking down
4242 @cindex statistics, for TODO items
4244 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
4245 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
4246 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
4247 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
4248 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
4249 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
4250 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
4251 be updated each time the TODO status of a child changes, or when pressing
4252 @kbd{C-c C-c} on the cookie. For example:
4255 * Organize Party [33%]
4256 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
4260 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
4263 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4264 If a heading has both checkboxes and TODO children below it, the meaning of
4265 the statistics cookie become ambiguous. Set the property
4266 @code{COOKIE_DATA} to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve
4269 @vindex org-hierarchical-todo-statistics
4270 If you would like to have the statistics cookie count any TODO entries in the
4271 subtree (not just direct children), configure the variable
4272 @code{org-hierarchical-todo-statistics}. To do this for a single subtree,
4273 include the word @samp{recursive} into the value of the @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4277 * Parent capturing statistics [2/20]
4279 :COOKIE_DATA: todo recursive
4283 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE
4284 when all children are done, you can use the following setup:
4287 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
4288 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
4289 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
4290 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
4292 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
4296 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
4297 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
4300 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
4304 @vindex org-list-automatic-rules
4305 Every item in a plain list@footnote{With the exception of description
4306 lists. But you can allow it by modifying @code{org-list-automatic-rules}
4307 accordingly.} (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a checkbox by starting
4308 it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is similar to TODO items
4309 (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight. Checkboxes are not included
4310 into the global TODO list, so they are often great to split a task into a
4311 number of simple steps. Or you can use them in a shopping list. To toggle a
4312 checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's
4313 @file{org-mouse.el}).
4315 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
4318 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
4319 - [-] call people [1/3]
4324 - [ ] think about what music to play
4325 - [X] talk to the neighbors
4328 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
4329 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
4330 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
4333 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
4334 @cindex checkbox statistics
4335 @cindex property, COOKIE_DATA
4336 @vindex org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics
4337 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are cookies
4338 indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been checked off,
4339 and the total number of checkboxes present. This can give you an idea on how
4340 many checkboxes remain, even without opening a folded entry. The cookies can
4341 be placed into a headline or into (the first line of) a plain list item.
4342 Each cookie covers checkboxes of direct children structurally below the
4343 headline/item on which the cookie appears@footnote{Set the variable
4344 @code{org-hierarchical-checkbox-statistics} if you want such cookies to
4345 count all checkboxes below the cookie, not just those belonging to direct
4346 children.}. You have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either
4347 @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m}
4348 result, as in the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about
4349 the percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
4350 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively). In a headline, a cookie can
4351 count either checkboxes below the heading or TODO states of children, and it
4352 will display whatever was changed last. Set the property @code{COOKIE_DATA}
4353 to either @samp{checkbox} or @samp{todo} to resolve this issue.
4355 @cindex blocking, of checkboxes
4356 @cindex checkbox blocking
4357 @cindex property, ORDERED
4358 If the current outline node has an @code{ORDERED} property, checkboxes must
4359 be checked off in sequence, and an error will be thrown if you try to check
4360 off a box while there are unchecked boxes above it.
4362 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
4365 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-toggle-checkbox}
4366 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4367 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4369 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-b,org-toggle-checkbox}
4370 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point. With
4371 double prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]}, which is considered to be an
4375 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
4376 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
4377 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
4379 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
4380 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
4382 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
4384 @orgcmd{M-S-@key{RET},org-insert-todo-heading}
4385 Insert a new item with a checkbox. This works only if the cursor is already
4386 in a plain list item (@pxref{Plain lists}).
4387 @orgcmd{C-c C-x o,org-toggle-ordered-property}
4388 @vindex org-track-ordered-property-with-tag
4389 @cindex property, ORDERED
4390 Toggle the @code{ORDERED} property of the entry, to toggle if checkboxes must
4391 be checked off in sequence. A property is used for this behavior because
4392 this should be local to the current entry, not inherited like a tag.
4393 However, if you would like to @i{track} the value of this property with a tag
4394 for better visibility, customize the variable
4395 @code{org-track-ordered-property-with-tag}.
4396 @orgcmd{C-c #,org-update-statistics-cookies}
4397 Update the statistics cookie in the current outline entry. When called with
4398 a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox statistic cookies are
4399 updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make
4400 new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. TODO statistics cookies update when
4401 changing TODO states. If you delete boxes/entries or add/change them by
4402 hand, use this command to get things back into sync.
4405 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
4408 @cindex headline tagging
4409 @cindex matching, tags
4410 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
4412 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
4413 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org-mode has extensive
4416 @vindex org-tag-faces
4417 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
4418 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
4419 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
4420 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
4421 Tags will by default be in bold face with the same color as the headline.
4422 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
4423 @code{org-tag-faces}, in much the same way as you can for TODO keywords
4424 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
4427 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
4428 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
4429 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
4432 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
4433 @section Tag inheritance
4434 @cindex tag inheritance
4435 @cindex inheritance, of tags
4436 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
4438 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
4439 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
4440 well. For example, in the list
4443 * Meeting with the French group :work:
4444 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
4445 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
4449 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
4450 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
4451 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
4452 a file should inherit just as if these tags were defined in a hypothetical
4453 level zero that surrounds the entire file. Use a line like this@footnote{As
4454 with all these in-buffer settings, pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} activates any
4455 changes in the line.}:
4459 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
4463 @vindex org-use-tag-inheritance
4464 @vindex org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance
4465 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
4466 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
4467 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
4469 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4470 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
4471 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
4472 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
4473 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
4474 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
4475 match in a subtree, configure the variable
4476 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
4478 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
4479 @section Setting tags
4480 @cindex setting tags
4481 @cindex tags, setting
4484 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
4485 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
4486 also a special command for inserting tags:
4489 @orgcmd{C-c C-q,org-set-tags-command}
4490 @cindex completion, of tags
4491 @vindex org-tags-column
4492 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org-mode will either offer
4493 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
4494 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
4495 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
4496 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
4497 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
4498 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
4499 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-set-tags-command}
4500 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
4503 @vindex org-tag-alist
4504 Org supports tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
4505 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
4506 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
4507 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
4508 the default tags for a given file with lines like
4512 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
4513 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
4516 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
4517 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
4518 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
4524 @vindex org-tag-persistent-alist
4525 If you have a preferred set of tags that you would like to use in every file,
4526 in addition to those defined on a per-file basis by TAGS option lines, then
4527 you may specify a list of tags with the variable
4528 @code{org-tag-persistent-alist}. You may turn this off on a per-file basis
4529 by adding a STARTUP option line to that file:
4535 By default Org-mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
4536 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
4537 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
4538 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
4539 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
4540 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
4541 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
4542 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
4546 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
4549 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on, then you
4550 can instead set the TAGS option line as:
4553 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
4556 @noindent The tags interface will show the available tags in a splash
4557 window. If you want to start a new line after a specific tag, insert
4558 @samp{\n} into the tag list
4561 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) \n laptop(l) pc(p)
4564 @noindent or write them in two lines:
4567 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t)
4568 #+TAGS: laptop(l) pc(p)
4572 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive by using
4576 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
4579 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
4580 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
4582 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
4583 these lines to activate any changes.
4586 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-tags-alist},
4587 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
4588 of the braces. Similarly, you can use @code{:newline} to indicate a line
4589 break. The previous example would be set globally by the following
4593 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
4594 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
4595 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
4597 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
4600 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
4601 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
4602 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
4603 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
4604 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
4609 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
4610 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
4611 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
4614 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
4615 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
4616 You can also add several tags: just separate them with a comma.
4620 Clear all tags for this line.
4623 Accept the modified set.
4625 Abort without installing changes.
4627 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
4629 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
4630 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
4632 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
4633 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
4638 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
4639 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
4640 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
4641 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
4642 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
4643 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
4644 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
4645 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
4647 @vindex org-fast-tag-selection-single-key
4648 If you find that most of the time you need only a single key press to
4649 modify your list of tags, set the variable
4650 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
4651 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection---it will immediately exit
4652 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
4653 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
4654 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
4655 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
4656 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
4657 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
4659 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
4660 @section Tag searches
4661 @cindex tag searches
4662 @cindex searching for tags
4664 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
4665 information into special lists.
4668 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \\,org-match-sparse-tree}
4669 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
4670 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4671 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4672 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
4673 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4674 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4675 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4676 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4677 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
4678 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4681 These commands all prompt for a match string which allows basic Boolean logic
4682 like @samp{+boss+urgent-project1}, to find entries with tags @samp{boss} and
4683 @samp{urgent}, but not @samp{project1}, or @samp{Kathy|Sally} to find entries
4684 which are tagged, like @samp{Kathy} or @samp{Sally}. The full syntax of the search
4685 string is rich and allows also matching against TODO keywords, entry levels
4686 and properties. For a complete description with many examples, see
4687 @ref{Matching tags and properties}.
4690 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
4691 @chapter Properties and columns
4694 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
4695 are two main applications for properties in Org-mode. First, properties
4696 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
4697 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
4698 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
4699 you document bugs and plan releases for a piece of software. Instead of
4700 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
4701 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
4702 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
4703 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
4704 where properties could be things such as the album, artist, date of
4705 release, number of tracks, and so on.
4707 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
4708 (@pxref{Column view}).
4711 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
4712 * Special properties:: Access to other Org-mode features
4713 * Property searches:: Matching property values
4714 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
4715 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
4716 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
4719 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
4720 @section Property syntax
4721 @cindex property syntax
4722 @cindex drawer, for properties
4724 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
4725 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
4726 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
4727 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
4732 *** Goldberg Variations
4734 :Title: Goldberg Variations
4735 :Composer: J.S. Bach
4737 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammophon
4742 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
4743 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
4744 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
4745 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4746 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4747 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4748 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4753 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4754 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4758 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4759 file, use a line like
4760 @cindex property, _ALL
4763 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4766 @vindex org-global-properties
4767 Property values set with the global variable
4768 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4772 The following commands help to work with properties:
4775 @orgcmd{M-@key{TAB},pcomplete}
4776 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4777 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4778 @orgcmd{C-c C-x p,org-set-property}
4779 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4780 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4781 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4782 @findex org-insert-property-drawer
4783 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4784 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4785 information like deadlines.
4786 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-property-action}
4787 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4788 @orgcmd{C-c C-c s,org-set-property}
4789 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4790 can be inserted using completion.
4791 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{right},S-@key{left},org-property-next-allowed-value,org-property-previous-allowed-value}
4792 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4793 @orgcmd{C-c C-c d,org-delete-property}
4794 Remove a property from the current entry.
4795 @orgcmd{C-c C-c D,org-delete-property-globally}
4796 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4797 @orgcmd{C-c C-c c,org-compute-property-at-point}
4798 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4799 nearest column format definition.
4802 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4803 @section Special properties
4804 @cindex properties, special
4806 Special properties provide an alternative access method to Org-mode features,
4807 like the TODO state or the priority of an entry, discussed in the previous
4808 chapters. This interface exists so that you can include these states in a
4809 column view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in queries. The following
4810 property names are special and (except for @code{:CATEGORY:}) should not be
4811 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4813 @cindex property, special, TODO
4814 @cindex property, special, TAGS
4815 @cindex property, special, ALLTAGS
4816 @cindex property, special, CATEGORY
4817 @cindex property, special, PRIORITY
4818 @cindex property, special, DEADLINE
4819 @cindex property, special, SCHEDULED
4820 @cindex property, special, CLOSED
4821 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP
4822 @cindex property, special, TIMESTAMP_IA
4823 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
4824 @cindex property, special, BLOCKED
4825 @c guessing that ITEM is needed in this area; also, should this list be sorted?
4826 @cindex property, special, ITEM
4827 @cindex property, special, FILE
4829 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4830 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4831 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4832 CATEGORY @r{The category of an entry.}
4833 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4834 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4835 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling timestamp, without the angular brackets.}
4836 CLOSED @r{When was this entry closed?}
4837 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less timestamp in the entry.}
4838 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive timestamp in the entry.}
4839 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4840 @r{must be run first to compute the values in the current buffer.}
4841 BLOCKED @r{"t" if task is currently blocked by children or siblings}
4842 ITEM @r{The content of the entry.}
4843 FILE @r{The filename the entry is located in.}
4846 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4847 @section Property searches
4848 @cindex properties, searching
4849 @cindex searching, of properties
4851 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4852 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}).
4854 @orgcmdkkc{C-c / m,C-c \,org-match-sparse-tree}
4855 Create a sparse tree with all matching entries. With a
4856 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
4857 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
4858 Create a global list of tag/property matches from all agenda files.
4859 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
4860 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
4861 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
4862 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
4863 only TODO items and force checking of subitems (see variable
4864 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
4867 The syntax for the search string is described in @ref{Matching tags and
4870 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4875 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4876 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4877 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4878 value. If you enclose the value in curly braces, it is interpreted as
4879 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4882 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4883 @section Property Inheritance
4884 @cindex properties, inheritance
4885 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4887 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
4888 The outline structure of Org-mode documents lends itself to an
4889 inheritance model of properties: if the parent in a tree has a certain
4890 property, the children can inherit this property. Org-mode does not
4891 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4892 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4893 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4894 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t} to make
4895 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4896 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4897 inherited properties. If a property has the value @samp{nil}, this is
4898 interpreted as an explicit undefine of the property, so that inheritance
4899 search will stop at this value and return @code{nil}.
4901 Org-mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4902 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4904 @cindex property, COLUMNS
4907 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4908 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4909 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4910 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4911 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4913 @cindex property, CATEGORY
4914 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4915 applies to the entire subtree.
4917 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
4918 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4919 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4921 @cindex property, LOGGING
4922 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4923 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4926 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4927 @section Column view
4929 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4930 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline node is turned into a
4931 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4932 entries. Org-mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4933 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4934 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4935 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4936 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4937 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4938 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4939 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4940 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4941 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4944 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4945 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4946 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4949 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4950 @subsection Defining columns
4951 @cindex column view, for properties
4952 @cindex properties, column view
4954 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4955 done by defining a column format line.
4958 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4959 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4962 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4963 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4965 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4969 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4972 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4973 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4976 ** Top node for columns view
4978 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4982 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4983 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4984 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4985 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4986 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4987 deeper part of the tree.
4989 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4990 @subsubsection Column attributes
4991 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4992 definition looks like this:
4995 %[@var{width}]@var{property}[(@var{title})][@{@var{summary-type}@}]
4999 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
5000 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
5003 @var{width} @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
5004 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
5005 @var{property} @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
5006 @r{Special properties representing meta data are allowed here}
5007 @r{as well (@pxref{Special properties})}
5008 @var{title} @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the property}
5010 @{@var{summary-type}@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
5011 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
5012 @r{Supported summary types are:}
5013 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
5014 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
5015 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
5016 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM, plain numbers are hours.}
5017 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[X]} if all children are @samp{[X]}.}
5018 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n/m]}.}
5019 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, @samp{[n%]}.}
5020 @{min@} @r{Smallest number in column.}
5021 @{max@} @r{Largest number.}
5022 @{mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of numbers.}
5023 @{:min@} @r{Smallest time value in column.}
5024 @{:max@} @r{Largest time value.}
5025 @{:mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of time values.}
5026 @{@@min@} @r{Minimum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5027 @{@@max@} @r{Maximum age (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5028 @{@@mean@} @r{Arithmetic mean of ages (in days/hours/mins/seconds).}
5029 @{est+@} @r{Add low-high estimates.}
5033 Be aware that you can only have one summary type for any property you
5034 include. Subsequent columns referencing the same property will all display the
5035 same summary information.
5037 The @code{est+} summary type requires further explanation. It is used for
5038 combining estimates, expressed as low-high ranges. For example, instead
5039 of estimating a particular task will take 5 days, you might estimate it as
5040 5-6 days if you're fairly confident you know how much work is required, or
5041 1-10 days if you don't really know what needs to be done. Both ranges
5042 average at 5.5 days, but the first represents a more predictable delivery.
5044 When combining a set of such estimates, simply adding the lows and highs
5045 produces an unrealistically wide result. Instead, @code{est+} adds the
5046 statistical mean and variance of the sub-tasks, generating a final estimate
5047 from the sum. For example, suppose you had ten tasks, each of which was
5048 estimated at 0.5 to 2 days of work. Straight addition produces an estimate
5049 of 5 to 20 days, representing what to expect if everything goes either
5050 extremely well or extremely poorly. In contrast, @code{est+} estimates the
5051 full job more realistically, at 10-15 days.
5053 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
5057 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line---it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
5058 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5059 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
5060 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
5061 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
5065 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
5066 item itself, i.e.@: of the headline. You probably always should start the
5067 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
5068 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
5069 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
5070 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
5071 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
5072 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
5073 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
5074 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
5075 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
5076 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
5077 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
5080 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
5081 @subsection Using column view
5084 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
5085 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-columns}
5086 @vindex org-columns-default-format
5087 Turn on column view. If the cursor is before the first headline in the file,
5088 column view is turned on for the entire file, using the @code{#+COLUMNS}
5089 definition. If the cursor is somewhere inside the outline, this command
5090 searches the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that
5091 defines a format. When one is found, the column view table is established
5092 for the tree starting at the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
5093 property. If no such property is found, the format is taken from the
5094 @code{#+COLUMNS} line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format},
5095 and column view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
5096 @orgcmd{r,org-columns-redo}
5097 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
5098 @orgcmd{g,org-columns-redo}
5100 @orgcmd{q,org-columns-quit}
5102 @tsubheading{Editing values}
5103 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
5104 Move through the column view from field to field.
5105 @kindex S-@key{left}
5106 @kindex S-@key{right}
5107 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
5108 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
5109 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
5111 Directly select the Nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
5112 @orgcmdkkcc{n,p,org-columns-next-allowed-value,org-columns-previous-allowed-value}
5113 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
5114 @orgcmd{e,org-columns-edit-value}
5115 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
5116 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
5117 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
5118 or fast selection interface will pop up.
5119 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-columns-set-tags-or-toggle}
5120 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
5121 @orgcmd{v,org-columns-show-value}
5122 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
5123 the column is smaller than that of the value.
5124 @orgcmd{a,org-columns-edit-allowed}
5125 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
5126 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
5127 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
5128 current column view.
5129 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
5130 @orgcmdkkcc{<,>,org-columns-narrow,org-columns-widen}
5131 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
5132 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{right},org-columns-new}
5133 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
5134 @orgcmd{S-M-@key{left},org-columns-delete}
5135 Delete the current column.
5138 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
5139 @subsection Capturing column view
5141 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
5142 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
5143 a @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
5144 of this block looks like this:
5146 @cindex #+BEGIN, columnview
5149 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
5154 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
5158 This is the most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
5159 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
5160 at a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
5161 capture, you can use 4 values:
5162 @cindex property, ID
5164 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
5165 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
5166 "file:@var{path-to-file}"
5167 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
5168 "@var{ID}" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
5169 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
5170 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
5171 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
5174 When @code{t}, insert an hline after every line. When a number @var{N}, insert
5175 an hline before each headline with level @code{<= @var{N}}.
5177 When set to @code{t}, force column groups to get vertical lines.
5179 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
5180 @item :skip-empty-rows
5181 When set to @code{t}, skip rows where the only non-empty specifier of the
5182 column view is @code{ITEM}.
5187 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
5190 @orgcmd{C-c C-x i,org-insert-columns-dblock}
5191 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
5192 for the scope or ID of the view.
5193 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5194 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5195 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5196 @orgcmd{C-u C-c C-x C-u,org-update-all-dblocks}
5197 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5198 you have several clock table blocks, column-capturing blocks or other dynamic
5202 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
5203 instructions in front of the table---these will survive an update of the
5204 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
5205 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
5207 An alternative way to capture and process property values into a table is
5208 provided by Eric Schulte's @file{org-collector.el} which is a contributed
5209 package@footnote{Contributed packages are not part of Emacs, but are
5210 distributed with the main distribution of Org (visit
5211 @uref{http://orgmode.org}).}. It provides a general API to collect
5212 properties from entries in a certain scope, and arbitrary Lisp expressions to
5213 process these values before inserting them into a table or a dynamic block.
5215 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
5216 @section The Property API
5217 @cindex properties, API
5218 @cindex API, for properties
5220 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
5221 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
5222 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
5225 @node Dates and Times, Capture - Refile - Archive, Properties and Columns, Top
5226 @chapter Dates and times
5232 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
5233 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
5234 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org-mode. This may be a
5235 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
5236 something was created or last changed. However, in Org-mode this term
5237 is used in a much wider sense.
5240 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
5241 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
5242 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
5243 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
5244 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
5245 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
5246 * Countdown timer:: Starting a countdown timer for a task
5250 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
5251 @section Timestamps, deadlines, and scheduling
5253 @cindex ranges, time
5258 A timestamp is a specification of a date (possibly with a time or a range of
5259 times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
5260 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
5261 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is inspired by the standard ISO 8601 date/time
5262 format. To use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A
5263 timestamp can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry.
5264 Its presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
5265 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
5268 @item Plain timestamp; Event; Appointment
5270 A simple timestamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
5271 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
5272 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
5273 plain timestamp will be shown exactly on that date.
5276 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
5277 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
5280 @item Timestamp with repeater interval
5281 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
5282 A timestamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
5283 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
5284 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months (m), or years (y). The
5285 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
5288 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
5291 @item Diary-style sexp entries
5292 For more complex date specifications, Org-mode supports using the special
5293 sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
5294 package@footnote{When working with the standard diary sexp functions, you
5295 need to be very careful with the order of the arguments. That order depend
5296 evilly on the variable @code{calendar-date-style} (or, for older Emacs
5297 versions, @code{european-calendar-style}). For example, to specify a date
5298 December 12, 2005, the call might look like @code{(diary-date 12 1 2005)} or
5299 @code{(diary-date 1 12 2005)} or @code{(diary-date 2005 12 1)}, depending on
5300 the settings. This has been the source of much confusion. Org-mode users
5301 can resort to special versions of these functions like @code{org-date} or
5302 @code{org-anniversary}. These work just like the corresponding @code{diary-}
5303 functions, but with stable ISO order of arguments (year, month, day) wherever
5304 applicable, independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.}. For example
5307 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
5308 <%%(org-float t 4 2)>
5311 @item Time/Date range
5314 Two timestamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
5315 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
5316 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
5319 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
5320 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
5323 @item Inactive timestamp
5324 @cindex timestamp, inactive
5325 @cindex inactive timestamp
5326 Just like a plain timestamp, but with square brackets instead of
5327 angular ones. These timestamps are inactive in the sense that they do
5328 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
5331 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
5336 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
5337 @section Creating timestamps
5338 @cindex creating timestamps
5339 @cindex timestamps, creating
5341 For Org-mode to recognize timestamps, they need to be in the specific
5342 format. All commands listed below produce timestamps in the correct
5346 @orgcmd{C-c .,org-time-stamp}
5347 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding timestamp. When the cursor is
5348 at an existing timestamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
5349 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
5350 succession, a time range is inserted.
5352 @orgcmd{C-c !,org-time-stamp-inactive}
5353 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive timestamp that will not cause
5360 @vindex org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes
5361 Like @kbd{C-c .} and @kbd{C-c !}, but use the alternative format which
5362 contains date and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5
5363 minutes, see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
5365 @orgcmd{C-c <,org-date-from-calendar}
5366 Insert a timestamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
5368 @orgcmd{C-c >,org-goto-calendar}
5369 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
5370 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
5373 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-open-at-point}
5374 Access the agenda for the date given by the timestamp or -range at
5375 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5377 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-timestamp-down-day,org-timestamp-up-day}
5378 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
5379 shift-selection and related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5381 @orgcmdkkcc{S-@key{up},S-@key{down},org-timestamp-up,org-timestamp-down-down}
5382 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
5383 year, month, day, hour or minute. When the timestamp contains a time range
5384 like @samp{15:30-16:30}, modifying the first time will also shift the second,
5385 shifting the time block with constant length. To change the length, modify
5386 the second time. Note that if the cursor is in a headline and not at a
5387 timestamp, these same keys modify the priority of an item.
5388 (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with shift-selection and
5389 related modes (@pxref{Conflicts}).
5391 @orgcmd{C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5392 @cindex evaluate time range
5393 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
5394 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
5395 the following column).
5400 * The date/time prompt:: How Org-mode helps you entering date and time
5401 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
5404 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
5405 @subsection The date/time prompt
5406 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
5407 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
5409 @vindex org-read-date-prefer-future
5410 When Org-mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown in default
5411 date/time format, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for a specific
5412 format. But it will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or
5413 time information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
5414 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
5415 copied from an email message. Org-mode will find whatever information is in
5416 there and derive anything you have not specified from the @emph{default date
5417 and time}. The default is usually the current date and time, but when
5418 modifying an existing timestamp, or when entering the second stamp of a
5419 range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer. When filling in
5420 information, Org-mode assumes that most of the time you will want to enter a
5421 date in the future: if you omit the month/year and the given day/month is
5422 @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a future date@footnote{See the
5423 variable @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}. You may set that variable to
5424 the symbol @code{time} to even make a time before now shift the date to
5425 tomorrow.}. If the date has been automatically shifted into the future, the
5426 time prompt will show this with @samp{(=>F).}
5428 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
5429 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org-mode are
5433 3-2-5 @result{} 2003-02-05
5434 2/5/3 @result{} 2003-02-05
5435 14 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
5436 12 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
5437 2/5 @result{} @b{2007}-02-05
5438 Fri @result{} nearest Friday (default date or later)
5439 sep 15 @result{} @b{2006}-09-15
5440 feb 15 @result{} @b{2007}-02-15
5441 sep 12 9 @result{} 2009-09-12
5442 12:45 @result{} @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
5443 22 sept 0:34 @result{} @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
5444 w4 @result{} ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
5445 2012 w4 fri @result{} Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
5446 2012-w04-5 @result{} Same as above
5449 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
5450 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
5451 letter ([dwmy]) to indicate change in days, weeks, months, or years. With a
5452 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
5453 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
5454 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
5455 the Nth such day, e.g.@:
5460 +4d @result{} four days from today
5461 +4 @result{} same as above
5462 +2w @result{} two weeks from today
5463 ++5 @result{} five days from default date
5464 +2tue @result{} second Tuesday from now.
5467 @vindex parse-time-months
5468 @vindex parse-time-weekdays
5469 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
5470 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
5471 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
5473 @vindex org-read-date-force-compatible-dates
5474 Not all dates can be represented in a given Emacs implementation. By default
5475 Org mode forces dates into the compatibility range 1970--2037 which works on
5476 all Emacs implementations. If you want to use dates outside of this range,
5477 read the docstring of the variable
5478 @code{org-read-date-force-compatible-dates}.
5480 You can specify a time range by giving start and end times or by giving a
5481 start time and a duration (in HH:MM format). Use one or two dash(es) as the
5482 separator in the former case and use '+' as the separator in the latter
5486 11am-1:15pm @result{} 11:00-13:15
5487 11am--1:15pm @result{} same as above
5488 11am+2:15 @result{} same as above
5491 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
5492 @vindex org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt
5493 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
5494 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
5495 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
5496 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
5497 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
5498 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
5499 from the minibuffer:
5506 @kindex S-@key{right}
5507 @kindex S-@key{left}
5508 @kindex S-@key{down}
5510 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
5511 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
5514 @key{RET} @r{Choose date at cursor in calendar.}
5515 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
5516 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
5517 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
5518 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
5519 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
5520 M-v / C-v @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by 3 months.}
5523 @vindex org-read-date-display-live
5524 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
5525 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
5526 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
5527 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
5528 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
5529 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
5531 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
5532 @subsection Custom time format
5533 @cindex custom date/time format
5534 @cindex time format, custom
5535 @cindex date format, custom
5537 @vindex org-display-custom-times
5538 @vindex org-time-stamp-custom-formats
5539 Org-mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
5540 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
5541 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
5542 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
5543 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
5546 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-t,org-toggle-time-stamp-overlays}
5547 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
5551 Org-mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
5552 format does not @emph{replace} the default format---instead it is put
5553 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
5554 following consequences:
5557 You cannot place the cursor onto a timestamp anymore, only before or
5560 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
5561 each component of a timestamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
5562 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
5563 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
5564 time will be changed by one minute.
5566 If the timestamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
5567 will not be overlaid, but remain in the buffer as they were.
5569 When you delete a timestamp character-by-character, it will only
5570 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
5571 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
5573 If the custom timestamp format is longer than the default and you are
5574 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
5575 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
5579 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
5580 @section Deadlines and scheduling
5582 A timestamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
5586 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
5588 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
5589 to be finished on that date.
5591 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5592 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
5593 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
5594 approaching or missed deadline, starting
5595 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
5596 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
5599 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
5600 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
5601 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
5604 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
5605 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
5606 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
5609 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
5611 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
5614 @vindex org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done
5615 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
5616 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
5617 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
5618 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
5619 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE, i.e.@:
5620 the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
5623 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
5624 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
5628 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org-mode should @i{not} be
5629 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
5630 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
5631 mark this entry with a simple plain timestamp, to get this item shown
5632 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent misunderstanding by
5633 Org users. In Org-mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
5634 want to start working on an action item.
5637 You may use timestamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
5638 entries. Org-mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
5639 assumption that the timestamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
5640 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
5642 @code{<%%(org-float t 42)>}
5644 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org-mode does not
5645 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
5646 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
5650 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
5651 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
5654 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
5655 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
5657 The following commands allow you to quickly insert@footnote{The @samp{SCHEDULED} and
5658 @samp{DEADLINE} dates are inserted on the line right below the headline. Don't put
5659 any text between this line and the headline.} a deadline or to schedule
5664 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-deadline}
5665 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will happen
5666 in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp will be
5667 removed. When called with a prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed
5668 from the entry. Depending on the variable @code{org-log-redeadline}@footnote{with corresponding
5669 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logredeadline}, @code{lognoteredeadline},
5670 and @code{nologredeadline}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5673 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-schedule}
5674 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
5675 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED timestamp
5676 will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove the scheduling
5677 date from the entry. Depending on the variable
5678 @code{org-log-reschedule}@footnote{with corresponding @code{#+STARTUP}
5679 keywords @code{logreschedule}, @code{lognotereschedule}, and
5680 @code{nologreschedule}}, a note will be taken when changing an existing
5683 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-k,org-mark-entry-for-agenda-action}
5686 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
5687 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
5688 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
5689 schedule the marked item.
5691 @orgcmd{C-c / d,org-check-deadlines}
5692 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
5693 @vindex org-deadline-warning-days
5694 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
5695 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
5696 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
5697 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
5698 all deadlines due tomorrow.
5700 @orgcmd{C-c / b,org-check-before-date}
5701 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items before a given date.
5703 @orgcmd{C-c / a,org-check-after-date}
5704 Sparse tree for deadlines and scheduled items after a given date.
5707 Note that @code{org-schedule} and @code{org-deadline} supports
5708 setting the date by indicating a relative time: e.g. +1d will set
5709 the date to the next day after today, and --1w will set the date
5710 to the previous week before any current timestamp.
5712 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
5713 @subsection Repeated tasks
5714 @cindex tasks, repeated
5715 @cindex repeated tasks
5717 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org-mode helps to
5718 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
5719 or plain timestamp. In the following example
5721 ** TODO Pay the rent
5722 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
5725 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the task
5726 has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month starting
5727 from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special warning period in
5728 a deadline entry, the repeater should come first and the warning period last:
5729 @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
5731 @vindex org-todo-repeat-to-state
5732 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they are
5733 over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as completed
5734 once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE with the TODO
5735 keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the agenda. The problem
5736 with this is, however, that then also the @emph{next} instance of the
5737 repeated entry will not be active. Org-mode deals with this in the following
5738 way: When you try to mark such an entry DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will
5739 shift the base date of the repeating timestamp by the repeater interval, and
5740 immediately set the entry state back to TODO@footnote{In fact, the target
5741 state is taken from, in this sequence, the @code{REPEAT_TO_STATE} property or
5742 the variable @code{org-todo-repeat-to-state}. If neither of these is
5743 specified, the target state defaults to the first state of the TODO state
5744 sequence.}. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would actually
5745 switch the date like this:
5748 ** TODO Pay the rent
5749 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
5752 @vindex org-log-repeat
5753 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
5754 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
5755 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
5756 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
5757 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
5759 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
5760 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
5763 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
5764 month. So if you have not paid the rent for three months, marking this
5765 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
5766 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
5767 forgot to call your father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
5768 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
5769 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
5770 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org-mode has
5771 special repeaters @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
5775 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
5776 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
5777 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
5778 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
5779 and marked it done on Saturday.
5780 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
5781 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
5782 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
5786 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
5787 task---just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
5789 An alternative to using a repeater is to create a number of copies of a task
5790 subtree, with dates shifted in each copy. The command @kbd{C-c C-x c} was
5791 created for this purpose, it is described in @ref{Structure editing}.
5794 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
5795 @section Clocking work time
5796 @cindex clocking time
5797 @cindex time clocking
5799 Org-mode allows you to clock the time you spend on specific tasks in a
5800 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
5801 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
5802 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
5803 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project. And it
5804 remembers a history or tasks recently clocked, to that you can jump quickly
5805 between a number of tasks absorbing your time.
5807 To save the clock history across Emacs sessions, use
5809 (setq org-clock-persist 'history)
5810 (org-clock-persistence-insinuate)
5812 When you clock into a new task after resuming Emacs, the incomplete
5813 clock@footnote{To resume the clock under the assumption that you have worked
5814 on this task while outside Emacs, use @code{(setq org-clock-persist t)}.}
5815 will be found (@pxref{Resolving idle time}) and you will be prompted about
5819 * Clocking commands:: Starting and stopping a clock
5820 * The clock table:: Detailed reports
5821 * Resolving idle time:: Resolving time when you've been idle
5824 @node Clocking commands, The clock table, Clocking work time, Clocking work time
5825 @subsection Clocking commands
5828 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-i,org-clock-in}
5829 @vindex org-clock-into-drawer
5830 @cindex property, LOG_INTO_DRAWER
5831 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
5832 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
5833 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
5834 @code{:LOGBOOK:} drawer (see also the variable
5835 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). You can also overrule
5836 the setting of this variable for a subtree by setting a
5837 @code{CLOCK_INTO_DRAWER} or @code{LOG_INTO_DRAWER} property.
5838 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
5839 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
5840 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
5841 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
5842 with letter @kbd{d}.@*
5843 @cindex property: CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL
5844 @cindex property: LAST_REPEAT
5845 @vindex org-clock-modeline-total
5846 While the clock is running, the current clocking time is shown in the mode
5847 line, along with the title of the task. The clock time shown will be all
5848 time ever clocked for this task and its children. If the task has an effort
5849 estimate (@pxref{Effort estimates}), the mode line displays the current
5850 clocking time against it@footnote{To add an effort estimate ``on the fly'',
5851 hook a function doing this to @code{org-clock-in-prepare-hook}.} If the task
5852 is a repeating one (@pxref{Repeated tasks}), only the time since the last
5853 reset of the task @footnote{as recorded by the @code{LAST_REPEAT} property}
5854 will be shown. More control over what time is shown can be exercised with
5855 the @code{CLOCK_MODELINE_TOTAL} property. It may have the values
5856 @code{current} to show only the current clocking instance, @code{today} to
5857 show all time clocked on this tasks today (see also the variable
5858 @code{org-extend-today-until}), @code{all} to include all time, or
5859 @code{auto} which is the default@footnote{See also the variable
5860 @code{org-clock-modeline-total}.}.@* Clicking with @kbd{mouse-1} onto the
5861 mode line entry will pop up a menu with clocking options.
5863 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-o,org-clock-out}
5864 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
5865 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
5866 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
5867 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
5868 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
5869 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
5870 timestamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
5871 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
5872 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
5873 Update the effort estimate for the current clock task.
5876 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-y,org-evaluate-time-range}
5877 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the timestamps. This
5878 is only necessary if you edit the timestamps directly. If you change
5879 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
5880 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{up/down},org-clock-timestamps-up/down}
5881 On @code{CLOCK} log lines, increase/decrease both timestamps at the same
5882 time so that duration keeps the same.
5883 @orgcmd{C-c C-t,org-todo}
5884 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
5885 if it is running in this same item.
5886 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-x,org-clock-cancel}
5887 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
5888 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
5889 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-j,org-clock-goto}
5890 Jump to the headline of the currently clocked in task. With a @kbd{C-u}
5891 prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked tasks.
5892 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-d,org-clock-display}
5893 @vindex org-remove-highlights-with-change
5894 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This puts
5895 overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time recorded under
5896 that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You can use visibility
5897 cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear when you change the
5898 buffer (see variable @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press
5902 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5903 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5904 worked on or closed during a day.
5906 @node The clock table, Resolving idle time, Clocking commands, Clocking work time
5907 @subsection The clock table
5908 @cindex clocktable, dynamic block
5909 @cindex report, of clocked time
5911 Org mode can produce quite complex reports based on the time clocking
5912 information. Such a report is called a @emph{clock table}, because it is
5913 formatted as one or several Org tables.
5916 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-r,org-clock-report}
5917 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5918 report as an Org-mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5919 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5920 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5922 @orgcmdkkc{C-c C-c,C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
5923 Update dynamic block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5924 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5925 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
5926 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5927 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5928 @orgcmdkxkc{S-@key{left},S-@key{right},org-clocktable-try-shift}
5929 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5930 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5931 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5935 Here is an example of the frame for a clock table as it is inserted into the
5936 buffer with the @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} command:
5938 @cindex #+BEGIN, clocktable
5940 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5944 @vindex org-clocktable-defaults
5945 The @samp{BEGIN} line and specify a number of options to define the scope,
5946 structure, and formatting of the report. Defaults for all these options can
5947 be configured in the variable @code{org-clocktable-defaults}.
5949 @noindent First there are options that determine which clock entries are to
5952 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5953 @r{Clocks at deeper levels will be summed into the upper level.}
5954 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5955 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5956 file @r{the full current buffer}
5957 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5958 tree@var{N} @r{the surrounding level @var{N} tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5959 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5960 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5961 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5962 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5963 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5964 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5965 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5967 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5968 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5969 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5970 2007-Q2 @r{2nd quarter in 2007}
5971 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5972 today, yesterday, today-@var{N} @r{a relative day}
5973 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-@var{N} @r{a relative week}
5974 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-@var{N} @r{a relative month}
5975 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-@var{N} @r{a relative year}
5976 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5977 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times.}
5978 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times.}
5979 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5980 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5981 :stepskip0 @r{Do not show steps that have zero time.}
5982 :fileskip0 @r{Do not show table sections from files which did not contribute.}
5983 :tags @r{A tags match to select entries that should contribute. See}
5984 @r{@ref{Matching tags and properties} for the match syntax.}
5987 Then there are options which determine the formatting of the table. There
5988 options are interpreted by the function @code{org-clocktable-write-default},
5989 but you can specify your own function using the @code{:formatter} parameter.
5991 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items.}
5992 :lang @r{Language@footnote{Language terms can be set through the variable @code{org-clock-clocktable-language-setup}.} to use for descriptive cells like "Task".}
5993 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins.}
5994 :narrow @r{An integer to limit the width of the headline column in}
5995 @r{the org table. If you write it like @samp{50!}, then the}
5996 @r{headline will also be shortened in export.}
5997 :indent @r{Indent each headline field according to its level.}
5998 :tcolumns @r{Number of columns to be used for times. If this is smaller}
5999 @r{than @code{:maxlevel}, lower levels will be lumped into one column.}
6000 :level @r{Should a level number column be included?}
6001 :compact @r{Abbreviation for @code{:level nil :indent t :narrow 40! :tcolumns 1}}
6002 @r{All are overwritten except if there is an explicit @code{:narrow}}
6003 :timestamp @r{A timestamp for the entry, when available. Look for SCHEDULED,}
6004 @r{DEADLINE, TIMESTAMP and TIMESTAMP_IA, in this order.}
6005 :properties @r{List of properties that should be shown in the table. Each}
6006 @r{property will get its own column.}
6007 :inherit-props @r{When this flag is @code{t}, the values for @code{:properties} will be inherited.}
6008 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
6009 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds a column with % time.}
6010 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
6011 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
6012 :formatter @r{A function to format clock data and insert it into the buffer.}
6014 To get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
6015 day, you could write
6017 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
6021 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
6022 parameters must be specified in a single line---the line is broken here
6023 only to fit it into the manual.}
6025 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
6026 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
6029 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
6031 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
6034 A horizontally compact representation of everything clocked during last week
6037 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope agenda :block lastweek :compact t
6041 @node Resolving idle time, , The clock table, Clocking work time
6042 @subsection Resolving idle time
6043 @cindex resolve idle time
6045 @cindex idle, resolve, dangling
6046 If you clock in on a work item, and then walk away from your
6047 computer---perhaps to take a phone call---you often need to ``resolve'' the
6048 time you were away by either subtracting it from the current clock, or
6049 applying it to another one.
6051 @vindex org-clock-idle-time
6052 By customizing the variable @code{org-clock-idle-time} to some integer, such
6053 as 10 or 15, Emacs can alert you when you get back to your computer after
6054 being idle for that many minutes@footnote{On computers using Mac OS X,
6055 idleness is based on actual user idleness, not just Emacs' idle time. For
6056 X11, you can install a utility program @file{x11idle.c}, available in the
6057 UTILITIES directory of the Org git distribution, to get the same general
6058 treatment of idleness. On other systems, idle time refers to Emacs idle time
6059 only.}, and ask what you want to do with the idle time. There will be a
6060 question waiting for you when you get back, indicating how much idle time has
6061 passed (constantly updated with the current amount), as well as a set of
6062 choices to correct the discrepancy:
6066 To keep some or all of the minutes and stay clocked in, press @kbd{k}. Org
6067 will ask how many of the minutes to keep. Press @key{RET} to keep them all,
6068 effectively changing nothing, or enter a number to keep that many minutes.
6070 If you use the shift key and press @kbd{K}, it will keep however many minutes
6071 you request and then immediately clock out of that task. If you keep all of
6072 the minutes, this is the same as just clocking out of the current task.
6074 To keep none of the minutes, use @kbd{s} to subtract all the away time from
6075 the clock, and then check back in from the moment you returned.
6077 To keep none of the minutes and just clock out at the start of the away time,
6078 use the shift key and press @kbd{S}. Remember that using shift will always
6079 leave you clocked out, no matter which option you choose.
6081 To cancel the clock altogether, use @kbd{C}. Note that if instead of
6082 canceling you subtract the away time, and the resulting clock amount is less
6083 than a minute, the clock will still be canceled rather than clutter up the
6084 log with an empty entry.
6087 What if you subtracted those away minutes from the current clock, and now
6088 want to apply them to a new clock? Simply clock in to any task immediately
6089 after the subtraction. Org will notice that you have subtracted time ``on
6090 the books'', so to speak, and will ask if you want to apply those minutes to
6091 the next task you clock in on.
6093 There is one other instance when this clock resolution magic occurs. Say you
6094 were clocked in and hacking away, and suddenly your cat chased a mouse who
6095 scared a hamster that crashed into your UPS's power button! You suddenly
6096 lose all your buffers, but thanks to auto-save you still have your recent Org
6097 mode changes, including your last clock in.
6099 If you restart Emacs and clock into any task, Org will notice that you have a
6100 dangling clock which was never clocked out from your last session. Using
6101 that clock's starting time as the beginning of the unaccounted-for period,
6102 Org will ask how you want to resolve that time. The logic and behavior is
6103 identical to dealing with away time due to idleness; it is just happening due
6104 to a recovery event rather than a set amount of idle time.
6106 You can also check all the files visited by your Org agenda for dangling
6107 clocks at any time using @kbd{M-x org-resolve-clocks}.
6109 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
6110 @section Effort estimates
6111 @cindex effort estimates
6113 @cindex property, Effort
6114 @vindex org-effort-property
6115 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
6116 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
6117 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
6118 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
6119 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
6120 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
6121 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. You can set the effort
6122 for an entry with the following commands:
6125 @orgcmd{C-c C-x e,org-set-effort}
6126 Set the effort estimate for the current entry. With a numeric prefix
6127 argument, set it to the Nth allowed value (see below). This command is also
6128 accessible from the agenda with the @kbd{e} key.
6129 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-e,org-clock-modify-effort-estimate}
6130 Modify the effort estimate of the item currently being clocked.
6133 Clearly the best way to work with effort estimates is through column view
6134 (@pxref{Column view}). You should start by setting up discrete values for
6135 effort estimates, and a @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values
6136 together with clock sums (if you want to clock your time). For a specific
6140 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00
6141 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
6145 @vindex org-global-properties
6146 @vindex org-columns-default-format
6147 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
6148 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
6149 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
6150 setup may be advised.
6152 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
6153 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
6154 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
6155 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
6157 @vindex org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum
6158 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
6159 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
6160 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
6161 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
6162 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
6163 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
6164 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
6165 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
6167 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
6168 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
6169 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
6170 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
6172 @node Relative timer, Countdown timer, Effort estimates, Dates and Times
6173 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
6174 @cindex relative timer
6176 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
6177 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
6178 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
6181 @orgcmd{C-c C-x .,org-timer}
6182 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
6183 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
6185 @orgcmd{C-c C-x -,org-timer-item}
6186 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
6187 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
6188 @orgcmd{M-@key{RET},org-insert-heading}
6189 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
6191 @c for key sequences with a comma, command name macros fail :(
6194 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused
6195 (@command{org-timer-pause-or-continue}).
6196 @c removed the sentence because it is redundant to the following item
6197 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
6199 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
6200 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
6201 @orgcmd{C-c C-x 0,org-timer-start}
6202 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
6203 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
6204 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
6205 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
6206 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
6207 prefix argument @kbd{C-u C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
6208 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
6209 not started at exactly the right moment.
6212 @node Countdown timer, , Relative timer, Dates and Times
6213 @section Countdown timer
6214 @cindex Countdown timer
6218 Calling @code{org-timer-set-timer} from an Org-mode buffer runs a countdown
6219 timer. Use @kbd{;} from agenda buffers, @key{C-c C-x ;} everwhere else.
6221 @code{org-timer-set-timer} prompts the user for a duration and displays a
6222 countdown timer in the modeline. @code{org-timer-default-timer} sets the
6223 default countdown value. Giving a prefix numeric argument overrides this
6226 @node Capture - Refile - Archive, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
6227 @chapter Capture - Refile - Archive
6230 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
6231 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
6232 Org does this using a process called @i{capture}. It also can store files
6233 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory. Once in the
6234 system, tasks and projects need to be moved around. Moving completed project
6235 trees to an archive file keeps the system compact and fast.
6238 * Capture:: Capturing new stuff
6239 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks
6240 * RSS Feeds:: Getting input from RSS feeds
6241 * Protocols:: External (e.g.@: Browser) access to Emacs and Org
6242 * Refiling notes:: Moving a tree from one place to another
6243 * Archiving:: What to do with finished projects
6246 @node Capture, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive, Capture - Refile - Archive
6250 Org's method for capturing new items is heavily inspired by John Wiegley
6251 excellent remember package. Up to version 6.36 Org used a special setup
6252 for @file{remember.el}. @file{org-remember.el} is still part of Org-mode for
6253 backward compatibility with existing setups. You can find the documentation
6254 for org-remember at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-remember.pdf}.
6256 The new capturing setup described here is preferred and should be used by new
6257 users. To convert your @code{org-remember-templates}, run the command
6259 @kbd{M-x org-capture-import-remember-templates @key{RET}}
6261 @noindent and then customize the new variable with @kbd{M-x
6262 customize-variable org-capture-templates}, check the result, and save the
6263 customization. You can then use both remember and capture until
6264 you are familiar with the new mechanism.
6266 Capture lets you quickly store notes with little interruption of your work
6267 flow. The basic process of capturing is very similar to remember, but Org
6268 does enhance it with templates and more.
6271 * Setting up capture:: Where notes will be stored
6272 * Using capture:: Commands to invoke and terminate capture
6273 * Capture templates:: Define the outline of different note types
6276 @node Setting up capture, Using capture, Capture, Capture
6277 @subsection Setting up capture
6279 The following customization sets a default target file for notes, and defines
6280 a global key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c c} is only a
6281 suggestion.} for capturing new material.
6283 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6285 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
6286 (define-key global-map "\C-cc" 'org-capture)
6289 @node Using capture, Capture templates, Setting up capture, Capture
6290 @subsection Using capture
6293 @orgcmd{C-c c,org-capture}
6294 Call the command @code{org-capture}. Note that this keybinding is global and
6295 not active by default - you need to install it. If you have templates
6297 defined @pxref{Capture templates}, it will offer these templates for
6298 selection or use a new Org outline node as the default template. It will
6299 insert the template into the target file and switch to an indirect buffer
6300 narrowed to this new node. You may then insert the information you want.
6302 @orgcmd{C-c C-c,org-capture-finalize}
6303 Once you have finished entering information into the capture buffer, @kbd{C-c
6304 C-c} will return you to the window configuration before the capture process,
6305 so that you can resume your work without further distraction. When called
6306 with a prefix arg, finalize and then jump to the captured item.
6308 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-capture-refile}
6309 Finalize the capture process by refiling (@pxref{Refiling notes}) the note to
6310 a different place. Please realize that this is a normal refiling command
6311 that will be executed---so the cursor position at the moment you run this
6312 command is important. If you have inserted a tree with a parent and
6313 children, first move the cursor back to the parent. Any prefix argument
6314 given to this command will be passed on to the @code{org-refile} command.
6316 @orgcmd{C-c C-k,org-capture-kill}
6317 Abort the capture process and return to the previous state.
6321 You can also call @code{org-capture} in a special way from the agenda, using
6322 the @kbd{k c} key combination. With this access, any timestamps inserted by
6323 the selected capture template will default to the cursor date in the agenda,
6324 rather than to the current date.
6326 To find the locations of the last stored capture, use @code{org-capture} with
6331 Visit the target location of a capture template. You get to select the
6332 template in the usual way.
6333 @orgkey{C-u C-u C-c c}
6334 Visit the last stored capture item in its buffer.
6337 @node Capture templates, , Using capture, Capture
6338 @subsection Capture templates
6339 @cindex templates, for Capture
6341 You can use templates for different types of capture items, and
6342 for different target locations. The easiest way to create such templates is
6343 through the customize interface.
6347 Customize the variable @code{org-capture-templates}.
6350 Before we give the formal description of template definitions, let's look at
6351 an example. Say you would like to use one template to create general TODO
6352 entries, and you want to put these entries under the heading @samp{Tasks} in
6353 your file @file{~/org/gtd.org}. Also, a date tree in the file
6354 @file{journal.org} should capture journal entries. A possible configuration
6358 (setq org-capture-templates
6359 '(("t" "Todo" entry (file+headline "~/org/gtd.org" "Tasks")
6360 "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a")
6361 ("j" "Journal" entry (file+datetree "~/org/journal.org")
6362 "* %?\nEntered on %U\n %i\n %a")))
6365 @noindent If you then press @kbd{C-c c t}, Org will prepare the template
6369 [[file:@var{link to where you initiated capture}]]
6373 During expansion of the template, @code{%a} has been replaced by a link to
6374 the location from where you called the capture command. This can be
6375 extremely useful for deriving tasks from emails, for example. You fill in
6376 the task definition, press @code{C-c C-c} and Org returns you to the same
6377 place where you started the capture process.
6379 To define special keys to capture to a particular template without going
6380 through the interactive template selection, you can create your key binding
6384 (define-key global-map "\C-cx"
6385 (lambda () (interactive) (org-capture nil "x")))
6389 * Template elements:: What is needed for a complete template entry
6390 * Template expansion:: Filling in information about time and context
6393 @node Template elements, Template expansion, Capture templates, Capture templates
6394 @subsubsection Template elements
6396 Now lets look at the elements of a template definition. Each entry in
6397 @code{org-capture-templates} is a list with the following items:
6401 The keys that will select the template, as a string, characters
6402 only, for example @code{"a"} for a template to be selected with a
6403 single key, or @code{"bt"} for selection with two keys. When using
6404 several keys, keys using the same prefix key must be sequential
6405 in the list and preceded by a 2-element entry explaining the
6406 prefix key, for example
6408 ("b" "Templates for marking stuff to buy")
6410 @noindent If you do not define a template for the @kbd{C} key, this key will
6411 be used to open the customize buffer for this complex variable.
6414 A short string describing the template, which will be shown during
6418 The type of entry, a symbol. Valid values are:
6421 An Org-mode node, with a headline. Will be filed as the child of the target
6422 entry or as a top-level entry. The target file should be an Org-mode file.
6424 A plain list item, placed in the first plain list at the target
6425 location. Again the target file should be an Org file.
6427 A checkbox item. This only differs from the plain list item by the
6430 a new line in the first table at the target location. Where exactly the
6431 line will be inserted depends on the properties @code{:prepend} and
6432 @code{:table-line-pos} (see below).
6434 Text to be inserted as it is.
6438 @vindex org-default-notes-file
6439 Specification of where the captured item should be placed. In Org-mode
6440 files, targets usually define a node. Entries will become children of this
6441 node. Other types will be added to the table or list in the body of this
6442 node. Most target specifications contain a file name. If that file name is
6443 the empty string, it defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}. A file can
6444 also be given as a variable, function, or Emacs Lisp form.
6448 @item (file "path/to/file")
6449 Text will be placed at the beginning or end of that file.
6451 @item (id "id of existing org entry")
6452 Filing as child of this entry, or in the body of the entry.
6454 @item (file+headline "path/to/file" "node headline")
6455 Fast configuration if the target heading is unique in the file.
6457 @item (file+olp "path/to/file" "Level 1 heading" "Level 2" ...)
6458 For non-unique headings, the full path is safer.
6460 @item (file+regexp "path/to/file" "regexp to find location")
6461 Use a regular expression to position the cursor.
6463 @item (file+datetree "path/to/file")
6464 Will create a heading in a date tree for today's date.
6466 @item (file+datetree+prompt "path/to/file")
6467 Will create a heading in a date tree, but will prompt for the date.
6469 @item (file+function "path/to/file" function-finding-location)
6470 A function to find the right location in the file.
6473 File to the entry that is currently being clocked.
6475 @item (function function-finding-location)
6476 Most general way, write your own function to find both
6481 The template for creating the capture item. If you leave this empty, an
6482 appropriate default template will be used. Otherwise this is a string with
6483 escape codes, which will be replaced depending on time and context of the
6484 capture call. The string with escapes may be loaded from a template file,
6485 using the special syntax @code{(file "path/to/template")}. See below for
6489 The rest of the entry is a property list of additional options.
6490 Recognized properties are:
6493 Normally new captured information will be appended at
6494 the target location (last child, last table line, last list item...).
6495 Setting this property will change that.
6497 @item :immediate-finish
6498 When set, do not offer to edit the information, just
6499 file it away immediately. This makes sense if the template only needs
6500 information that can be added automatically.
6503 Set this to the number of lines to insert
6504 before and after the new item. Default 0, only common other value is 1.
6507 Start the clock in this item.
6510 Keep the clock running when filing the captured entry.
6513 If starting the capture interrupted a clock, restart that clock when finished
6514 with the capture. Note that @code{:clock-keep} has precedence over
6515 @code{:clock-resume}. When setting both to @code{t}, the current clock will
6516 run and the previous one will not be resumed.
6519 Do not narrow the target buffer, simply show the full buffer. Default is to
6520 narrow it so that you only see the new material.
6522 @item :table-line-pos
6523 Specification of the location in the table where the new line should be
6524 inserted. It should be a string like @code{"II-3"} meaning that the new
6525 line should become the third line before the second horizontal separator
6529 If the target file was not yet visited when capture was invoked, kill the
6530 buffer again after capture is completed.
6534 @node Template expansion, , Template elements, Capture templates
6535 @subsubsection Template expansion
6537 In the template itself, special @kbd{%}-escapes@footnote{If you need one of
6538 these sequences literally, escape the @kbd{%} with a backslash.} allow
6539 dynamic insertion of content. The templates are expanded in the order given here:
6542 %[@var{file}] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @var{file}.}
6543 %(@var{sexp}) @r{evaluate Elisp @var{sexp} and replace with the result.}
6544 %<...> @r{the result of format-time-string on the ... format specification.}
6545 %t @r{timestamp, date only.}
6546 %T @r{timestamp with date and time.}
6547 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive timestamps.}
6548 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}.}
6549 %i @r{initial content, the region when capture is called while the}
6550 @r{region is active.}
6551 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
6552 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part.}
6553 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
6554 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
6555 %k @r{title of the currently clocked task.}
6556 %K @r{link to the currently clocked task.}
6557 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name}).}
6558 %f @r{file visited by current buffer when org-capture was called.}
6559 %F @r{full path of the file or directory visited by current buffer.}
6560 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below.}
6561 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
6562 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
6563 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}.}
6564 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}.}
6565 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
6566 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
6567 %^@{@var{prop}@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @var{prop}.}
6568 %^@{@var{prompt}@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
6569 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
6570 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}.}
6571 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
6575 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
6576 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
6577 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
6578 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in capture templates in a
6581 @vindex org-from-is-user-regexp
6583 Link type | Available keywords
6584 ------------------------+----------------------------------------------
6585 bbdb | %:name %:company
6586 irc | %:server %:port %:nick
6587 vm, wl, mh, mew, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
6588 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
6589 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
6590 | %:date @r{(message date header field)}
6591 | %:date-timestamp @r{(date as active timestamp)}
6592 | %:date-timestamp-inactive @r{(date as inactive timestamp)}
6593 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
6594 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
6596 info | %:file %:node
6601 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
6604 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
6608 @node Attachments, RSS Feeds, Capture, Capture - Refile - Archive
6609 @section Attachments
6612 @vindex org-attach-directory
6613 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
6614 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
6615 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can establish associations with
6616 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
6617 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
6618 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
6619 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
6620 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
6621 your Org file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org files from one
6622 directory to another, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
6623 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
6624 @code{git init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
6625 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
6627 In cases where it seems better to do so, you can also attach a directory of your
6628 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
6629 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
6632 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments:
6636 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
6637 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
6638 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you must press an additional key
6639 to select a command:
6642 @orgcmdtkc{a,C-c C-a a,org-attach-attach}
6643 @vindex org-attach-method
6644 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
6645 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
6646 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6652 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
6653 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
6655 @orgcmdtkc{n,C-c C-a n,org-attach-new}
6656 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
6658 @orgcmdtkc{z,C-c C-a z,org-attach-sync}
6659 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
6660 attachments yourself.
6662 @orgcmdtkc{o,C-c C-a o,org-attach-open}
6663 @vindex org-file-apps
6664 Open current task's attachment. If there is more than one, prompt for a
6665 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
6666 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
6667 (@pxref{Handling links}).
6669 @orgcmdtkc{O,C-c C-a O,org-attach-open-in-emacs}
6670 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
6672 @orgcmdtkc{f,C-c C-a f,org-attach-reveal}
6673 Open the current task's attachment directory.
6675 @orgcmdtkc{F,C-c C-a F,org-attach-reveal-in-emacs}
6676 Also open the directory, but force using @command{dired} in Emacs.
6678 @orgcmdtkc{d,C-c C-a d,org-attach-delete-one}
6679 Select and delete a single attachment.
6681 @orgcmdtkc{D,C-c C-a D,org-attach-delete-all}
6682 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
6683 @command{dired} and delete from there.
6685 @orgcmdtkc{s,C-c C-a s,org-attach-set-directory}
6686 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR
6687 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
6688 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
6690 @orgcmdtkc{i,C-c C-a i,org-attach-set-inherit}
6691 @cindex property, ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT
6692 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
6693 same directory for attachments as the parent does.
6697 @node RSS Feeds, Protocols, Attachments, Capture - Refile - Archive
6702 Org can add and change entries based on information found in RSS feeds and
6703 Atom feeds. You could use this to make a task out of each new podcast in a
6704 podcast feed. Or you could use a phone-based note-creating service on the
6705 web to import tasks into Org. To access feeds, configure the variable
6706 @code{org-feed-alist}. The docstring of this variable has detailed
6707 information. Here is just an example:
6710 (setq org-feed-alist
6712 "http://rss.slashdot.org/Slashdot/slashdot"
6713 "~/txt/org/feeds.org" "Slashdot Entries")))
6717 will configure that new items from the feed provided by
6718 @code{rss.slashdot.org} will result in new entries in the file
6719 @file{~/org/feeds.org} under the heading @samp{Slashdot Entries}, whenever
6720 the following command is used:
6723 @orgcmd{C-c C-x g,org-feed-update-all}
6725 Collect items from the feeds configured in @code{org-feed-alist} and act upon
6727 @orgcmd{C-c C-x G,org-feed-goto-inbox}
6728 Prompt for a feed name and go to the inbox configured for this feed.
6731 Under the same headline, Org will create a drawer @samp{FEEDSTATUS} in which
6732 it will store information about the status of items in the feed, to avoid
6733 adding the same item several times. You should add @samp{FEEDSTATUS} to the
6734 list of drawers in that file:
6737 #+DRAWERS: LOGBOOK PROPERTIES FEEDSTATUS
6740 For more information, including how to read atom feeds, see
6741 @file{org-feed.el} and the docstring of @code{org-feed-alist}.
6743 @node Protocols, Refiling notes, RSS Feeds, Capture - Refile - Archive
6744 @section Protocols for external access
6745 @cindex protocols, for external access
6748 You can set up Org for handling protocol calls from outside applications that
6749 are passed to Emacs through the @file{emacsserver}. For example, you can
6750 configure bookmarks in your web browser to send a link to the current page to
6751 Org and create a note from it using capture (@pxref{Capture}). Or you
6752 could create a bookmark that will tell Emacs to open the local source file of
6753 a remote website you are looking at with the browser. See
6754 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/org-protocol.php} for detailed
6755 documentation and setup instructions.
6757 @node Refiling notes, Archiving, Protocols, Capture - Refile - Archive
6758 @section Refiling notes
6759 @cindex refiling notes
6761 When reviewing the captured data, you may want to refile some of the entries
6762 into a different list, for example into a project. Cutting, finding the
6763 right location, and then pasting the note is cumbersome. To simplify this
6764 process, you can use the following special command:
6767 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-refile}
6768 @vindex org-reverse-note-order
6769 @vindex org-refile-targets
6770 @vindex org-refile-use-outline-path
6771 @vindex org-outline-path-complete-in-steps
6772 @vindex org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes
6773 @vindex org-log-refile
6774 @vindex org-refile-use-cache
6775 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
6776 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
6777 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
6778 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
6780 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
6781 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
6782 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
6783 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
6784 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
6785 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}. If you would like to be able to
6786 create new nodes as new parents for refiling on the fly, check the
6787 variable @code{org-refile-allow-creating-parent-nodes}.
6788 When the variable @code{org-log-refile}@footnote{with corresponding
6789 @code{#+STARTUP} keywords @code{logrefile}, @code{lognoterefile},
6790 and @code{nologrefile}} is set, a timestamp or a note will be
6791 recorded when an entry has been refiled.
6792 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-w}
6793 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
6794 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-w,org-refile-goto-last-stored}
6795 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
6797 Refile as the child of the item currently being clocked.
6798 @item C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w
6800 @orgcmdtkc{C-0 C-c C-w @ @r{or} @ C-u C-u C-u C-c C-w,C-0 C-c C-w,org-refile-cache-clear}
6802 Clear the target cache. Caching of refile targets can be turned on by
6803 setting @code{org-refile-use-cache}. To make the command see new possible
6804 targets, you have to clear the cache with this command.
6807 @node Archiving, , Refiling notes, Capture - Refile - Archive
6811 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
6812 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
6813 agenda. Archiving is important to keep your working files compact and global
6814 searches like the construction of agenda views fast.
6817 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-a,org-archive-subtree-default}
6818 @vindex org-archive-default-command
6819 Archive the current entry using the command specified in the variable
6820 @code{org-archive-default-command}.
6824 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
6825 * Internal archiving:: Switch off a tree but keep it in the file
6828 @node Moving subtrees, Internal archiving, Archiving, Archiving
6829 @subsection Moving a tree to the archive file
6830 @cindex external archiving
6832 The most common archiving action is to move a project tree to another file,
6836 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,C-c $,org-archive-subtree}
6837 @vindex org-archive-location
6838 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
6839 given by @code{org-archive-location}.
6840 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-s}
6841 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
6842 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
6843 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
6844 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
6845 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
6848 @cindex archive locations
6849 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
6850 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
6851 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
6852 see the documentation string of the variable
6853 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
6854 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
6855 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
6856 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
6857 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
6858 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
6859 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
6860 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
6864 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
6867 @cindex property, ARCHIVE
6869 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
6870 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
6871 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
6873 @vindex org-archive-save-context-info
6874 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
6875 record context information like the file from where the entry came, its
6876 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
6877 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
6881 @node Internal archiving, , Moving subtrees, Archiving
6882 @subsection Internal archiving
6884 If you want to just switch off (for agenda views) certain subtrees without
6885 moving them to a different file, you can use the @code{ARCHIVE tag}.
6887 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
6888 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
6891 @vindex org-cycle-open-archived-trees
6892 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
6893 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
6894 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
6895 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
6896 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
6898 @vindex org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees
6899 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
6900 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
6901 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
6903 @vindex org-agenda-skip-archived-trees
6904 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
6905 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
6906 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
6907 be included. In the agenda you can press @kbd{v a} to get archives
6908 temporarily included.
6910 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
6911 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
6912 is. Configure the details using the variable
6913 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
6915 @vindex org-columns-skip-archived-trees
6916 Archived trees are excluded from column view unless the variable
6917 @code{org-columns-skip-archived-trees} is configured to @code{nil}.
6920 The following commands help manage the ARCHIVE tag:
6923 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-toggle-archive-tag}
6924 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
6925 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
6927 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x a}
6928 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
6929 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
6930 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
6931 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
6932 level 1 trees will be checked.
6933 @orgcmd{C-@kbd{TAB},org-force-cycle-archived}
6934 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
6935 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-archive-to-archive-sibling}
6936 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
6937 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}. The
6938 entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this way retains a lot of its
6939 original context, including inherited tags and approximate position in the
6944 @node Agenda Views, Markup, Capture - Refile - Archive, Top
6945 @chapter Agenda views
6946 @cindex agenda views
6948 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
6949 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
6950 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
6951 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
6952 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
6954 Org can select items based on various criteria and display them
6955 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
6959 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
6962 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
6965 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties, and
6966 TODO state associated with them,
6968 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
6969 in time-sorted view,
6971 a @emph{text search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
6972 that contain specified keywords,
6974 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
6977 @emph{custom views} that are special searches and combinations of different
6982 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
6983 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
6984 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
6985 edit these files remotely.
6987 @vindex org-agenda-window-setup
6988 @vindex org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit
6989 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
6990 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
6991 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
6992 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
6995 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
6996 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
6997 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
6998 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
6999 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
7000 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
7001 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing a view to a file
7002 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
7005 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
7006 @section Agenda files
7007 @cindex agenda files
7008 @cindex files for agenda
7010 @vindex org-agenda-files
7011 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
7012 files}, the files listed in the variable
7013 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
7014 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
7015 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
7016 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
7019 Thus, even if you only work with a single Org file, that file should
7020 be put into the list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
7021 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
7022 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
7023 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
7024 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
7026 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
7028 @orgcmd{C-c [,org-agenda-file-to-front}
7029 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
7030 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
7031 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
7032 @orgcmd{C-c ],org-remove-file}
7033 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
7035 @orgcmd{C-',org-cycle-agenda-files}
7037 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
7038 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
7039 @item M-x org-iswitchb
7040 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
7045 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
7046 to visit any of them.
7048 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily on a file not in
7049 this list, or on just one file in the list, or even on only a subtree in a
7050 file, then this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
7051 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
7052 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
7053 extended period, use the following commands:
7056 @orgcmd{C-c C-x <,org-agenda-set-restriction-lock}
7057 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
7058 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
7059 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
7060 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
7061 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
7062 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
7063 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7064 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
7068 When working with @file{speedbar.el}, you can use the following commands in
7071 @orgcmdtkc{< @r{in the speedbar frame},<,org-speedbar-set-agenda-restriction}
7072 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item---either an Org file or a subtree
7073 in such a file---at the cursor in the Speedbar frame.
7074 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
7076 @orgcmdtkc{> @r{in the speedbar frame},>,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7077 Lift the restriction.
7080 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
7081 @section The agenda dispatcher
7082 @cindex agenda dispatcher
7083 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
7084 The views are created through a dispatcher, which should be bound to a
7085 global key---for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Activation}). In the
7086 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
7087 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
7088 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
7089 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
7092 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
7094 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
7096 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
7097 tags and properties}).
7099 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
7101 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
7102 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
7104 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7105 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
7106 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}. This
7107 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
7108 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
7111 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
7113 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
7114 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
7115 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
7116 selecting the command.
7118 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
7119 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
7120 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
7121 current region/subtree.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
7122 character selecting the command.
7125 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
7126 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
7127 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
7128 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
7129 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
7131 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
7132 @section The built-in agenda views
7134 In this section we describe the built-in views.
7137 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
7138 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
7139 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
7140 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
7141 * Search view:: Find entries by searching for text
7142 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
7145 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
7146 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
7148 @cindex weekly agenda
7149 @cindex daily agenda
7151 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
7152 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
7155 @cindex org-agenda, command
7156 @orgcmd{C-c a a,org-agenda-list}
7157 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of Org files. The agenda
7158 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
7159 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
7160 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
7161 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
7162 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed.
7165 @vindex org-agenda-span
7166 @vindex org-agenda-ndays
7167 The default number of days displayed in the agenda is set by the variable
7168 @code{org-agenda-span} (or the obsolete @code{org-agenda-ndays}). This
7169 variable can be set to any number of days you want to see by default in the
7170 agenda, or to a span name, such a @code{day}, @code{week}, @code{month} or
7173 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
7174 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
7175 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
7178 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
7179 @cindex calendar integration
7180 @cindex diary integration
7182 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
7183 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
7184 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
7185 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
7186 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
7187 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
7190 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org-mode's
7191 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
7194 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
7197 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
7198 entries including holidays, anniversaries, etc., will be included in the
7199 agenda buffer created by Org-mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
7200 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
7201 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
7202 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
7203 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
7204 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
7205 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
7206 between calendar and agenda.
7208 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
7209 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
7210 the entries into an Org file. Org-mode evaluates diary-style sexp
7211 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
7212 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
7213 the left margin, no whitespace is allowed before them. For example,
7214 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
7215 will be made in the agenda:
7218 * Birthdays and similar stuff
7220 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
7222 %%(org-anniversary 1956 5 14)@footnote{@code{org-anniversary} is just like @code{diary-anniversary}, but the argument order is allways according to ISO and therefore independent of the value of @code{calendar-date-style}.} Arthur Dent is %d years old
7223 %%(org-anniversary 1869 10 2) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
7226 @subsubheading Anniversaries from BBDB
7227 @cindex BBDB, anniversaries
7228 @cindex anniversaries, from BBDB
7230 If you are using the Big Brothers Database to store your contacts, you will
7231 very likely prefer to store anniversaries in BBDB rather than in a
7232 separate Org or diary file. Org supports this and will show BBDB
7233 anniversaries as part of the agenda. All you need to do is to add the
7234 following to one your your agenda files:
7241 %%(org-bbdb-anniversaries)
7244 You can then go ahead and define anniversaries for a BBDB record. Basically,
7245 you need to press @kbd{C-o anniversary @key{RET}} with the cursor in a BBDB
7246 record and then add the date in the format @code{YYYY-MM-DD} or @code{MM-DD},
7247 followed by a space and the class of the anniversary (@samp{birthday} or
7248 @samp{wedding}, or a format string). If you omit the class, it will default to
7249 @samp{birthday}. Here are a few examples, the header for the file
7250 @file{org-bbdb.el} contains more detailed information.
7256 2008-04-14 %s released version 6.01 of org-mode, %d years ago
7259 After a change to BBDB, or for the first agenda display during an Emacs
7260 session, the agenda display will suffer a short delay as Org updates its
7261 hash with anniversaries. However, from then on things will be very fast---much
7262 faster in fact than a long list of @samp{%%(diary-anniversary)} entries
7263 in an Org or Diary file.
7265 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
7266 @cindex @file{appt.el}
7267 @cindex appointment reminders
7269 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility. To add all
7270 the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
7271 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This command also lets you filter through the
7272 list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific category
7273 or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for details.
7275 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
7276 @subsection The global TODO list
7277 @cindex global TODO list
7278 @cindex TODO list, global
7280 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items formatted and
7281 collected into a single place.
7284 @orgcmd{C-c a t,org-todo-list}
7285 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all agenda
7286 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. By default, this lists
7287 items with a state the is not a DONE state. The buffer is in
7288 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate the TODO
7289 entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
7290 @orgcmd{C-c a T,org-todo-list}
7291 @cindex TODO keyword matching
7292 @vindex org-todo-keywords
7293 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You can
7294 also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. You are
7295 prompted for a keyword, and you may also specify several keywords by
7296 separating them with @samp{|} as the boolean OR operator. With a numeric
7297 prefix, the Nth keyword in @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
7299 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
7300 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
7301 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
7302 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
7303 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
7304 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
7307 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
7308 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
7309 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
7311 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
7312 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
7313 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
7317 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled
7318 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines
7319 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp
7320 @vindex org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date
7321 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for execution or
7322 have a @emph{deadline} (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}.
7323 Configure the variables @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled},
7324 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-deadlines},
7325 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-timestamp} and/or
7326 @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-with-date} to exclude such items from the global
7329 @vindex org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels
7330 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
7331 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
7332 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
7333 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
7336 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
7337 @subsection Matching tags and properties
7338 @cindex matching, of tags
7339 @cindex matching, of properties
7343 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags} (@pxref{Tags}),
7344 or have properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), you can select headlines
7345 based on this metadata and collect them into an agenda buffer. The match
7346 syntax described here also applies when creating sparse trees with @kbd{C-c /
7350 @orgcmd{C-c a m,org-tags-view}
7351 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
7352 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
7353 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
7354 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
7355 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
7356 @orgcmd{C-c a M,org-tags-view}
7357 @vindex org-tags-match-list-sublevels
7358 @vindex org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options
7359 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items in a
7360 not-DONE state and force checking subitems (see variable
7361 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). To exclude scheduled/deadline items,
7362 see the variable @code{org-agenda-tags-todo-honor-ignore-options}. Matching
7363 specific TODO keywords together with a tags match is also possible, see
7367 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
7370 @subsubheading Match syntax
7372 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag/property searches
7373 A search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and @samp{|} for
7374 OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}. Parentheses are currently
7375 not implemented. Each element in the search is either a tag, a regular
7376 expression matching tags, or an expression like @code{PROPERTY OPERATOR
7377 VALUE} with a comparison operator, accessing a property value. Each element
7378 may be preceded by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic
7379 sugar for positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when
7380 @samp{+} or @samp{-} is present. Here are some examples, using only tags.
7384 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
7387 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
7388 @item work|laptop+night
7389 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
7393 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
7394 Instead of a tag, you may also specify a regular expression enclosed in curly
7395 braces. For example,
7396 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
7397 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}.
7399 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
7400 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
7401 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
7402 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
7403 You may also test for properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same
7404 time as matching tags. The properties may be real properties, or special
7405 properties that represent other metadata (@pxref{Special properties}). For
7406 example, the ``property'' @code{TODO} represents the TODO keyword of the
7407 entry. Or, the ``property'' @code{LEVEL} represents the level of an entry.
7408 So a search @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss-TODO="DONE"} lists all level three headlines
7409 that have the tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword
7410 DONE. In buffers with @code{org-odd-levels-only} set, @samp{LEVEL} does not
7411 count the number of stars, but @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars etc.
7413 Here are more examples:
7415 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
7416 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
7417 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
7418 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
7419 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
7422 When matching properties, a number of different operators can be used to test
7423 the value of a property. Here is a complex example:
7426 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
7427 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
7431 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
7434 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
7435 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
7436 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
7438 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes,
7439 a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
7441 If the comparison value is enclosed in double-quotes @emph{and} angular
7442 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
7443 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
7444 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
7445 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
7446 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e.@: without a time
7447 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
7448 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
7449 respectively, can be used.
7451 If the comparison value is enclosed
7452 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
7453 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
7457 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
7458 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
7459 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
7460 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
7461 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
7462 on or after October 11, 2008.
7464 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
7465 other properties will slow down the search. However, once you have paid the
7466 price by accessing one property, testing additional properties is cheap
7469 You can configure Org-mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
7470 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
7471 inheritance}, for details.
7473 For backward compatibility, and also for typing speed, there is also a
7474 different way to test TODO states in a search. For this, terminate the
7475 tags/property part of the search string (which may include several terms
7476 connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then specify a Boolean
7477 expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then similar to that for
7478 tags, but should be applied with care: for example, a positive selection on
7479 several TODO keywords cannot meaningfully be combined with boolean AND.
7480 However, @emph{negative selection} combined with AND can be meaningful. To
7481 make sure that only lines are checked that actually have any TODO keyword
7482 (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M}, or equivalently start the TODO
7483 part after the slash with @samp{!}. Using @kbd{C-c a M} or @samp{/!} will
7484 not match TODO keywords in a DONE state. Examples:
7488 Same as @samp{work+TODO="WAITING"}
7489 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
7490 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
7492 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
7493 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
7497 @node Timeline, Search view, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
7498 @subsection Timeline for a single file
7499 @cindex timeline, single file
7500 @cindex time-sorted view
7502 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org-mode
7503 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
7504 to give an overview over events in a project.
7507 @orgcmd{C-c a L,org-timeline}
7508 Show a time-sorted view of the Org file, with all time-stamped items.
7509 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
7510 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
7514 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
7515 @ref{Agenda commands}.
7517 @node Search view, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
7518 @subsection Search view
7521 @cindex searching, for text
7523 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org-mode entries.
7524 It is particularly useful to find notes.
7527 @orgcmd{C-c a s,org-search-view}
7528 This is a special search that lets you select entries by matching a substring
7529 or specific words using a boolean logic.
7531 For example, the search string @samp{computer equipment} will find entries
7532 that contain @samp{computer equipment} as a substring. If the two words are
7533 separated by more space or a line break, the search will still match.
7534 Search view can also search for specific keywords in the entry, using Boolean
7535 logic. The search string @samp{+computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}}
7536 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
7537 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
7538 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
7539 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g. The first @samp{+} is necessary to turn on
7540 word search, other @samp{+} characters are optional. For more details, see
7541 the docstring of the command @code{org-search-view}.
7543 @vindex org-agenda-text-search-extra-files
7544 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
7545 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
7547 @node Stuck projects, , Search view, Built-in agenda views
7548 @subsection Stuck projects
7549 @pindex GTD, Getting Things Done
7551 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
7552 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
7553 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
7554 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
7555 Org-mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
7556 projects and define next actions for them.
7559 @orgcmd{C-c a #,org-agenda-list-stuck-projects}
7560 List projects that are stuck.
7563 @vindex org-stuck-projects
7564 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
7565 project is and how to find it.
7568 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
7569 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
7570 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
7571 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
7573 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org-mode, identify
7574 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
7575 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
7576 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
7577 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
7578 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
7579 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
7580 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
7581 with a tags/todo match@footnote{@xref{Tag searches}.}
7582 @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and
7583 IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that are not stuck. The
7584 correct customization for this is
7587 (setq org-stuck-projects
7588 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
7592 Note that if a project is identified as non-stuck, the subtree of this entry
7593 will still be searched for stuck projects.
7595 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
7596 @section Presentation and sorting
7597 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
7599 @vindex org-agenda-prefix-format
7600 @vindex org-agenda-tags-column
7601 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org-mode visually prepares the
7602 items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line starts
7603 with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category} (@pxref{Categories})
7604 of the item and other important information. You can customize in which
7605 column tags will be displayed through @code{org-agenda-tags-column}. You can
7606 also customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
7607 This prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
7608 associated with the item.
7611 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
7612 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
7613 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
7616 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
7617 @subsection Categories
7621 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
7622 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
7623 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
7624 backward compatibility, the following also works: if there are several
7625 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
7626 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
7627 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
7628 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
7629 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
7637 @cindex property, CATEGORY
7638 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
7639 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
7640 special category you want to apply as the value.
7643 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
7644 longer than 10 characters.
7647 You can set up icons for category by customizing the
7648 @code{org-agenda-category-icon-alist} variable.
7650 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
7651 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
7652 @cindex time-of-day specification
7654 Org-mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
7655 time can be part of the timestamp that triggered inclusion into the
7656 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
7657 ranges can be specified with two timestamps, like
7659 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
7661 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
7662 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
7663 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
7664 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
7666 For agenda display, Org-mode extracts the time and displays it in a
7667 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
7668 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
7671 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7672 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7673 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7674 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7678 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
7679 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
7682 8:00...... ------------------
7683 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
7684 10:00...... ------------------
7685 12:00...... ------------------
7686 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
7687 14:00...... ------------------
7688 16:00...... ------------------
7689 18:00...... ------------------
7690 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
7691 20:00...... ------------------
7692 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
7695 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7696 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7697 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
7698 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
7699 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7701 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
7702 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
7703 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
7704 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
7705 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
7706 done depends on the type of view.
7709 @vindex org-agenda-files
7710 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
7711 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
7712 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
7713 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
7714 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
7715 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
7716 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
7717 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
7718 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
7720 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
7721 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
7722 (@pxref{Priorities}). The priority used for sorting derives from the
7723 priority cookie, with additions depending on how close an item is to its due
7726 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
7727 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
7730 @vindex org-agenda-sorting-strategy
7731 Sorting can be customized using the variable
7732 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
7733 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
7735 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
7736 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
7737 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
7739 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the Org file or diary
7740 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
7741 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
7742 original entry location, and to edit the Org files ``remotely'' from
7743 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
7744 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
7746 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
7747 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
7750 @tsubheading{Motion}
7751 @cindex motion commands in agenda
7752 @orgcmd{n,org-agenda-next-line}
7753 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
7754 @orgcmd{p,org-agenda-previous-line}
7755 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
7756 @tsubheading{View/Go to Org file}
7757 @orgcmdkkc{@key{SPC},mouse-3,org-agenda-show-and-scroll-up}
7758 Display the original location of the item in another window.
7759 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
7760 outline, not only the heading.
7762 @orgcmd{L,org-agenda-recenter}
7763 Display original location and recenter that window.
7765 @orgcmdkkc{@key{TAB},mouse-2,org-agenda-goto}
7766 Go to the original location of the item in another window.
7768 @orgcmd{@key{RET},org-agenda-switch-to}
7769 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
7771 @orgcmd{F,org-agenda-follow-mode}
7772 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode
7773 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
7774 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
7775 location in the Org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
7776 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7777 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
7779 @orgcmd{C-c C-x b,org-agenda-tree-to-indirect-buffer}
7780 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
7781 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
7782 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
7783 previously used indirect buffer.
7785 @orgcmd{C-c C-o,org-agenda-open-link}
7786 Follow a link in the entry. This will offer a selection of any links in the
7787 text belonging to the referenced Org node. If there is only one link, it
7788 will be followed without a selection prompt.
7790 @tsubheading{Change display}
7791 @cindex display changing, in agenda
7794 Interactively select another agenda view and append it to the current view.
7798 Delete other windows.
7800 @orgcmdkskc{v d,d,org-aganda-day-view}
7801 @xorgcmdkskc{v w,w,org-aganda-day-view}
7802 @xorgcmd{v m,org-agenda-month-view}
7803 @xorgcmd{v y,org-agenda-month-year}
7804 @xorgcmd{v SPC,org-agenda-reset-view}
7805 @vindex org-agenda-span
7806 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view, this
7807 setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda refreshes. Since month and
7808 year views are slow to create, they do not become the default. A numeric
7809 prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day of the year,
7810 ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example, @kbd{32 d} jumps to
7811 February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When setting day, week, or
7812 month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix argument as well. For
7813 example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in 2007. If such a year
7814 specification has only one or two digits, it will be mapped to the interval
7815 1938-2037. @kbd{v @key{SPC}} will reset to what is set in
7816 @code{org-agenda-span}.
7818 @orgcmd{f,org-agenda-later}
7819 Go forward in time to display the following @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7820 For example, if the display covers a week, switch to the following week.
7821 With prefix arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-current-span} days.
7823 @orgcmd{b,org-agenda-earlier}
7824 Go backward in time to display earlier dates.
7826 @orgcmd{.,org-agenda-goto-today}
7829 @orgcmd{j,org-agenda-goto-date}
7830 Prompt for a date and go there.
7832 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
7833 Go to the currently clocked-in task @i{in the agenda buffer}.
7835 @orgcmd{D,org-agenda-toggle-diary}
7836 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
7838 @orgcmdkskc{v l,l,org-agenda-log-mode}
7840 @vindex org-log-done
7841 @vindex org-agenda-log-mode-items
7842 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
7843 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
7844 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
7845 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
7846 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
7847 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
7848 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
7849 @kbd{v L} is equivalent to @kbd{C-u v l}.
7851 @orgcmdkskc{v [,[,org-agenda-manipulate-query-add}
7852 Include inactive timestamps into the current view. Only for weekly/daily
7853 agenda and timeline views.
7855 @orgcmd{v a,org-agenda-archives-mode}
7856 @xorgcmd{v A,org-agenda-archives-mode 'files}
7857 Toggle Archives mode. In Archives mode, trees that are marked
7858 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you use the
7859 capital @kbd{A}, even all archive files are included. To exit archives mode,
7860 press @kbd{v a} again.
7862 @orgcmdkskc{v R,R,org-agenda-clockreport-mode}
7863 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode
7864 Toggle Clockreport mode. In Clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
7865 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
7866 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
7867 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
7868 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}. By using a prefix argument
7869 when toggling this mode (i.e.@: @kbd{C-u R}), the clock table will not show
7870 contributions from entries that are hidden by agenda filtering@footnote{Only
7871 tags filtering will be respected here, effort filtering is ignored.}.
7874 @vindex org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks
7875 Show overlapping clock entries, clocking gaps, and other clocking problems in
7876 the current agenda range. You can then visit clocking lines and fix them
7877 manually. See the variable @code{org-agenda-clock-consistency-checks} for
7878 information on how to customize the definition of what constituted a clocking
7879 problem. To return to normal agenda display, press @kbd{l} to exit Logbook
7882 @orgcmdkskc{v E,E,org-agenda-entry-text-mode}
7883 @vindex org-agenda-start-with-entry-text-mode
7884 @vindex org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines
7885 Toggle entry text mode. In entry text mode, a number of lines from the Org
7886 outline node referenced by an agenda line will be displayed below the line.
7887 The maximum number of lines is given by the variable
7888 @code{org-agenda-entry-text-maxlines}. Calling this command with a numeric
7889 prefix argument will temporarily modify that number to the prefix value.
7891 @orgcmd{G,org-agenda-toggle-time-grid}
7892 @vindex org-agenda-use-time-grid
7893 @vindex org-agenda-time-grid
7894 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
7895 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
7897 @orgcmd{r,org-agenda-redo}
7898 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes after
7899 modification of the timestamps of items with @kbd{S-@key{left}} and
7900 @kbd{S-@key{right}}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
7901 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
7903 @orgcmd{g,org-agenda-redo}
7906 @orgcmdkskc{C-x C-s,s,org-save-all-org-buffers}
7907 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session, and also the locations of
7910 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
7911 @vindex org-columns-default-format
7912 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
7913 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
7914 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
7915 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
7916 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
7917 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
7919 @orgcmd{C-c C-x >,org-agenda-remove-restriction-lock}
7920 Remove the restriction lock on the agenda, if it is currently restricted to a
7921 file or subtree (@pxref{Agenda files}).
7923 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
7924 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
7925 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
7926 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
7927 @cindex query editing, in agenda
7929 @orgcmd{/,org-agenda-filter-by-tag}
7930 @vindex org-agenda-filter-preset
7931 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
7932 The difference between this and a custom agenda command is that filtering is
7933 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
7934 having to recreate the agenda.@footnote{Custom commands can preset a filter by
7935 binding the variable @code{org-agenda-filter-preset} as an option. This
7936 filter will then be applied to the view and persist as a basic filter through
7937 refreshes and more secondary filtering. The filter is a global property of
7938 the entire agenda view---in a block agenda, you should only set this in the
7939 global options section, not in the section of an individual block.}
7941 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter; @key{SPC} will mean any tag at
7942 all. Pressing @key{TAB} at that prompt will offer use completion to select a
7943 tag (including any tags that do not have a selection character). The command
7944 then hides all entries that do not contain or inherit this tag. When called
7945 with prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second
7946 @kbd{/} at the prompt will turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries.
7947 If the first key you press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter
7948 will be narrowed by requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag.
7949 Instead of pressing @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also
7950 immediately use the @kbd{\} command.
7952 @vindex org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high
7953 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set up allowed
7954 efforts globally, for example
7956 (setq org-global-properties
7957 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
7959 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of
7960 @kbd{<}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort
7961 estimate in your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value.
7962 The filter will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal,
7963 or larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used
7964 as fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit
7965 directly without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed. For
7966 application of the operator, entries without a defined effort will be treated
7967 according to the value of @code{org-sort-agenda-noeffort-is-high}. To filter
7968 for tasks without effort definition, press @kbd{?} as the operator.
7970 Org also supports automatic, context-aware tag filtering. If the variable
7971 @code{org-agenda-auto-exclude-function} is set to a user-defined function,
7972 that function can decide which tags should be excluded from the agenda
7973 automatically. Once this is set, the @kbd{/} command then accepts @kbd{RET}
7974 as a sub-option key and runs the auto exclusion logic. For example, let's
7975 say you use a @code{Net} tag to identify tasks which need network access, an
7976 @code{Errand} tag for errands in town, and a @code{Call} tag for making phone
7977 calls. You could auto-exclude these tags based on the availability of the
7978 Internet, and outside of business hours, with something like this:
7982 (defun org-my-auto-exclude-function (tag)
7984 ((string= tag "Net")
7985 (/= 0 (call-process "/sbin/ping" nil nil nil
7986 "-c1" "-q" "-t1" "mail.gnu.org")))
7987 ((or (string= tag "Errand") (string= tag "Call"))
7988 (let ((hour (nth 2 (decode-time))))
7989 (or (< hour 8) (> hour 21)))))
7992 (setq org-agenda-auto-exclude-function 'org-my-auto-exclude-function)
7996 @orgcmd{\\,org-agenda-filter-by-tag-refine}
7997 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
7998 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
7999 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
8000 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
8009 @item @r{in} search view
8010 add new search words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions
8011 (@kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will
8012 add a positive search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search
8013 term @i{must} occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a
8014 negative search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
8018 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
8019 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
8024 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
8025 @cindex remote editing, undo
8026 @orgcmd{C-_,org-agenda-undo}
8027 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
8028 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
8030 @orgcmd{t,org-agenda-todo}
8031 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
8034 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{right},org-agenda-todo-nextset}
8035 @orgcmd{C-S-@key{left},org-agenda-todo-previousset}
8036 Switch to the next/previous set of TODO keywords.
8038 @orgcmd{C-k,org-agenda-kill}
8039 @vindex org-agenda-confirm-kill
8040 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
8041 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
8042 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
8043 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
8045 @orgcmd{C-c C-w,org-agenda-refile}
8046 Refile the entry at point.
8048 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-a,a,org-agenda-archive-default-with-confirmation}
8049 @vindex org-archive-default-command
8050 Archive the subtree corresponding to the entry at point using the default
8051 archiving command set in @code{org-archive-default-command}. When using the
8052 @code{a} key, confirmation will be required.
8054 @orgcmd{C-c C-x a,org-agenda-toggle-archive-tag}
8055 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
8057 @orgcmd{C-c C-x A,org-agenda-archive-to-archive-sibling}
8058 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{archive
8061 @orgcmdkskc{C-c C-x C-s,$,org-agenda-archive}
8062 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
8063 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
8066 @orgcmd{T,org-agenda-show-tags}
8067 @vindex org-agenda-show-inherited-tags
8068 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
8069 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
8070 tags of a headline occasionally.
8072 @orgcmd{:,org-agenda-set-tags}
8073 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
8074 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
8078 Set the priority for the current item (@command{org-agenda-priority}).
8079 Org-mode prompts for the priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC},
8080 the priority cookie is removed from the entry.
8082 @orgcmd{P,org-agenda-show-priority}
8083 Display weighted priority of current item.
8085 @orgcmdkkc{+,S-@key{up},org-agenda-priority-up}
8086 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
8087 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
8090 @orgcmdkkc{-,S-@key{down},org-agenda-priority-down}
8091 Decrease the priority of the current item.
8093 @orgcmdkkc{z,C-c C-z,org-agenda-add-note}
8094 @vindex org-log-into-drawer
8095 Add a note to the entry. This note will be recorded, and then filed to the
8096 same location where state change notes are put. Depending on
8097 @code{org-log-into-drawer}, this may be inside a drawer.
8099 @orgcmd{C-c C-a,org-attach}
8100 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
8102 @orgcmd{C-c C-s,org-agenda-schedule}
8103 Schedule this item. With prefix arg remove the scheduling timestamp
8105 @orgcmd{C-c C-d,org-agenda-deadline}
8106 Set a deadline for this item. With prefix arg remove the deadline.
8108 @orgcmd{k,org-agenda-action}
8109 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
8110 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
8113 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
8114 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
8115 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
8116 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
8117 r @r{Call @code{org-capture} with the cursor date as default date.}
8120 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
8123 @orgcmd{S-@key{right},org-agenda-do-date-later}
8124 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day into the
8125 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
8126 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. With a
8127 @kbd{C-u} prefix, change the time by one hour. If you immediately repeat the
8128 command, it will continue to change hours even without the prefix arg. With
8129 a double @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix, do the same for changing minutes. The stamp
8130 is changed in the original Org file, but the change is not directly reflected
8131 in the agenda buffer. Use @kbd{r} or @kbd{g} to update the buffer.
8133 @orgcmd{S-@key{left},org-agenda-do-date-earlier}
8134 Change the timestamp associated with the current line by one day
8137 @orgcmd{>,org-agenda-date-prompt}
8138 Change the timestamp associated with the current line. The key @kbd{>} has
8139 been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.} on my keyboard.
8141 @orgcmd{I,org-agenda-clock-in}
8142 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
8145 @orgcmd{O,org-agenda-clock-out}
8146 Stop the previously started clock.
8148 @orgcmd{X,org-agenda-clock-cancel}
8149 Cancel the currently running clock.
8151 @orgcmd{J,org-agenda-clock-goto}
8152 Jump to the running clock in another window.
8154 @tsubheading{Bulk remote editing selected entries}
8155 @cindex remote editing, bulk, from agenda
8157 @orgcmd{m,org-agenda-bulk-mark}
8158 Mark the entry at point for bulk action. With prefix arg, mark that many
8161 @orgcmd{%,org-agenda-bulk-mark-regexp}
8162 Mark entries matching a regular expression for bulk action.
8164 @orgcmd{u,org-agenda-bulk-unmark}
8165 Unmark entry for bulk action.
8167 @orgcmd{U,org-agenda-bulk-remove-all-marks}
8168 Unmark all marked entries for bulk action.
8170 @orgcmd{B,org-agenda-bulk-action}
8171 Bulk action: act on all marked entries in the agenda. This will prompt for
8172 another key to select the action to be applied. The prefix arg to @kbd{B}
8173 will be passed through to the @kbd{s} and @kbd{d} commands, to bulk-remove
8174 these special timestamps.
8176 r @r{Prompt for a single refile target and move all entries. The entries}
8177 @r{will no longer be in the agenda; refresh (@kbd{g}) to bring them back.}
8178 $ @r{Archive all selected entries.}
8179 A @r{Archive entries by moving them to their respective archive siblings.}
8180 t @r{Change TODO state. This prompts for a single TODO keyword and}
8181 @r{changes the state of all selected entries, bypassing blocking and}
8182 @r{suppressing logging notes (but not timestamps).}
8183 + @r{Add a tag to all selected entries.}
8184 - @r{Remove a tag from all selected entries.}
8185 s @r{Schedule all items to a new date. To shift existing schedule dates}
8186 @r{by a fixed number of days, use something starting with double plus}
8187 @r{at the prompt, for example @samp{++8d} or @samp{++2w}.}
8188 S @r{Reschedule randomly into the coming N days. N will be prompted for.}
8189 @r{With prefix arg (@kbd{C-u B S}), scatter only across weekdays.}
8190 d @r{Set deadline to a specific date.}
8191 f @r{Apply a function to marked entries.}
8192 @r{For example, the function below sets the CATEGORY property of the}
8194 @r{(defun set-category ()}
8195 @r{ (interactive "P")}
8196 @r{ (let* ((marker (or (org-get-at-bol 'org-hd-marker)}
8197 @r{ (org-agenda-error)))}
8198 @r{ (buffer (marker-buffer marker)))}
8199 @r{ (with-current-buffer buffer}
8200 @r{ (save-excursion}
8201 @r{ (save-restriction}
8203 @r{ (goto-char marker)}
8204 @r{ (org-back-to-heading t)}
8205 @r{ (org-set-property "CATEGORY" "web"))))))}
8209 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
8210 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
8212 @orgcmd{c,org-agenda-goto-calendar}
8213 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
8215 @orgcmd{c,org-calendar-goto-agenda}
8216 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org-mode agenda for the
8219 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
8220 @orgcmd{i,org-agenda-diary-entry}
8221 @vindex org-agenda-diary-file
8222 Insert a new entry into the diary, using the date at the cursor and (for
8223 block entries) the date at the mark. This will add to the Emacs diary
8224 file@footnote{This file is parsed for the agenda when
8225 @code{org-agenda-include-diary} is set.}, in a way similar to the @kbd{i}
8226 command in the calendar. The diary file will pop up in another window, where
8227 you can add the entry.
8229 If you configure @code{org-agenda-diary-file} to point to an Org-mode file,
8230 Org will create entries (in org-mode syntax) in that file instead. Most
8231 entries will be stored in a date-based outline tree that will later make it
8232 easy to archive appointments from previous months/years. The tree will be
8233 built under an entry with a @code{DATE_TREE} property, or else with years as
8234 top-level entries. Emacs will prompt you for the entry text---if you specify
8235 it, the entry will be created in @code{org-agenda-diary-file} without further
8236 interaction. If you directly press @key{RET} at the prompt without typing
8237 text, the target file will be shown in another window for you to finish the
8238 entry there. See also the @kbd{k r} command.
8240 @orgcmd{M,org-agenda-phases-of-moon}
8241 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
8243 @orgcmd{S,org-agenda-sunrise-sunset}
8244 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
8245 with calendar variables, see the documentation for the Emacs calendar.
8247 @orgcmd{C,org-agenda-convert-date}
8248 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
8251 @orgcmd{H,org-agenda-holidays}
8252 Show holidays for three months around the cursor date.
8254 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
8255 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
8256 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
8258 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
8259 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8260 @cindex exporting agenda views
8261 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8262 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8263 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8264 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8265 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), PDF (extension @file{.pdf}),
8266 and plain text (any other extension). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix
8267 argument, immediately open the newly created file. Use the variable
8268 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8269 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
8271 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
8272 @orgcmd{q,org-agenda-quit}
8273 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
8275 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
8276 @orgcmd{x,org-agenda-exit}
8277 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
8278 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
8279 visit Org files will not be removed.
8283 @node Custom agenda views, Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
8284 @section Custom agenda views
8285 @cindex custom agenda views
8286 @cindex agenda views, custom
8288 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
8289 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
8290 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
8291 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
8294 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
8295 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
8296 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
8299 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
8300 @subsection Storing searches
8302 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
8303 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
8304 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
8307 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8308 Custom commands are configured in the variable
8309 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
8310 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
8311 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
8316 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8317 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
8318 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
8319 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
8320 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
8321 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
8322 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
8323 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
8324 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
8325 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
8326 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
8331 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
8332 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
8333 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
8334 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
8335 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
8336 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
8337 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
8338 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
8339 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
8344 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
8347 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
8348 results as a sparse tree
8350 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
8353 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
8354 headlines that are also TODO items
8356 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
8357 displaying the result as a sparse tree
8359 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
8360 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
8362 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
8363 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
8364 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
8367 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
8368 @subsection Block agenda
8369 @cindex block agenda
8370 @cindex agenda, with block views
8372 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
8373 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
8374 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
8375 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
8376 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
8377 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
8378 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
8382 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8383 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8387 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8395 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
8396 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
8397 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
8398 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
8399 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
8401 @node Setting Options, , Block agenda, Custom agenda views
8402 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
8403 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
8405 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8406 Org-mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
8407 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
8408 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
8409 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
8410 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
8411 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
8415 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8416 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
8417 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
8418 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
8419 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
8420 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
8421 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
8423 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
8424 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
8429 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
8430 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
8431 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
8432 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
8433 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
8434 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
8435 to only a single file.
8437 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
8438 For command sets creating a block agenda,
8439 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
8440 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
8441 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
8442 the set. The former are just added to the command entry; the latter
8443 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
8444 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
8445 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
8446 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
8447 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
8451 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8452 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8456 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
8457 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
8458 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8465 As you see, the values and parentheses setting is a little complex.
8466 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable---it
8467 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: when setting options in
8468 this interface, the @emph{values} are just Lisp expressions. So if the
8469 value is a string, you need to add the double-quotes around the value
8473 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda column view, Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
8474 @section Exporting Agenda Views
8475 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8477 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
8478 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org-mode can export custom
8479 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
8480 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, PDF@footnote{To create PDF output, the
8481 ghostscript @file{ps2pdf} utility must be installed on the system. Selecting
8482 a PDF file will also create the postscript file.}, and iCalendar files. If
8483 you want to do this only occasionally, use the command
8486 @orgcmd{C-x C-w,org-write-agenda}
8487 @cindex exporting agenda views
8488 @cindex agenda views, exporting
8489 @vindex org-agenda-exporter-settings
8490 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the selected
8491 file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension @file{.html} or
8492 @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), iCalendar (extension
8493 @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
8494 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print} and
8495 for @file{htmlize} to be used during export, for example
8497 @vindex org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines
8498 @vindex htmlize-output-type
8499 @vindex ps-number-of-columns
8500 @vindex ps-landscape-mode
8502 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
8503 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8504 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8505 (org-agenda-add-entry-text-maxlines 5)
8506 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
8510 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
8511 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
8512 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
8513 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
8514 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
8515 that first defines custom commands for the agenda and the global
8516 TODO list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
8517 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
8518 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
8523 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8524 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
8525 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
8526 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
8531 ("~/views/home.html"))
8532 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
8537 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
8541 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
8542 @file{.html}, Org-mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
8543 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
8544 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
8545 Postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
8546 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
8547 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda. Any other
8548 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
8550 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
8551 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
8552 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
8556 @orgcmd{C-c a e,org-store-agenda-views}
8557 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
8561 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
8562 set options for the export commands. For example:
8565 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
8567 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
8568 (ps-landscape-mode t)
8569 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
8570 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
8571 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
8576 This command sets two options for the Postscript exporter, to make it
8577 print in two columns in landscape format---the resulting page can be cut
8578 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
8579 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
8580 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
8581 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
8582 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
8583 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
8584 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
8587 From the command line you may also use
8589 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
8592 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting depends on the
8593 system you use, please check the FAQ for examples.}
8595 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
8596 org-agenda-span month \
8597 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
8598 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
8599 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
8603 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
8604 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with a 30-day
8607 You can also extract agenda information in a way that allows further
8608 processing by other programs. See @ref{Extracting agenda information}, for
8612 @node Agenda column view, , Exporting Agenda Views, Agenda Views
8613 @section Using column view in the agenda
8614 @cindex column view, in agenda
8615 @cindex agenda, column view
8617 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
8618 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
8619 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
8620 collected by certain criteria.
8623 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-c,org-agenda-columns}
8624 Turn on column view in the agenda.
8627 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
8628 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
8629 This causes the following issues:
8633 @vindex org-columns-default-format
8634 @vindex org-overriding-columns-format
8635 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
8636 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
8637 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
8638 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-agenda-overriding-columns-format} is
8639 currently set, and if so, takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
8640 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
8641 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in its file), it
8642 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
8644 @cindex property, special, CLOCKSUM
8645 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
8646 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
8647 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
8648 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
8649 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
8650 cover a single day; in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
8651 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
8652 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
8653 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and its @emph{child}). In these
8654 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
8655 some values will count double.
8657 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
8658 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
8659 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
8660 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
8661 a column listing the planned total effort for a task---one of the major
8662 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
8663 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
8668 @node Markup, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
8669 @chapter Markup for rich export
8671 When exporting Org-mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
8672 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the backend. Since
8673 export targets like HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook allow much richer formatting,
8674 Org-mode has rules on how to prepare text for rich export. This section
8675 summarizes the markup rules used in an Org-mode buffer.
8678 * Structural markup elements:: The basic structure as seen by the exporter
8679 * Images and tables:: Tables and Images will be included
8680 * Literal examples:: Source code examples with special formatting
8681 * Include files:: Include additional files into a document
8682 * Index entries:: Making an index
8683 * Macro replacement:: Use macros to create complex output
8684 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX can be freely used inside Org documents
8687 @node Structural markup elements, Images and tables, Markup, Markup
8688 @section Structural markup elements
8691 * Document title:: Where the title is taken from
8692 * Headings and sections:: The document structure as seen by the exporter
8693 * Table of contents:: The if and where of the table of contents
8694 * Initial text:: Text before the first heading?
8696 * Paragraphs:: Paragraphs
8697 * Footnote markup:: Footnotes
8698 * Emphasis and monospace:: Bold, italic, etc.
8699 * Horizontal rules:: Make a line
8700 * Comment lines:: What will *not* be exported
8703 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements, Structural markup elements
8704 @subheading Document title
8705 @cindex document title, markup rules
8708 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
8712 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
8716 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
8717 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
8718 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
8719 title will be the file name without extension.
8721 @cindex property, EXPORT_TITLE
8722 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
8723 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
8724 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
8726 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Structural markup elements
8727 @subheading Headings and sections
8728 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
8730 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
8731 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
8732 Structure}, forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
8733 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
8734 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
8735 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
8736 switch globally by setting the variable @code{org-export-headline-levels}, or on a
8737 per-file basis with a line
8744 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Structural markup elements
8745 @subheading Table of contents
8746 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
8748 @vindex org-export-with-toc
8749 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
8750 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
8751 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
8752 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
8753 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number, or turn off
8754 the table of contents entirely, by configuring the variable
8755 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
8758 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
8759 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
8762 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Structural markup elements
8763 @subheading Text before the first headline
8764 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
8767 Org-mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
8768 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
8769 you need to include literal HTML, @LaTeX{}, or DocBook code, use the special
8770 constructs described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
8772 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
8773 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
8774 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
8775 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
8776 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
8777 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
8780 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
8781 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
8785 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
8786 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
8787 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the *first* headline
8790 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Structural markup elements
8792 @cindex lists, markup rules
8794 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists}, are translated to the backend's
8795 syntax for such lists. Most backends support unordered, ordered, and
8798 @node Paragraphs, Footnote markup, Lists, Structural markup elements
8799 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
8800 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
8802 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
8803 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
8805 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
8806 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
8808 @cindex #+BEGIN_VERSE
8811 Great clouds overhead
8812 Tiny black birds rise and fall
8819 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
8820 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
8821 can include quotations in Org-mode documents like this:
8823 @cindex #+BEGIN_QUOTE
8826 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
8827 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
8831 If you would like to center some text, do it like this:
8832 @cindex #+BEGIN_CENTER
8835 Everything should be made as simple as possible, \\
8841 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Paragraphs, Structural markup elements
8842 @subheading Footnote markup
8843 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
8844 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
8846 Footnotes defined in the way described in @ref{Footnotes}, will be exported
8847 by all backends. Org allows multiple references to the same note, and
8848 multiple footnotes side by side.
8850 @node Emphasis and monospace, Horizontal rules, Footnote markup, Structural markup elements
8851 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
8853 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
8854 @cindex bold text, markup rules
8855 @cindex italic text, markup rules
8856 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
8857 @cindex code text, markup rules
8858 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
8859 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
8860 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
8861 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org-mode specific
8862 syntax; it is exported verbatim.
8864 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, Emphasis and monospace, Structural markup elements
8865 @subheading Horizontal rules
8866 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
8867 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be exported as
8868 a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML and @code{\hrule} in @LaTeX{}).
8870 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Structural markup elements
8871 @subheading Comment lines
8872 @cindex comment lines
8873 @cindex exporting, not
8874 @cindex #+BEGIN_COMMENT
8876 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
8877 never be exported. If you want an indented line to be treated as a comment,
8878 start it with @samp{#+ }. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
8879 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
8880 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
8885 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
8889 @node Images and tables, Literal examples, Structural markup elements, Markup
8890 @section Images and Tables
8892 @cindex tables, markup rules
8895 Both the native Org-mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
8896 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org-mode tables,
8897 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
8898 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
8899 a caption and a label for cross references, and in the text you can refer to
8900 the object with @code{\ref@{tab:basic-data@}}:
8903 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
8904 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
8909 Optionally, the caption can take the form:
8911 #+CAPTION: [Caption for list of figures]@{Caption for table (or link).@}
8914 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
8915 Some backends (HTML, @LaTeX{}, and DocBook) allow you to directly include
8916 images into the exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image
8917 files does not have a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}.
8918 If you wish to define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal
8919 cross references, make sure that the link is on a line by itself and precede
8920 it with @code{#+CAPTION} and @code{#+LABEL} as follows:
8923 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
8924 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8928 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
8929 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
8932 @xref{Handling links,the discussion of image links}.
8934 @node Literal examples, Include files, Images and tables, Markup
8935 @section Literal examples
8936 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
8937 @cindex code line references, markup rules
8939 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
8940 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
8941 for source code and similar examples.
8942 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
8946 Some example from a text file.
8950 Note that such blocks may be @i{indented} in order to align nicely with
8951 indented text and in particular with plain list structure (@pxref{Plain
8952 lists}). For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the
8953 example lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
8954 whitespace before the colon:
8958 : Some example from a text file.
8961 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
8962 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
8963 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
8964 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{This works automatically for
8965 the HTML backend (it requires version 1.34 of the @file{htmlize.el} package,
8966 which is distributed with Org). Fontified code chunks in LaTeX can be
8967 achieved using either the listings or the
8968 @url{http://code.google.com/p/minted, minted,} package. To use listings, turn
8969 on the variable @code{org-export-latex-listings} and ensure that the listings
8970 package is included by the LaTeX header (e.g.@: by configuring
8971 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}). See the listings documentation for
8972 configuration options, including obtaining colored output. For minted it is
8973 necessary to install the program @url{http://pygments.org, pygments}, in
8974 addition to setting @code{org-export-latex-minted}, ensuring that the minted
8975 package is included by the LaTeX header, and ensuring that the
8976 @code{-shell-escape} option is passed to @file{pdflatex} (see
8977 @code{org-latex-to-pdf-process}). See the documentation of the variables
8978 @code{org-export-latex-listings} and @code{org-export-latex-minted} for
8979 further details.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also
8980 need to specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
8981 example@footnote{Code in @samp{src} blocks may also be evaluated either
8982 interactively or on export. See @pxref{Working With Source Code} for more
8983 information on evaluating code blocks.}:
8987 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
8988 (defun org-xor (a b)
8994 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
8995 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
8996 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
8997 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
8998 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
8999 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e.@: the reference name
9000 enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such a
9001 link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
9004 You can also add a @code{-r} switch which @i{removes} the labels from the
9005 source code@footnote{Adding @code{-k} to @code{-n -r} will @i{keep} the
9006 labels in the source code while using line numbers for the links, which might
9007 be useful to explain those in an org-mode example code.}. With the @code{-n}
9008 switch, links to these references will be labeled by the line numbers from
9009 the code listing, otherwise links will use the labels with no parentheses.
9013 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
9014 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
9015 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
9017 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current position. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
9021 @vindex org-coderef-label-format
9022 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
9023 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
9024 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
9026 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas (@pxref{Text
9027 areas in HTML export}).
9029 Because the @code{#+BEGIN_...} and @code{#+END_...} patterns need to be added
9030 so often, shortcuts are provided using the Easy Templates facility
9031 (@pxref{Easy Templates}).
9036 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
9037 switching to a temporary buffer with the source code. You need to exit by
9038 pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon exit, lines starting with @samp{*}
9039 or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to keep them from being interpreted
9040 by Org as outline nodes or special comments. These commas will be stripped
9041 for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and also for export.}. The edited version will
9042 then replace the old version in the Org buffer. Fixed-width regions
9043 (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be edited
9044 using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with the
9045 variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating ASCII
9046 drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
9050 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
9051 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label. Make sure
9052 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
9053 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
9054 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9058 @node Include files, Index entries, Literal examples, Markup
9059 @section Include files
9060 @cindex include files, markup rules
9062 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
9063 include your @file{.emacs} file, you could use:
9067 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
9070 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (e.g.@: @samp{quote},
9071 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
9072 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional; if it is not
9073 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org-mode format and will be
9074 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
9075 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
9076 first line and for each following line, @code{:minlevel} in order to get
9077 org-mode content demoted to a specified level, as well as any options
9078 accepted by the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item,
9082 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
9085 You can also include a portion of a file by specifying a lines range using
9086 the @code{:lines} parameter. The line at the upper end of the range will not
9087 be included. The start and/or the end of the range may be omitted to use the
9091 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "5-10" @r{Include lines 5 to 10, 10 excluded}
9092 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "-10" @r{Include lines 1 to 10, 10 excluded}
9093 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" :lines "10-" @r{Include lines from 10 to EOF}
9099 Visit the include file at point.
9102 @node Index entries, Macro replacement, Include files, Markup
9103 @section Index entries
9104 @cindex index entries, for publishing
9106 You can specify entries that will be used for generating an index during
9107 publishing. This is done by lines starting with @code{#+INDEX}. An entry
9108 the contains an exclamation mark will create a sub item. See @ref{Generating
9109 an index} for more information.
9114 #+INDEX: Application!CV
9120 @node Macro replacement, Embedded LaTeX, Index entries, Markup
9121 @section Macro replacement
9122 @cindex macro replacement, during export
9125 You can define text snippets with
9128 #+MACRO: name replacement text $1, $2 are arguments
9131 @noindent which can be referenced anywhere in the document (even in
9132 code examples) with @code{@{@{@{name(arg1,arg2)@}@}@}}. In addition to
9133 defined macros, @code{@{@{@{title@}@}@}}, @code{@{@{@{author@}@}@}}, etc.,
9134 will reference information set by the @code{#+TITLE:}, @code{#+AUTHOR:}, and
9135 similar lines. Also, @code{@{@{@{date(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} and
9136 @code{@{@{@{modification-time(@var{FORMAT})@}@}@}} refer to current date time
9137 and to the modification time of the file being exported, respectively.
9138 @var{FORMAT} should be a format string understood by
9139 @code{format-time-string}.
9141 Macro expansion takes place during export, and some people use it to
9142 construct complex HTML code.
9145 @node Embedded LaTeX, , Macro replacement, Markup
9146 @section Embedded @LaTeX{}
9147 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
9148 @cindex @LaTeX{} interpretation
9150 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. Exceptions
9151 include scientific notes, which often require mathematical symbols and the
9152 occasional formula. @LaTeX{}@footnote{@LaTeX{} is a macro system based on
9153 Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the features described here as
9154 ``@LaTeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for simplicity I am blurring this
9155 distinction.} is widely used to typeset scientific documents. Org-mode
9156 supports embedding @LaTeX{} code into its files, because many academics are
9157 used to writing and reading @LaTeX{} source code, and because it can be
9158 readily processed to produce pretty output for a number of export backends.
9161 * Special symbols:: Greek letters and other symbols
9162 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
9163 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
9164 * Previewing LaTeX fragments:: What will this snippet look like?
9165 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
9168 @node Special symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
9169 @subsection Special symbols
9170 @cindex math symbols
9171 @cindex special symbols
9172 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9173 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments, markup rules
9174 @cindex HTML entities
9175 @cindex @LaTeX{} entities
9177 You can use @LaTeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
9178 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
9179 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
9180 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike @LaTeX{}
9181 code, Org-mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
9182 delimiters, for example:
9185 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
9188 @vindex org-entities
9189 During export, these symbols will be transformed into the native format of
9190 the exporter backend. Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as
9191 @code{α} in the HTML output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the @LaTeX{}
9192 output. Similarly, @code{\nbsp} will become @code{ } in HTML and
9193 @code{~} in @LaTeX{}. If you need such a symbol inside a word, terminate it
9194 like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
9196 A large number of entities is provided, with names taken from both HTML and
9197 @LaTeX{}; see the variable @code{org-entities} for the complete list.
9198 @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
9199 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
9200 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
9202 If you would like to see entities displayed as UTF8 characters, use the
9203 following command@footnote{You can turn this on by default by setting the
9204 variable @code{org-pretty-entities}, or on a per-file base with the
9205 @code{#+STARTUP} option @code{entitiespretty}.}:
9210 Toggle display of entities as UTF-8 characters. This does not change the
9211 buffer content which remains plain ASCII, but it overlays the UTF-8 character
9212 for display purposes only.
9215 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Special symbols, Embedded LaTeX
9216 @subsection Subscripts and superscripts
9220 Just like in @LaTeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
9221 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
9222 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
9223 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
9224 with curly braces. For example
9227 The mass of the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
9228 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
9231 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
9232 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote @samp{^} and
9233 @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\^} and @samp{\_}. If you write a text
9234 where the underscore is often used in a different context, Org's convention
9235 to always interpret these as subscripts can get in your way. Configure the
9236 variable @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts} to globally change this
9237 convention, or use, on a per-file basis:
9243 @noindent With this setting, @samp{a_b} will not be interpreted as a
9244 subscript, but @samp{a_@{b@}} will.
9249 In addition to showing entities as UTF-8 characters, this command will also
9250 format sub- and superscripts in a WYSIWYM way.
9253 @node LaTeX fragments, Previewing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
9254 @subsection @LaTeX{} fragments
9255 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9257 @vindex org-format-latex-header
9258 Going beyond symbols and sub- and superscripts, a full formula language is
9259 needed. Org-mode can contain @LaTeX{} math fragments, and it supports ways
9260 to process these for several export backends. When exporting to @LaTeX{},
9261 the code is obviously left as it is. When exporting to HTML, Org invokes the
9262 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax library} (@pxref{Math formatting in
9263 HTML export}) to process and display the math@footnote{If you plan to use
9264 this regularly or on pages with significant page views, you should install
9265 @file{MathJax} on your own
9266 server in order to limit the load of our server.}. Finally, it can also
9267 process the mathematical expressions into images@footnote{For this to work
9268 you need to be on a system with a working @LaTeX{} installation. You also
9269 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
9270 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The @LaTeX{} header that will
9271 be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the variable
9272 @code{org-format-latex-header}.} that can be displayed in a browser or in
9275 @LaTeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
9276 snippets will be identified as @LaTeX{} source code:
9279 Environments of any kind@footnote{When @file{MathJax} is used, only the
9280 environment recognized by @file{MathJax} will be processed. When
9281 @file{dvipng} is used to create images, any @LaTeX{} environments will be
9282 handled.}. The only requirement is that the @code{\begin} statement appears
9283 on a new line, preceded by only whitespace.
9285 Text within the usual @LaTeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
9286 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
9287 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
9288 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
9289 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
9290 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
9291 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
9294 @noindent For example:
9297 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
9298 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
9299 \end@{equation@} % etc
9301 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
9302 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
9306 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9307 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
9308 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
9309 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the @LaTeX{} converter.
9311 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
9312 LaTeX processing can be configured with the variable
9313 @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}. The default setting is @code{t}
9314 which means @file{MathJax} for HTML, and no processing for DocBook, ASCII and
9315 LaTeX backends. You can also set this variable on a per-file basis using one
9319 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:t @r{Do the right thing automatically (MathJax)}
9320 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng @r{Force using dvipng images}
9321 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:nil @r{Do not process @LaTeX{} fragments at all}
9322 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:verbatim @r{Verbatim export, for jsMath or so}
9325 @node Previewing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9326 @subsection Previewing LaTeX fragments
9327 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
9329 If you have @file{dvipng} installed, @LaTeX{} fragments can be processed to
9330 produce preview images of the typeset expressions:
9335 Produce a preview image of the @LaTeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
9336 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
9337 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
9338 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
9339 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
9340 process the entire buffer.
9343 Remove the overlay preview images.
9346 @vindex org-format-latex-options
9347 You can customize the variable @code{org-format-latex-options} to influence
9348 some aspects of the preview. In particular, the @code{:scale} (and for HTML
9349 export, @code{:html-scale}) property can be used to adjust the size of the
9352 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Previewing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
9353 @subsection Using CDLa@TeX{} to enter math
9356 CDLa@TeX{} mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
9357 major @LaTeX{} mode like AUC@TeX{} in order to speed-up insertion of
9358 environments and math templates. Inside Org-mode, you can make use of
9359 some of the features of CDLa@TeX{} mode. You need to install
9360 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
9361 AUC@TeX{}) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
9362 Don't use CDLa@TeX{} mode itself under Org-mode, but use the light
9363 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org-mode. Turn it
9364 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
9368 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
9371 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
9372 details see the documentation of CDLa@TeX{} mode):
9376 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
9379 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
9380 @LaTeX{} fragment@footnote{Org-mode has a method to test if the cursor is
9381 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
9382 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
9383 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
9384 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
9385 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
9386 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
9387 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
9388 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
9389 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
9393 @vindex cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts
9394 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a @LaTeX{} fragment will insert these
9395 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
9396 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
9397 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
9398 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
9401 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
9402 macros, also outside @LaTeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
9403 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
9406 Pressing the single-quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
9407 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
9408 1.5 seconds after the single-quote, a help window will pop up. Character
9409 modification will work only inside @LaTeX{} fragments; outside the quote
9413 @node Exporting, Publishing, Markup, Top
9417 Org-mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
9418 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and simple
9419 version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a notes file on
9420 the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for exchange with a
9421 broad range of other applications. @LaTeX{} export lets you use Org-mode and
9422 its structured editing functions to easily create @LaTeX{} files. DocBook
9423 export makes it possible to convert Org files to many other formats using
9424 DocBook tools. OpenDocumentText export allows seamless colloboration across
9425 organizational boundaries. For project management you can create gantt and
9426 resource charts by using TaskJuggler export. To incorporate entries with
9427 associated times like deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar
9428 program like iCal, Org-mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar
9429 format. Currently Org-mode only supports export, not import of these
9432 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
9433 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
9436 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
9437 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
9438 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
9439 * ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export:: Exporting to flat files with encoding
9440 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
9441 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to @LaTeX{}, and processing to PDF
9442 * DocBook export:: Exporting to DocBook
9443 * OpenDocumentText export:: Exporting to OpenDocumentText
9444 * TaskJuggler export:: Exporting to TaskJuggler
9445 * Freemind export:: Exporting to Freemind mind maps
9446 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
9447 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
9450 @node Selective export, Export options, Exporting, Exporting
9451 @section Selective export
9452 @cindex export, selective by tags or TODO keyword
9454 @vindex org-export-select-tags
9455 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
9456 @cindex org-export-with-tasks
9457 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
9458 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
9459 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
9463 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the
9464 buffer. If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be
9465 excluded. If a selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it
9466 will also be selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
9469 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
9473 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
9474 be removed from the export buffer.
9477 The variable @code{org-export-with-tasks} can be configured to select which
9478 kind of tasks should be included for export. See the docstring of the
9479 variable for more information.
9481 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
9482 @section Export options
9483 @cindex options, for export
9485 @cindex completion, of option keywords
9486 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
9487 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
9488 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
9489 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
9490 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
9491 (@pxref{Completion}). For a summary of other in-buffer settings not
9492 specifically related to export, see @ref{In-buffer settings}.
9493 In particular, note that you can place commonly-used (export) options in
9494 a separate file which can be included using @code{#+SETUPFILE}.
9497 @orgcmd{C-c C-e t,org-insert-export-options-template}
9498 Insert template with export options, see example below.
9505 @cindex #+DESCRIPTION
9513 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS
9514 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS
9516 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
9517 @vindex user-full-name
9518 @vindex user-mail-address
9519 @vindex org-export-default-language
9521 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
9522 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
9523 #+DATE: a date, fixed, or a format string for @code{format-time-string}
9524 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
9525 #+DESCRIPTION: the page description, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9526 #+KEYWORDS: the page keywords, e.g.@: for the XHTML meta tag
9527 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g.@: @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
9528 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
9529 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
9530 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
9531 #+BIND: lisp-var lisp-val, e.g.@:: org-export-latex-low-levels itemize
9532 @r{You need to confirm using these, or configure @code{org-export-allow-BIND}}
9533 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
9534 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
9535 #+LATEX_HEADER: extra line(s) for the LaTeX header, like \usepackage@{xyz@}
9536 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
9537 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
9538 #+XSLT: the XSLT stylesheet used by DocBook exporter to generate FO file
9542 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
9543 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export
9544 settings. Here you can:
9545 @cindex headline levels
9546 @cindex section-numbers
9547 @cindex table of contents
9548 @cindex line-break preservation
9549 @cindex quoted HTML tags
9550 @cindex fixed-width sections
9552 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
9554 @cindex special strings
9555 @cindex emphasized text
9556 @cindex @TeX{} macros
9557 @cindex @LaTeX{} fragments
9558 @cindex author info, in export
9559 @cindex time info, in export
9560 @vindex org-export-plist-vars
9561 @vindex org-export-author-info
9562 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9563 @vindex org-export-email-info
9564 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9566 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
9567 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
9568 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
9569 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation (DOES NOT WORK)}
9570 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
9571 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
9572 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
9573 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
9574 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
9575 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
9576 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
9577 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
9578 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
9579 tasks: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tasks (TODO items), can be nil to remove}
9580 @r{all tasks, @code{todo} to remove DONE tasks, or list of kwds to keep}
9581 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
9582 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
9583 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
9584 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
9585 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
9586 LaTeX: @r{configure export of @LaTeX{} fragments. Default @code{auto}}
9587 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
9588 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
9589 email: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author email into exported file}
9590 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
9591 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
9592 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
9595 These options take effect in both the HTML and @LaTeX{} export, except for
9596 @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX} options, which are respectively @code{t} and
9597 @code{nil} for the @LaTeX{} export.
9599 The default values for these and many other options are given by a set of
9600 variables. For a list of such variables, the corresponding OPTIONS keys and
9601 also the publishing keys (@pxref{Project alist}), see the constant
9602 @code{org-export-plist-vars}.
9604 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
9605 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
9606 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
9607 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, @code{EXPORT_AUTHOR}, @code{EXPORT_DATE}, and
9608 @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
9610 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Export options, Exporting
9611 @section The export dispatcher
9612 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
9614 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
9615 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
9616 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
9617 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
9618 the subtrees are exported.
9621 @orgcmd{C-c C-e,org-export}
9622 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9623 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
9624 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
9625 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
9626 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
9627 separate Emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
9628 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
9629 @orgcmd{C-c C-e v,org-export-visible}
9630 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
9631 (i.e.@: not hidden by outline visibility).
9632 @orgcmd{C-u C-u C-c C-e,org-export}
9633 @vindex org-export-run-in-background
9634 Call the exporter, but reverse the setting of
9635 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e.@: request background processing if
9636 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if set.
9639 @node ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
9640 @section ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export
9641 @cindex ASCII export
9642 @cindex Latin-1 export
9643 @cindex UTF-8 export
9645 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org-mode
9646 file, containing only plain ASCII. Latin-1 and UTF-8 export augment the file
9647 with special characters and symbols available in these encodings.
9649 @cindex region, active
9650 @cindex active region
9651 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9653 @orgcmd{C-c C-e a,org-export-as-ascii}
9654 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9655 Export as ASCII file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
9656 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
9657 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9658 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9659 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9660 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
9661 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
9662 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
9664 @orgcmd{C-c C-e A,org-export-as-ascii-to-buffer}
9665 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9666 @orgcmd{C-c C-e n,org-export-as-latin1}
9667 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e N,org-export-as-latin1-to-buffer}
9668 Like the above commands, but use Latin-1 encoding.
9669 @orgcmd{C-c C-e u,org-export-as-utf8}
9670 @xorgcmd{C-c C-e U,org-export-as-utf8-to-buffer}
9671 Like the above commands, but use UTF-8 encoding.
9672 @item C-c C-e v a/n/u
9673 Export only the visible part of the document.
9676 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9677 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
9678 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
9679 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
9680 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
9687 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
9688 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
9689 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
9690 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
9691 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
9692 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
9693 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
9695 @vindex org-export-ascii-links-to-notes
9696 Links will be exported in a footnote-like style, with the descriptive part in
9697 the text and the link in a note before the next heading. See the variable
9698 @code{org-export-ascii-links-to-notes} for details and other options.
9700 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII/Latin-1/UTF-8 export, Exporting
9701 @section HTML export
9704 Org-mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
9705 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
9706 language, but with additional support for tables.
9709 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
9710 * HTML preamble and postamble:: How to insert a preamble and a postamble
9711 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org-mode
9712 * Links in HTML export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
9713 * Tables in HTML export:: How to modify the formatting of tables
9714 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
9715 * Math formatting in HTML export:: Beautiful math also on the web
9716 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
9717 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
9718 * JavaScript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
9721 @node HTML Export commands, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export, HTML export
9722 @subsection HTML export commands
9724 @cindex region, active
9725 @cindex active region
9726 @cindex transient-mark-mode
9728 @orgcmd{C-c C-e h,org-export-as-html}
9729 @cindex property, EXPORT_FILE_NAME
9730 Export as HTML file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org},
9731 the HTML file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
9732 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
9733 @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
9734 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
9735 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
9736 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
9737 property, that name will be used for the export.
9738 @orgcmd{C-c C-e b,org-export-as-html-and-open}
9739 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
9740 @orgcmd{C-c C-e H,org-export-as-html-to-buffer}
9741 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
9742 @orgcmd{C-c C-e R,org-export-region-as-html}
9743 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
9744 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
9745 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
9746 @item C-c C-e v h/b/H/R
9747 Export only the visible part of the document.
9748 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
9749 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org-mode
9750 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
9752 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
9753 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by HTML
9757 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
9758 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
9759 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
9760 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
9761 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
9768 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
9771 @node HTML preamble and postamble, Quoting HTML tags, HTML Export commands, HTML export
9772 @subsection HTML preamble and postamble
9773 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
9774 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
9775 @vindex org-export-html-preamble-format
9776 @vindex org-export-html-postamble-format
9777 @vindex org-export-html-validation-link
9778 @vindex org-export-author-info
9779 @vindex org-export-email-info
9780 @vindex org-export-creator-info
9781 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
9783 The HTML exporter lets you define a preamble and a postamble.
9785 The default value for @code{org-export-html-preamble} is @code{t}, which
9786 means that the preamble is inserted depending on the relevant formatting
9787 string in @code{org-export-html-preamble-format}.
9789 Setting @code{org-export-html-preamble} to a string will override the default
9790 formatting string. Setting it to a function, will insert the output of the
9791 function, which must be a string; such a function takes no argument but you
9792 can check against the value of @code{opt-plist}, which contains the list of
9793 publishing properties for the current file. Setting to @code{nil} will not
9794 insert any preamble.
9796 The default value for @code{org-export-html-postamble} is @code{'auto}, which
9797 means that the HTML exporter will look for the value of
9798 @code{org-export-author-info}, @code{org-export-email-info},
9799 @code{org-export-creator-info} and @code{org-export-time-stamp-file},
9800 @code{org-export-html-validation-link} and build the postamble from these
9801 values. Setting @code{org-export-html-postamble} to @code{t} will insert the
9802 postamble from the relevant formatting string found in
9803 @code{org-export-html-postamble-format}. Setting it to @code{nil} will not
9804 insert any postamble.
9806 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links in HTML export, HTML preamble and postamble, HTML export
9807 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
9809 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{<} and
9810 @samp{>} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
9811 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
9812 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
9813 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
9814 the exported file use either
9817 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9819 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
9823 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
9827 All lines between these markers are exported literally
9832 @node Links in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
9833 @subsection Links in HTML export
9835 @cindex links, in HTML export
9836 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
9837 @cindex external links, in HTML export
9838 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
9839 includes automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
9840 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
9841 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
9842 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
9843 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
9844 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
9845 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
9846 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
9848 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
9849 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
9850 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{title}
9851 and @code{style} attributes for a link:
9855 #+ATTR_HTML: title="The Org-mode homepage" style="color:red;"
9856 [[http://orgmode.org]]
9859 @node Tables in HTML export, Images in HTML export, Links in HTML export, HTML export
9861 @cindex tables, in HTML
9862 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
9864 Org-mode tables are exported to HTML using the table tag defined in
9865 @code{org-export-html-table-tag}. The default setting makes tables without
9866 cell borders and frame. If you would like to change this for individual
9867 tables, place something like the following before the table:
9872 #+CAPTION: This is a table with lines around and between cells
9873 #+ATTR_HTML: border="2" rules="all" frame="all"
9876 @node Images in HTML export, Math formatting in HTML export, Tables in HTML export, HTML export
9877 @subsection Images in HTML export
9879 @cindex images, inline in HTML
9880 @cindex inlining images in HTML
9881 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
9882 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
9883 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
9884 default@footnote{But see the variable
9885 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}.}, images are inlined if a link does
9886 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
9887 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
9888 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
9889 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
9890 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
9891 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
9892 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
9895 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
9898 If you need to add attributes to an inlined image, use a @code{#+ATTR_HTML}.
9899 In the example below we specify the @code{alt} and @code{title} attributes to
9900 support text viewers and accessibility, and align it to the right.
9905 #+CAPTION: A black cat stalking a spider
9906 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="cat/spider image" title="Action!" align="right"
9911 You could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
9913 @node Math formatting in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Images in HTML export, HTML export
9914 @subsection Math formatting in HTML export
9918 @LaTeX{} math snippets (@pxref{LaTeX fragments}) can be displayed in two
9919 different ways on HTML pages. The default is to use the
9920 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org, MathJax system} which should work out of the
9921 box with Org mode installation because @code{http://orgmode.org} serves
9922 @file{MathJax} for Org-mode users for small applications and for testing
9923 purposes. @b{If you plan to use this regularly or on pages with significant
9924 page views, you should install@footnote{Installation instructions can be
9925 found on the MathJax website, see
9926 @uref{http://www.mathjax.org/resources/docs/?installation.html}.} MathJax on
9927 your own server in order to limit the load of our server.} To configure
9928 @file{MathJax}, use the variable @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} or
9929 insert something like the following into the buffer:
9932 #+MATHJAX: align:"left" mathml:t path:"/MathJax/MathJax.js"
9935 @noindent See the docstring of the variable
9936 @code{org-export-html-mathjax-options} for the meaning of the parameters in
9939 If you prefer, you can also request that @LaTeX{} fragments are processed
9940 into small images that will be inserted into the browser page. Before the
9941 availability of MathJax, this was the default method for Org files. This
9942 method requires that the @file{dvipng} program is available on your system.
9943 You can still get this processing with
9946 #+OPTIONS: LaTeX:dvipng
9949 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Math formatting in HTML export, HTML export
9950 @subsection Text areas in HTML export
9952 @cindex text areas, in HTML
9953 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
9954 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
9955 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
9956 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
9957 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
9958 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
9959 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
9960 respectively. For example
9963 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
9964 (defun org-xor (a b)
9971 @node CSS support, JavaScript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
9972 @subsection CSS support
9973 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
9974 @cindex HTML export, CSS
9976 @vindex org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix
9977 @vindex org-export-html-tag-class-prefix
9978 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
9979 assigns the following special CSS classes@footnote{If the classes on TODO
9980 keywords and tags lead to conflicts, use the variables
9981 @code{org-export-html-todo-kwd-class-prefix} and
9982 @code{org-export-html-tag-class-prefix} to make them unique.} to appropriate
9983 parts of the document---your style specifications may change these, in
9984 addition to any of the standard classes like for headlines, tables, etc.
9986 p.author @r{author information, including email}
9987 p.date @r{publishing date}
9988 p.creator @r{creator info, about org-mode version}
9989 .title @r{document title}
9990 .todo @r{TODO keywords, all not-done states}
9991 .done @r{the DONE keywords, all states that count as done}
9992 .WAITING @r{each TODO keyword also uses a class named after itself}
9993 .timestamp @r{timestamp}
9994 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a timestamp, like SCHEDULED}
9995 .timestamp-wrapper @r{span around keyword plus timestamp}
9996 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
9997 ._HOME @r{each tag uses itself as a class, "@@" replaced by "_"}
9998 .target @r{target for links}
9999 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
10000 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
10001 div.outline-N @r{div for outline level N (headline plus text))}
10002 div.outline-text-N @r{extra div for text at outline level N}
10003 .section-number-N @r{section number in headlines, different for each level}
10004 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
10005 pre.src @r{formatted source code}
10006 pre.example @r{normal example}
10007 p.verse @r{verse paragraph}
10008 div.footnotes @r{footnote section headline}
10009 p.footnote @r{footnote definition paragraph, containing a footnote}
10010 .footref @r{a footnote reference number (always a <sup>)}
10011 .footnum @r{footnote number in footnote definition (always <sup>)}
10014 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10015 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
10016 @vindex org-export-html-style
10017 @vindex org-export-html-extra
10018 @vindex org-export-html-style-default
10019 Each exported file contains a compact default style that defines these
10020 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
10021 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
10022 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
10023 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
10024 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
10025 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
10026 fine-grained settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
10027 individually for each file, you can use
10031 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
10035 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
10036 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
10037 referring to an external file.
10039 In order to add styles to a subtree, use the @code{:HTML_CONTAINER_CLASS:}
10040 property to assign a class to the tree. In order to specify CSS styles for a
10041 particular headline, you can use the id specified in a @code{:CUSTOM_ID:}
10044 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
10045 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
10047 @node JavaScript support, , CSS support, HTML export
10048 @subsection JavaScript supported display of web pages
10050 @cindex Rose, Sebastian
10051 Sebastian Rose has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
10052 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
10053 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
10054 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
10055 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
10056 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
10057 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
10058 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
10059 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
10060 We host the script at our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
10061 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
10062 copy on your own web server.
10064 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
10065 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
10066 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
10067 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
10068 adding a single line to the Org file:
10070 @cindex #+INFOJS_OPT
10072 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
10076 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
10077 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
10081 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
10082 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
10083 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
10084 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
10085 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
10086 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
10087 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
10088 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
10089 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
10090 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
10091 @r{@code{org-export-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
10092 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-export-headline-levels}, each}
10093 @r{info/folding section can still contain child headlines.}
10094 toc: @r{Should the table of contents @emph{initially} be visible?}
10095 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the "toc" with @kbd{i}.}
10096 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
10097 @r{the variables @code{org-export-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
10098 ftoc: @r{Does the CSS of the page specify a fixed position for the "toc"?}
10099 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
10100 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
10101 @r{Make this @code{above} if the section should be above initial text.}
10102 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
10103 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
10104 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
10105 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
10108 @vindex org-infojs-options
10109 @vindex org-export-html-use-infojs
10110 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
10111 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
10112 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
10114 @node LaTeX and PDF export, DocBook export, HTML export, Exporting
10115 @section @LaTeX{} and PDF export
10116 @cindex @LaTeX{} export
10118 @cindex Guerry, Bastien
10120 Org-mode contains a @LaTeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
10121 further processing@footnote{The default LaTeX output is designed for
10122 processing with pdftex or latex. It includes packages that are not
10123 compatible with xetex and possibly luatex. See the variables
10124 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10125 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist}.}, this backend is also used to
10126 produce PDF output. Since the @LaTeX{} output uses @file{hyperref} to
10127 implement links and cross references, the PDF output file will be fully
10128 linked. Beware of the fact that your @code{org} file has to be properly
10129 structured in order to be correctly exported: respect the hierarchy of
10133 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
10134 * Header and sectioning:: Setting up the export file structure
10135 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal @LaTeX{} code
10136 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to @LaTeX{}
10137 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into @LaTeX{} output
10138 * Beamer class export:: Turning the file into a presentation
10141 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
10142 @subsection @LaTeX{} export commands
10144 @cindex region, active
10145 @cindex active region
10146 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10148 @orgcmd{C-c C-e l,org-export-as-latex}
10149 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10150 Export as @LaTeX{} file. For an Org file
10151 @file{myfile.org}, the @LaTeX{} file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
10152 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10153 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} be turned on.}, only the region will be
10154 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10155 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10156 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10157 property, that name will be used for the export.
10158 @orgcmd{C-c C-e L,org-export-as-latex-to-buffer}
10159 Export to a temporary buffer. Do not create a file.
10160 @item C-c C-e v l/L
10161 Export only the visible part of the document.
10162 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
10163 Convert the region to @LaTeX{} under the assumption that it was Org-mode
10164 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
10166 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
10167 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org-mode syntax) by @LaTeX{}
10169 @orgcmd{C-c C-e p,org-export-as-pdf}
10170 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF.
10171 @orgcmd{C-c C-e d,org-export-as-pdf-and-open}
10172 Export as @LaTeX{} and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10175 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
10176 @vindex org-latex-low-levels
10177 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
10178 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
10179 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
10180 convert them to a custom string depending on
10181 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
10183 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
10184 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
10187 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
10191 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
10193 @node Header and sectioning, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
10194 @subsection Header and sectioning structure
10195 @cindex @LaTeX{} class
10196 @cindex @LaTeX{} sectioning structure
10197 @cindex @LaTeX{} header
10198 @cindex header, for LaTeX files
10199 @cindex sectioning structure, for LaTeX export
10201 By default, the @LaTeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
10203 @vindex org-export-latex-default-class
10204 @vindex org-export-latex-classes
10205 @vindex org-export-latex-default-packages-alist
10206 @vindex org-export-latex-packages-alist
10207 @cindex #+LATEX_HEADER
10208 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS
10209 @cindex #+LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10210 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS
10211 @cindex property, LATEX_CLASS_OPTIONS
10212 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
10213 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
10214 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
10215 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
10216 The class must be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}. This variable
10217 defines a header template for each class@footnote{Into which the values of
10218 @code{org-export-latex-default-packages-alist} and
10219 @code{org-export-latex-packages-alist} are spliced.}, and allows you to
10220 define the sectioning structure for each class. You can also define your own
10221 classes there. @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS} or a @code{LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS}
10222 property can specify the options for the @code{\documentclass} macro. You
10223 can also use @code{#+LATEX_HEADER: \usepackage@{xyz@}} to add lines to the
10224 header. See the docstring of @code{org-export-latex-classes} for more
10227 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Tables in LaTeX export, Header and sectioning, LaTeX and PDF export
10228 @subsection Quoting @LaTeX{} code
10230 Embedded @LaTeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX}, will be correctly
10231 inserted into the @LaTeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
10232 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
10233 you can add special code that should only be present in @LaTeX{} export with
10234 the following constructs:
10237 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10239 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
10243 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
10247 All lines between these markers are exported literally
10252 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
10253 @subsection Tables in @LaTeX{} export
10254 @cindex tables, in @LaTeX{} export
10256 For @LaTeX{} export of a table, you can specify a label, a caption and
10257 placement options (@pxref{Images and tables}). You can also use the
10258 @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to request a @code{longtable} environment for the
10259 table, so that it may span several pages, or to change the default table
10260 environment from @code{table} to @code{table*} or to change the default inner
10261 tabular environment to @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}. Finally, you can
10262 set the alignment string, and (with @code{tabularx} or @code{tabulary}) the
10267 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10269 #+CAPTION: A long table
10271 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable align=l|lp@{3cm@}r|l
10276 or to specify a multicolumn table with @code{tabulary}
10280 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10282 #+CAPTION: A wide table with tabulary
10284 #+ATTR_LaTeX: table* tabulary width=\textwidth
10289 @node Images in LaTeX export, Beamer class export, Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10290 @subsection Images in @LaTeX{} export
10291 @cindex images, inline in @LaTeX{}
10292 @cindex inlining images in @LaTeX{}
10294 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10295 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
10296 output file resulting from @LaTeX{} processing. Org will use an
10297 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
10298 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Images and tables}, the figure
10299 will be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
10300 element. You can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify various other
10301 options. You can ask org to export an image as a float without specifying
10302 a label or a caption by using the keyword @code{float} in this line. Various
10303 optional arguments to the @code{\includegraphics} macro can also be specified
10304 in this fashion. To modify the placement option of the floating environment,
10305 add something like @samp{placement=[h!]} to the attributes. It is to be noted
10306 this option can be used with tables as well@footnote{One can also take
10307 advantage of this option to pass other, unrelated options into the figure or
10308 table environment. For an example see the section ``Exporting org files'' in
10309 @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-hacks.html}}. For example the
10310 @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line below is exported as the @code{figure} environment
10313 If you would like to let text flow around the image, add the word @samp{wrap}
10314 to the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line, which will make the figure occupy the left
10315 half of the page. To fine-tune, the @code{placement} field will be the set
10316 of additional arguments needed by the @code{wrapfigure} environment. Note
10317 that if you change the size of the image, you need to use compatible settings
10318 for @code{\includegraphics} and @code{wrapfigure}.
10322 @cindex #+ATTR_LaTeX
10324 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
10325 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
10326 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
10327 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
10329 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=0.38\textwidth wrap placement=@{r@}@{0.4\textwidth@}
10333 If you wish to include an image which spans multiple columns in a page, you
10334 can use the keyword @code{multicolumn} in the @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX} line. This
10335 will export the image wrapped in a @code{figure*} environment.
10337 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
10338 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in @LaTeX{}.
10340 @node Beamer class export, , Images in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
10341 @subsection Beamer class export
10343 The LaTeX class @file{beamer} allows production of high quality presentations
10344 using LaTeX and pdf processing. Org-mode has special support for turning an
10345 Org-mode file or tree into a @file{beamer} presentation.
10347 When the LaTeX class for the current buffer (as set with @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS:
10348 beamer}) or subtree (set with a @code{LaTeX_CLASS} property) is
10349 @code{beamer}, a special export mode will turn the file or tree into a beamer
10350 presentation. Any tree with not-too-deep level nesting should in principle be
10351 exportable as a beamer presentation. By default, the top-level entries (or
10352 the first level below the selected subtree heading) will be turned into
10353 frames, and the outline structure below this level will become itemize lists.
10354 You can also configure the variable @code{org-beamer-frame-level} to a
10355 different level---then the hierarchy above frames will produce the sectioning
10356 structure of the presentation.
10358 A template for useful in-buffer settings or properties can be inserted into
10359 the buffer with @kbd{M-x org-insert-beamer-options-template}. Among other
10360 things, this will install a column view format which is very handy for
10361 editing special properties used by beamer.
10363 You can influence the structure of the presentation using the following
10368 The environment that should be used to format this entry. Valid environments
10369 are defined in the constant @code{org-beamer-environments-default}, and you
10370 can define more in @code{org-beamer-environments-extra}. If this property is
10371 set, the entry will also get a @code{:B_environment:} tag to make this
10372 visible. This tag has no semantic meaning, it is only a visual aid.
10373 @item BEAMER_envargs
10374 The beamer-special arguments that should be used for the environment, like
10375 @code{[t]} or @code{[<+->]} of @code{<2-3>}. If the @code{BEAMER_col}
10376 property is also set, something like @code{C[t]} can be added here as well to
10377 set an options argument for the implied @code{columns} environment.
10378 @code{c[t]} or @code{c<2->} will set an options for the implied @code{column}
10381 The width of a column that should start with this entry. If this property is
10382 set, the entry will also get a @code{:BMCOL:} property to make this visible.
10383 Also this tag is only a visual aid. When this is a plain number, it will be
10384 interpreted as a fraction of @code{\textwidth}. Otherwise it will be assumed
10385 that you have specified the units, like @samp{3cm}. The first such property
10386 in a frame will start a @code{columns} environment to surround the columns.
10387 This environment is closed when an entry has a @code{BEAMER_col} property
10388 with value 0 or 1, or automatically at the end of the frame.
10390 Additional commands that should be inserted after the environment has been
10391 opened. For example, when creating a frame, this can be used to specify
10395 Frames will automatically receive a @code{fragile} option if they contain
10396 source code that uses the verbatim environment. Special @file{beamer}
10397 specific code can be inserted using @code{#+BEAMER:} and
10398 @code{#+BEGIN_beamer...#+end_beamer} constructs, similar to other export
10399 backends, but with the difference that @code{#+LaTeX:} stuff will be included
10400 in the presentation as well.
10402 Outline nodes with @code{BEAMER_env} property value @samp{note} or
10403 @samp{noteNH} will be formatted as beamer notes, i,e, they will be wrapped
10404 into @code{\note@{...@}}. The former will include the heading as part of the
10405 note text, the latter will ignore the heading of that node. To simplify note
10406 generation, it is actually enough to mark the note with a @emph{tag} (either
10407 @code{:B_note:} or @code{:B_noteNH:}) instead of creating the
10408 @code{BEAMER_env} property.
10410 You can turn on a special minor mode @code{org-beamer-mode} for editing
10418 @orgcmd{C-c C-b,org-beamer-select-environment}
10419 In @code{org-beamer-mode}, this key offers fast selection of a beamer
10420 environment or the @code{BEAMER_col} property.
10423 Column view provides a great way to set the environment of a node and other
10424 important parameters. Make sure you are using a COLUMN format that is geared
10425 toward this special purpose. The command @kbd{M-x
10426 org-insert-beamer-options-template} defines such a format.
10428 Here is a simple example Org document that is intended for beamer export.
10431 #+LaTeX_CLASS: beamer
10432 #+TITLE: Example Presentation
10433 #+AUTHOR: Carsten Dominik
10434 #+LaTeX_CLASS_OPTIONS: [presentation]
10435 #+BEAMER_FRAME_LEVEL: 2
10436 #+BEAMER_HEADER_EXTRA: \usetheme@{Madrid@}\usecolortheme@{default@}
10437 #+COLUMNS: %35ITEM %10BEAMER_env(Env) %10BEAMER_envargs(Args) %4BEAMER_col(Col) %8BEAMER_extra(Ex)
10439 * This is the first structural section
10441 ** Frame 1 \\ with a subtitle
10442 *** Thanks to Eric Fraga :BMCOL:B_block:
10445 :BEAMER_envargs: C[t]
10448 for the first viable beamer setup in Org
10449 *** Thanks to everyone else :BMCOL:B_block:
10453 :BEAMER_envargs: <2->
10455 for contributing to the discussion
10456 **** This will be formatted as a beamer note :B_note:
10457 ** Frame 2 \\ where we will not use columns
10458 *** Request :B_block:
10459 Please test this stuff!
10465 For more information, see the documentation on Worg.
10467 @node DocBook export, OpenDocumentText export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
10468 @section DocBook export
10469 @cindex DocBook export
10471 @cindex Cui, Baoqiu
10473 Org contains a DocBook exporter written by Baoqiu Cui. Once an Org file is
10474 exported to DocBook format, it can be further processed to produce other
10475 formats, including PDF, HTML, man pages, etc., using many available DocBook
10476 tools and stylesheets.
10478 Currently DocBook exporter only supports DocBook V5.0.
10481 * DocBook export commands:: How to invoke DocBook export
10482 * Quoting DocBook code:: Incorporating DocBook code in Org files
10483 * Recursive sections:: Recursive sections in DocBook
10484 * Tables in DocBook export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10485 * Images in DocBook export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10486 * Special characters:: How to handle special characters
10489 @node DocBook export commands, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export, DocBook export
10490 @subsection DocBook export commands
10492 @cindex region, active
10493 @cindex active region
10494 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10496 @orgcmd{C-c C-e D,org-export-as-docbook}
10497 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10498 Export as DocBook file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the DocBook XML
10499 file will be @file{myfile.xml}. The file will be overwritten without
10500 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This requires
10501 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10502 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10503 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10504 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10505 property, that name will be used for the export.
10506 @orgcmd{C-c C-e V,org-export-as-docbook-pdf-and-open}
10507 Export as DocBook file, process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
10509 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command
10510 @vindex org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command
10511 Note that, in order to produce PDF output based on exported DocBook file, you
10512 need to have XSLT processor and XSL-FO processor software installed on your
10513 system. Check variables @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} and
10514 @code{org-export-docbook-xsl-fo-proc-command}.
10516 @vindex org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet
10517 The stylesheet argument @code{%s} in variable
10518 @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-proc-command} is replaced by the value of
10519 variable @code{org-export-docbook-xslt-stylesheet}, which needs to be set by
10520 the user. You can also overrule this global setting on a per-file basis by
10521 adding an in-buffer setting @code{#+XSLT:} to the Org file.
10523 @orgkey{C-c C-e v D}
10524 Export only the visible part of the document.
10527 @node Quoting DocBook code, Recursive sections, DocBook export commands, DocBook export
10528 @subsection Quoting DocBook code
10530 You can quote DocBook code in Org files and copy it verbatim into exported
10531 DocBook file with the following constructs:
10534 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10536 #+DOCBOOK: Literal DocBook code for export
10540 @cindex #+BEGIN_DOCBOOK
10544 All lines between these markers are exported by DocBook exporter
10549 For example, you can use the following lines to include a DocBook warning
10550 admonition. As to what this warning says, you should pay attention to the
10551 document context when quoting DocBook code in Org files. You may make
10552 exported DocBook XML files invalid by not quoting DocBook code correctly.
10557 <para>You should know what you are doing when quoting DocBook XML code
10558 in your Org file. Invalid DocBook XML may be generated by
10559 DocBook exporter if you are not careful!</para>
10564 @node Recursive sections, Tables in DocBook export, Quoting DocBook code, DocBook export
10565 @subsection Recursive sections
10566 @cindex DocBook recursive sections
10568 DocBook exporter exports Org files as articles using the @code{article}
10569 element in DocBook. Recursive sections, i.e.@: @code{section} elements, are
10570 used in exported articles. Top level headlines in Org files are exported as
10571 top level sections, and lower level headlines are exported as nested
10572 sections. The entire structure of Org files will be exported completely, no
10573 matter how many nested levels of headlines there are.
10575 Using recursive sections makes it easy to port and reuse exported DocBook
10576 code in other DocBook document types like @code{book} or @code{set}.
10578 @node Tables in DocBook export, Images in DocBook export, Recursive sections, DocBook export
10579 @subsection Tables in DocBook export
10580 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10582 Tables in Org files are exported as HTML tables, which have been supported since
10585 If a table does not have a caption, an informal table is generated using the
10586 @code{informaltable} element; otherwise, a formal table will be generated
10587 using the @code{table} element.
10589 @node Images in DocBook export, Special characters, Tables in DocBook export, DocBook export
10590 @subsection Images in DocBook export
10591 @cindex images, inline in DocBook
10592 @cindex inlining images in DocBook
10594 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
10595 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will be exported to DocBook
10596 using @code{mediaobject} elements. Each @code{mediaobject} element contains
10597 an @code{imageobject} that wraps an @code{imagedata} element. If you have
10598 specified a caption for an image as described in @ref{Images and tables}, a
10599 @code{caption} element will be added in @code{mediaobject}. If a label is
10600 also specified, it will be exported as an @code{xml:id} attribute of the
10601 @code{mediaobject} element.
10603 @vindex org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes
10604 Image attributes supported by the @code{imagedata} element, like @code{align}
10605 or @code{width}, can be specified in two ways: you can either customize
10606 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} or use the
10607 @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line. Attributes specified in variable
10608 @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes} are applied to all inline
10609 images in the Org file to be exported (unless they are overridden by image
10610 attributes specified in @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} lines).
10612 The @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line can be used to specify additional image
10613 attributes or override default image attributes for individual images. If
10614 the same attribute appears in both the @code{#+ATTR_DOCBOOK:} line and
10615 variable @code{org-export-docbook-default-image-attributes}, the former
10616 takes precedence. Here is an example about how image attributes can be
10621 @cindex #+ATTR_DOCBOOK
10623 #+CAPTION: The logo of Org-mode
10624 #+LABEL: unicorn-svg
10625 #+ATTR_DOCBOOK: scalefit="1" width="100%" depth="100%"
10626 [[./img/org-mode-unicorn.svg]]
10629 @vindex org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions
10630 By default, DocBook exporter recognizes the following image file types:
10631 @file{jpeg}, @file{jpg}, @file{png}, @file{gif}, and @file{svg}. You can
10632 customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-inline-image-extensions} to add
10633 more types to this list as long as DocBook supports them.
10635 @node Special characters, , Images in DocBook export, DocBook export
10636 @subsection Special characters in DocBook export
10637 @cindex Special characters in DocBook export
10639 @vindex org-export-docbook-doctype
10640 @vindex org-entities
10641 Special characters that are written in @TeX{}-like syntax, such as @code{\alpha},
10642 @code{\Gamma}, and @code{\Zeta}, are supported by DocBook exporter. These
10643 characters are rewritten to XML entities, like @code{α},
10644 @code{Γ}, and @code{Ζ}, based on the list saved in variable
10645 @code{org-entities}. As long as the generated DocBook file includes the
10646 corresponding entities, these special characters are recognized.
10648 You can customize variable @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to include the
10649 entities you need. For example, you can set variable
10650 @code{org-export-docbook-doctype} to the following value to recognize all
10651 special characters included in XHTML entities:
10654 "<!DOCTYPE article [
10655 <!ENTITY % xhtml1-symbol PUBLIC
10656 \"-//W3C//ENTITIES Symbol for HTML//EN//XML\"
10657 \"http://www.w3.org/2003/entities/2007/xhtml1-symbol.ent\"
10664 @c begin opendocument
10666 @node OpenDocumentText export, TaskJuggler export, DocBook export, Exporting
10667 @section OpenDocumentText export
10668 @cindex OpenDocumentText export
10669 @cindex K, Jambunathan
10671 Org-mode 7.6 supports export to OpenDocumentText format using
10672 @file{org-odt.el} module contributed by Jambunathan K. This module can be
10673 enabled in one of the following ways based on your mode of installation.
10677 If you have downloaded the Org from the Web, either as a distribution
10678 @file{.zip} or @file{.tar} file, or as a Git archive, enable the @code{odt}
10679 option in variable @code{org-modules}.
10681 If you are using Org that comes bundled with Emacs, then you can install the
10682 OpenDocumentText exporter using the package manager. To do this, customize
10683 the variable @code{package-archives} to include
10684 @uref{http://orgmode.org/pkg/releases/} as one of the package archives.
10688 * OpenDocumentText export commands::How to invoke OpenDocumentText export
10689 * Applying Custom Styles:: How to apply custom styles to the output
10690 * Converting to Other formats:: How to convert to formats like doc, docx etc
10691 * Links in OpenDocumentText export:: How links will be interpreted and formatted
10692 * Tables in OpenDocumentText export:: Tables are exported as HTML tables
10693 * Images in OpenDocumentText export:: How to insert figures into DocBook output
10694 * Additional Documentation:: Where to find more information
10697 @node OpenDocumentText export commands, Applying Custom Styles, OpenDocumentText export, OpenDocumentText export
10698 @subsection OpenDocumentText export commands
10700 @cindex region, active
10701 @cindex active region
10702 @cindex transient-mark-mode
10704 @orgcmd{C-c C-e o,org-export-as-odt}
10705 @cindex property EXPORT_FILE_NAME
10706 Export as OpenDocumentText file. For an Org file, @file{myfile.org}, the
10707 OpenDocumentText file will be @file{myfile.odt}. The file will be
10708 overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{This
10709 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
10710 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
10711 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
10712 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
10713 property, that name will be used for the export.
10714 @orgcmd{C-c C-e O,org-export-as-odt-and-open}
10715 Export as OpenDocumentText file and open the resulting file.
10718 @node Applying Custom Styles, Converting to Other formats, OpenDocumentText export commands, OpenDocumentText export
10719 @subsection Applying Custom Styles
10720 @cindex styles, custom
10721 @cindex template, custom
10723 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
10725 OpenDocumentExporter ships with a custom @file{styles.xml} for formatting of
10726 the exported file. To customize the output to suit your needs you can use
10727 one of the following methods:
10731 Customize the variable @code{org-export-odt-styles-file} to point to either a
10732 @file{styles.xml} file, a OpenDocument Text Template file @code{.ott} or a
10733 combination of Text or Template Document together with a set of member files.
10734 Use the first two options if the styles.xml has no references to additional
10735 set of files and use the last option if the @file{styles.xml} references
10736 additional files like header and footer images.
10738 Use an external tool like unoconv to apply custom templates.
10741 For best results, it is necessary that the style names used by
10742 OpenDocumentText exporter match that used in the @file{styles.xml}.
10744 @node Converting to Other formats, Links in OpenDocumentText export, Applying Custom Styles, OpenDocumentText export
10745 @subsection Converting to Other formats
10750 @vindex org-export-odt-styles-file
10752 Often times there is a need to convert OpenDocumentText files to other
10753 formats like doc, docx or pdf. You can accomplish this by one of the
10757 @item M-x org-lparse
10758 Export the outline first to one of the native formats (like OpenDocumentText)
10759 and immediately post-process it to other formats using an external converter.
10761 @item M-x org-lparse-convert
10762 Export an existing document to other formats using an external converter.
10765 You can choose the converter used for conversion by customizing the variable
10766 @code{org-lparse-convert-process}.
10768 @node Links in OpenDocumentText export, Tables in OpenDocumentText export, Converting to Other formats, OpenDocumentText export
10769 @subsection Links in OpenDocumentText export
10770 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10772 OpenDocumentExporter creates cross-references (aka bookmarks) for links that
10773 are destined locally. It creates internet style links for all other links.
10775 @node Tables in OpenDocumentText export, Images in OpenDocumentText export, Links in OpenDocumentText export, OpenDocumentText export
10776 @subsection Tables in OpenDocumentText export
10777 @cindex tables, in DocBook export
10779 Export of @file{table.el} tables with row or column spanning is not
10780 supported. Such tables are stripped from the exported document.
10782 @node Images in OpenDocumentText export, Additional Documentation, Tables in OpenDocumentText export, OpenDocumentText export
10783 @subsection Images in OpenDocumentText export
10784 @cindex images, embedding in OpenDocumentText
10785 @cindex embedding images in OpenDocumentText
10787 OpenDocumentText exporter can embed images within the exported document. To
10788 embed images, provide a link to the desired image file with no link
10789 description. For example, the following links @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or
10790 @samp{[[./img.jpg]]}, will result in embedding of @samp{img.jpg} in the
10793 The exporter can also embed scaled and explicitly sized images within the
10794 exported document. The markup of the scale and size specifications has not
10795 been standardized yet and is hence conveniently skipped in this document.
10797 The exporter can also make an image the clickable part of a link. To create
10798 clickable images, provide a link whose description is a link to an image
10799 file. For example, the following link
10800 @samp{[[http://orgmode.org][./img.jpg]]}, will result in a clickable image
10801 that links to @uref{http://Orgmode.org} website.
10803 @node Additional Documentation, , Images in OpenDocumentText export, OpenDocumentText export
10804 @subsection Additional documentation
10806 The OpenDocumentText exporter is still in development. For up to date
10807 information, please follow Org mailing list @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}
10810 @c end opendocument
10812 @node TaskJuggler export, Freemind export, OpenDocumentText export, Exporting
10813 @section TaskJuggler export
10814 @cindex TaskJuggler export
10815 @cindex Project management
10817 @uref{http://www.taskjuggler.org/, TaskJuggler} is a project management tool.
10818 It provides an optimizing scheduler that computes your project time lines and
10819 resource assignments based on the project outline and the constraints that
10822 The TaskJuggler exporter is a bit different from other exporters, such as the
10823 HTML and LaTeX exporters for example, in that it does not export all the
10824 nodes of a document or strictly follow the order of the nodes in the
10827 Instead the TaskJuggler exporter looks for a tree that defines the tasks and
10828 a optionally tree that defines the resources for this project. It then
10829 creates a TaskJuggler file based on these trees and the attributes defined in
10832 @subsection TaskJuggler export commands
10835 @orgcmd{C-c C-e j,org-export-as-taskjuggler}
10836 Export as TaskJuggler file.
10838 @orgcmd{C-c C-e J,org-export-as-taskjuggler-and-open}
10839 Export as TaskJuggler file and then open the file with TaskJugglerUI.
10844 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag
10845 Create your tasks as you usually do with Org-mode. Assign efforts to each
10846 task using properties (it is easiest to do this in the column view). You
10847 should end up with something similar to the example by Peter Jones in
10848 @url{http://www.contextualdevelopment.com/static/artifacts/articles/2008/project-planning/project-planning.org}.
10849 Now mark the top node of your tasks with a tag named
10850 @code{:taskjuggler_project:} (or whatever you customized
10851 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-project-tag} to). You are now ready to export
10852 the project plan with @kbd{C-c C-e J} which will export the project plan and
10853 open a gantt chart in TaskJugglerUI.
10855 @subsection Resources
10857 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag
10858 Next you can define resources and assign those to work on specific tasks. You
10859 can group your resources hierarchically. Tag the top node of the resources
10860 with @code{:taskjuggler_resource:} (or whatever you customized
10861 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-resource-tag} to). You can optionally assign an
10862 identifier (named @samp{resource_id}) to the resources (using the standard
10863 Org properties commands, @pxref{Property syntax}) or you can let the exporter
10864 generate identifiers automatically (the exporter picks the first word of the
10865 headline as the identifier as long as it is unique---see the documentation of
10866 @code{org-taskjuggler-get-unique-id}). Using that identifier you can then
10867 allocate resources to tasks. This is again done with the @samp{allocate}
10868 property on the tasks. Do this in column view or when on the task type
10869 @kbd{C-c C-x p allocate @key{RET} <resource_id> @key{RET}}.
10871 Once the allocations are done you can again export to TaskJuggler and check
10872 in the Resource Allocation Graph which person is working on what task at what
10875 @subsection Export of properties
10877 The exporter also takes TODO state information into consideration, i.e.@: if a
10878 task is marked as done it will have the corresponding attribute in
10879 TaskJuggler (@samp{complete 100}). Also it will export any property on a task
10880 resource or resource node which is known to TaskJuggler, such as
10881 @samp{limits}, @samp{vacation}, @samp{shift}, @samp{booking},
10882 @samp{efficiency}, @samp{journalentry}, @samp{rate} for resources or
10883 @samp{account}, @samp{start}, @samp{note}, @samp{duration}, @samp{end},
10884 @samp{journalentry}, @samp{milestone}, @samp{reference}, @samp{responsible},
10885 @samp{scheduling}, etc for tasks.
10887 @subsection Dependencies
10889 The exporter will handle dependencies that are defined in the tasks either
10890 with the @samp{ORDERED} attribute (@pxref{TODO dependencies}), with the
10891 @samp{BLOCKER} attribute (see @file{org-depend.el}) or alternatively with a
10892 @samp{depends} attribute. Both the @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends}
10893 attribute can be either @samp{previous-sibling} or a reference to an
10894 identifier (named @samp{task_id}) which is defined for another task in the
10895 project. @samp{BLOCKER} and the @samp{depends} attribute can define multiple
10896 dependencies separated by either space or comma. You can also specify
10897 optional attributes on the dependency by simply appending it. The following
10898 examples should illustrate this:
10903 :task_id: preparation
10906 * Training material
10908 :task_id: training_material
10911 ** Markup Guidelines
10915 ** Workflow Guidelines
10922 :BLOCKER: training_material @{ gapduration 1d @} preparation
10926 @subsection Reports
10928 @vindex org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports
10929 TaskJuggler can produce many kinds of reports (e.g.@: gantt chart, resource
10930 allocation, etc). The user defines what kind of reports should be generated
10931 for a project in the TaskJuggler file. The exporter will automatically insert
10932 some default reports in the file. These defaults are defined in
10933 @code{org-export-taskjuggler-default-reports}. They can be modified using
10934 customize along with a number of other options. For a more complete list, see
10935 @kbd{M-x customize-group @key{RET} org-export-taskjuggler @key{RET}}.
10937 For more information and examples see the Org-taskjuggler tutorial at
10938 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-taskjuggler.html}.
10940 @node Freemind export, XOXO export, TaskJuggler export, Exporting
10941 @section Freemind export
10942 @cindex Freemind export
10945 The Freemind exporter was written by Lennart Borgman.
10948 @orgcmd{C-c C-e m,org-export-as-freemind}
10949 Export as Freemind mind map. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the Freemind
10950 file will be @file{myfile.mm}.
10953 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, Freemind export, Exporting
10954 @section XOXO export
10955 @cindex XOXO export
10957 Org-mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
10958 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
10959 does not interpret any additional Org-mode features.
10962 @orgcmd{C-c C-e x,org-export-as-xoxo}
10963 Export as XOXO file. For an Org file @file{myfile.org}, the XOXO file will be
10964 @file{myfile.html}.
10965 @orgkey{C-c C-e v x}
10966 Export only the visible part of the document.
10969 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
10970 @section iCalendar export
10971 @cindex iCalendar export
10973 @vindex org-icalendar-include-todo
10974 @vindex org-icalendar-use-deadline
10975 @vindex org-icalendar-use-scheduled
10976 @vindex org-icalendar-categories
10977 @vindex org-icalendar-alarm-time
10978 Some people use Org-mode for keeping track of projects, but still prefer a
10979 standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments. In this
10980 case it can be useful to show deadlines and other time-stamped items in Org
10981 files in the calendar application. Org-mode can export calendar information
10982 in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to have TODO entries
10983 included in the export, configure the variable
10984 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. Plain timestamps are exported as VEVENT,
10985 and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from deadlines that are
10986 in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO items will be used
10987 to set the start and due dates for the TODO entry@footnote{See the variables
10988 @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}.
10989 As categories, it will use the tags locally defined in the heading, and the
10990 file/tree category@footnote{To add inherited tags or the TODO state,
10991 configure the variable @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}. See the variable
10992 @code{org-icalendar-alarm-time} for a way to assign alarms to entries with a
10995 @vindex org-icalendar-store-UID
10996 @cindex property, ID
10997 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
10998 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
10999 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
11000 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
11001 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
11002 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
11003 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
11004 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
11005 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
11008 @orgcmd{C-c C-e i,org-export-icalendar-this-file}
11009 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
11010 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
11011 @orgcmd{C-c C-e I, org-export-icalendar-all-agenda-files}
11012 @vindex org-agenda-files
11013 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
11014 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
11015 file will be written.
11016 @orgcmd{C-c C-e c,org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files}
11017 @vindex org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file
11018 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
11019 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
11020 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
11023 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
11024 @vindex org-icalendar-include-body
11025 @cindex property, SUMMARY
11026 @cindex property, DESCRIPTION
11027 @cindex property, LOCATION
11028 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
11029 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
11030 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
11031 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
11032 and the description from the body (limited to
11033 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
11035 How this calendar is best read and updated, depends on the application
11036 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
11038 @node Publishing, Working With Source Code, Exporting, Top
11039 @chapter Publishing
11042 Org includes a publishing management system that allows you to configure
11043 automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of interlinked org
11044 files. You can also configure Org to automatically upload your exported HTML
11045 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to a web
11048 You can also use Org to convert files into PDF, or even combine HTML and PDF
11049 conversion so that files are available in both formats on the server.
11051 Publishing has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
11054 * Configuration:: Defining projects
11055 * Uploading files:: How to get files up on the server
11056 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
11057 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
11060 @node Configuration, Uploading files, Publishing, Publishing
11061 @section Configuration
11063 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
11064 and many other properties of a project.
11067 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
11068 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
11069 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
11070 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
11071 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML/@LaTeX{} export
11072 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
11073 * Sitemap:: Generating a list of all pages
11074 * Generating an index:: An index that reaches across pages
11077 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
11078 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
11079 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
11080 @cindex projects, for publishing
11082 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
11083 Publishing is configured almost entirely through setting the value of one
11084 variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}. Each element of the list
11085 configures one project, and may be in one of the two following forms:
11088 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
11089 @r{i.e.@: a well-formed property list with alternating keys and values}
11091 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
11095 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values. A
11096 project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as the
11097 publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When a project
11098 takes the second form listed above, the individual members of the
11099 @code{:components} property are taken to be sub-projects, which group
11100 together files requiring different publishing options. When you publish such
11101 a ``meta-project'', all the components will also be published, in the
11104 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
11105 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
11106 @cindex directories, for publishing
11108 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
11109 particular, Org needs to know where to look for source files,
11110 and where to put published files.
11112 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
11113 @item @code{:base-directory}
11114 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
11115 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
11116 @tab Directory where output files will be published. You can directly
11117 publish to a webserver using a file name syntax appropriate for
11118 the Emacs @file{tramp} package. Or you can publish to a local directory and
11119 use external tools to upload your website (@pxref{Uploading files}).
11120 @item @code{:preparation-function}
11121 @tab Function or list of functions to be called before starting the
11122 publishing process, for example, to run @code{make} for updating files to be
11123 published. The project property list is scoped into this call as the
11124 variable @code{project-plist}.
11125 @item @code{:completion-function}
11126 @tab Function or list of functions called after finishing the publishing
11127 process, for example, to change permissions of the resulting files. The
11128 project property list is scoped into this call as the variable
11129 @code{project-plist}.
11133 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
11134 @subsection Selecting files
11135 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
11137 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
11138 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
11140 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
11141 @item @code{:base-extension}
11142 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
11143 regular expression. Set this to the symbol @code{any} if you want to get all
11144 files in @code{:base-directory}, even without extension.
11146 @item @code{:exclude}
11147 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
11148 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
11151 @item @code{:include}
11152 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
11153 and @code{:exclude}.
11155 @item @code{:recursive}
11156 @tab Non-nil means, check base-directory recursively for files to publish.
11159 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
11160 @subsection Publishing action
11161 @cindex action, for publishing
11163 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
11164 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
11165 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
11166 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
11167 export}). But you also can publish your content as PDF files using
11168 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}, or as @code{ascii}, @code{latin1} or
11169 @code{utf8} encoded files using the corresponding functions. If you want to
11170 publish the Org file itself, but with @i{archived}, @i{commented}, and
11171 @i{tag-excluded} trees removed, use @code{org-publish-org-to-org} and set the
11172 parameters @code{:plain-source} and/or @code{:htmlized-source}. This will
11173 produce @file{file.org} and @file{file.org.html} in the publishing
11174 directory@footnote{@file{file-source.org} and @file{file-source.org.html} if
11175 source and publishing directories are equal. Note that with this kind of
11176 setup, you need to add @code{:exclude "-source\\.org"} to the project
11177 definition in @code{org-publish-project-alist} to prevent the published
11178 source files from being considered as new org files the next time the project
11179 is published.}. Other files like images only need to be copied to the
11180 publishing destination; for this you may use @code{org-publish-attachment}.
11181 For non-Org files, you always need to specify the publishing function:
11183 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
11184 @item @code{:publishing-function}
11185 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
11186 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
11187 @item @code{:plain-source}
11188 @tab Non-nil means, publish plain source.
11189 @item @code{:htmlized-source}
11190 @tab Non-nil means, publish htmlized source.
11193 The function must accept three arguments: a property list containing at least
11194 a @code{:publishing-directory} property, the name of the file to be
11195 published, and the path to the publishing directory of the output file. It
11196 should take the specified file, make the necessary transformation (if any)
11197 and place the result into the destination folder.
11199 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
11200 @subsection Options for the HTML/@LaTeX{} exporters
11201 @cindex options, for publishing
11203 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
11204 and @LaTeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
11205 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
11206 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
11207 respective variable for details.
11209 @vindex org-export-html-link-up
11210 @vindex org-export-html-link-home
11211 @vindex org-export-default-language
11212 @vindex org-display-custom-times
11213 @vindex org-export-headline-levels
11214 @vindex org-export-with-section-numbers
11215 @vindex org-export-section-number-format
11216 @vindex org-export-with-toc
11217 @vindex org-export-preserve-breaks
11218 @vindex org-export-with-archived-trees
11219 @vindex org-export-with-emphasize
11220 @vindex org-export-with-sub-superscripts
11221 @vindex org-export-with-special-strings
11222 @vindex org-export-with-footnotes
11223 @vindex org-export-with-drawers
11224 @vindex org-export-with-tags
11225 @vindex org-export-with-todo-keywords
11226 @vindex org-export-with-tasks
11227 @vindex org-export-with-done-tasks
11228 @vindex org-export-with-priority
11229 @vindex org-export-with-TeX-macros
11230 @vindex org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments
11231 @vindex org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading
11232 @vindex org-export-with-fixed-width
11233 @vindex org-export-with-timestamps
11234 @vindex org-export-author-info
11235 @vindex org-export-email-info
11236 @vindex org-export-creator-info
11237 @vindex org-export-time-stamp-file
11238 @vindex org-export-with-tables
11239 @vindex org-export-highlight-first-table-line
11240 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-default
11241 @vindex org-export-html-style-include-scripts
11242 @vindex org-export-html-style
11243 @vindex org-export-html-style-extra
11244 @vindex org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html
11245 @vindex org-export-html-inline-images
11246 @vindex org-export-html-extension
11247 @vindex org-export-html-table-tag
11248 @vindex org-export-html-expand
11249 @vindex org-export-html-with-timestamp
11250 @vindex org-export-publishing-directory
11251 @vindex org-export-html-preamble
11252 @vindex org-export-html-postamble
11253 @vindex user-full-name
11254 @vindex user-mail-address
11255 @vindex org-export-select-tags
11256 @vindex org-export-exclude-tags
11258 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
11259 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
11260 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
11261 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
11262 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
11263 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
11264 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
11265 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
11266 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
11267 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
11268 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
11269 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
11270 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
11271 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
11272 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
11273 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
11274 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
11275 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
11276 @item @code{:tasks} @tab @code{org-export-with-tasks}
11277 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
11278 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
11279 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
11280 @item @code{:latex-listings} @tab @code{org-export-latex-listings}
11281 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
11282 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
11283 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
11284 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
11285 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address} : @code{addr;addr;..}
11286 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
11287 @item @code{:email-info} @tab @code{org-export-email-info}
11288 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
11289 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
11290 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
11291 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
11292 @item @code{:style-include-scripts} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-scripts}
11293 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
11294 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
11295 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
11296 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
11297 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
11298 @item @code{:html-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
11299 @item @code{:html-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
11300 @item @code{:xml-declaration} @tab @code{org-export-html-xml-declaration}
11301 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
11302 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
11303 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
11304 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
11305 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
11306 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
11307 @item @code{:latex-image-options} @tab @code{org-export-latex-image-default-option}
11310 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
11311 both HTML and @LaTeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
11312 @code{:LaTeX-fragments} options, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
11313 @LaTeX{} export. See @code{org-export-plist-vars} to check this list of
11318 @vindex org-publish-project-alist
11319 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
11320 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
11321 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
11322 options}), however, override everything.
11324 @node Publishing links, Sitemap, Publishing options, Configuration
11325 @subsection Links between published files
11326 @cindex links, publishing
11328 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
11329 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
11330 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). When published, this link
11331 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
11332 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
11333 you publish them to HTML. If you also publish the Org source file and want
11334 to link to that, use an @code{http:} link instead of a @code{file:} link,
11335 because @code{file:} links are converted to link to the corresponding
11338 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are careful
11339 with relative file names, and provided you have also configured Org to upload
11340 the related files, these links will work too. See @ref{Complex example}, for
11341 an example of this usage.
11343 Sometimes an Org file to be published may contain links that are
11344 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
11345 location. In this case, use the property
11347 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
11348 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
11349 @tab Function to validate links
11353 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
11354 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
11355 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
11356 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
11357 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
11358 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
11359 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
11361 @node Sitemap, Generating an index, Publishing links, Configuration
11362 @subsection Generating a sitemap
11363 @cindex sitemap, of published pages
11365 The following properties may be used to control publishing of
11366 a map of files for a given project.
11368 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.65
11369 @item @code{:auto-sitemap}
11370 @tab When non-nil, publish a sitemap during @code{org-publish-current-project}
11371 or @code{org-publish-all}.
11373 @item @code{:sitemap-filename}
11374 @tab Filename for output of sitemap. Defaults to @file{sitemap.org} (which
11375 becomes @file{sitemap.html}).
11377 @item @code{:sitemap-title}
11378 @tab Title of sitemap page. Defaults to name of file.
11380 @item @code{:sitemap-function}
11381 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of the sitemap.
11382 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-sitemap}, which generates a plain list
11383 of links to all files in the project.
11385 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-folders}
11386 @tab Where folders should appear in the sitemap. Set this to @code{first}
11387 (default) or @code{last} to display folders first or last,
11388 respectively. Any other value will mix files and folders.
11390 @item @code{:sitemap-sort-files}
11391 @tab How the files are sorted in the site map. Set this to
11392 @code{alphabetically} (default), @code{chronologically} or
11393 @code{anti-chronologically}. @code{chronologically} sorts the files with
11394 older date first while @code{anti-chronologically} sorts the files with newer
11395 date first. @code{alphabetically} sorts the files alphabetically. The date of
11396 a file is retrieved with @code{org-publish-find-date}.
11398 @item @code{:sitemap-ignore-case}
11399 @tab Should sorting be case-sensitive? Default @code{nil}.
11401 @item @code{:sitemap-file-entry-format}
11402 @tab With this option one can tell how a sitemap's entry is formated in the
11403 sitemap. This is a format string with some escape sequences: @code{%t} stands
11404 for the title of the file, @code{%a} stands for the author of the file and
11405 @code{%d} stands for the date of the file. The date is retrieved with the
11406 @code{org-publish-find-date} function and formated with
11407 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format}. Default @code{%t}.
11409 @item @code{:sitemap-date-format}
11410 @tab Format string for the @code{format-time-string} function that tells how
11411 a sitemap entry's date is to be formated. This property bypasses
11412 @code{org-publish-sitemap-date-format} which defaults to @code{%Y-%m-%d}.
11414 @item @code{:sitemap-sans-extension}
11415 @tab When non-nil, remove filenames' extensions from the generated sitemap.
11416 Useful to have cool URIs (see @uref{http://www.w3.org/Provider/Style/URI}).
11417 Defaults to @code{nil}.
11421 @node Generating an index, , Sitemap, Configuration
11422 @subsection Generating an index
11423 @cindex index, in a publishing project
11425 Org-mode can generate an index across the files of a publishing project.
11427 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
11428 @item @code{:makeindex}
11429 @tab When non-nil, generate in index in the file @file{theindex.org} and
11430 publish it as @file{theindex.html}.
11433 The file will be created when first publishing a project with the
11434 @code{:makeindex} set. The file only contains a statement @code{#+include:
11435 "theindex.inc"}. You can then build around this include statement by adding
11436 a title, style information, etc.
11438 @node Uploading files, Sample configuration, Configuration, Publishing
11439 @section Uploading files
11443 For those people already utilizing third party sync tools such as
11444 @command{rsync} or @command{unison}, it might be preferable not to use the built in
11445 @i{remote} publishing facilities of Org-mode which rely heavily on
11446 Tramp. Tramp, while very useful and powerful, tends not to be
11447 so efficient for multiple file transfer and has been known to cause problems
11450 Specialized synchronization utilities offer several advantages. In addition
11451 to timestamp comparison, they also do content and permissions/attribute
11452 checks. For this reason you might prefer to publish your web to a local
11453 directory (possibly even @i{in place} with your Org files) and then use
11454 @file{unison} or @file{rsync} to do the synchronization with the remote host.
11456 Since Unison (for example) can be configured as to which files to transfer to
11457 a certain remote destination, it can greatly simplify the project publishing
11458 definition. Simply keep all files in the correct location, process your Org
11459 files with @code{org-publish} and let the synchronization tool do the rest.
11460 You do not need, in this scenario, to include attachments such as @file{jpg},
11461 @file{css} or @file{gif} files in the project definition since the 3rd party
11464 Publishing to a local directory is also much faster than to a remote one, so
11465 that you can afford more easily to republish entire projects. If you set
11466 @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag} to @code{nil}, you gain the main
11467 benefit of re-including any changed external files such as source example
11468 files you might include with @code{#+INCLUDE}. The timestamp mechanism in
11469 Org is not smart enough to detect if included files have been modified.
11471 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Uploading files, Publishing
11472 @section Sample configuration
11474 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
11475 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
11476 more complex, with a multi-component project.
11479 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
11480 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
11483 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
11484 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
11486 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
11487 directory on the local machine.
11490 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11492 :base-directory "~/org/"
11493 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
11494 :section-numbers nil
11495 :table-of-contents nil
11496 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11497 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
11498 type=\"text/css\"/>")))
11501 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
11502 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
11504 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
11505 Org files converted to HTML, image files, Emacs Lisp source code, and
11506 style sheets. The publishing directory is remote and private files are
11509 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
11510 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
11511 paths. For example, if your Org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
11512 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you would link to an image with
11515 file:../images/myimage.png
11518 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
11519 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
11520 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
11523 (setq org-publish-project-alist
11525 :base-directory "~/org/"
11526 :base-extension "org"
11527 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
11528 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
11529 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
11531 :section-numbers nil
11532 :table-of-contents nil
11533 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
11534 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\"/>"
11538 :base-directory "~/images/"
11539 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
11540 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
11541 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11544 :base-directory "~/other/"
11545 :base-extension "css\\|el"
11546 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
11547 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
11548 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
11551 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
11552 @section Triggering publication
11554 Once properly configured, Org can publish with the following commands:
11557 @orgcmd{C-c C-e X,org-publish}
11558 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
11559 @orgcmd{C-c C-e P,org-publish-current-project}
11560 Publish the project containing the current file.
11561 @orgcmd{C-c C-e F,org-publish-current-file}
11562 Publish only the current file.
11563 @orgcmd{C-c C-e E,org-publish-all}
11564 Publish every project.
11567 @vindex org-publish-use-timestamps-flag
11568 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above functions
11569 normally only publish changed files. You can override this and force
11570 publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument to any of the commands
11571 above, or by customizing the variable @code{org-publish-use-timestamps-flag}.
11572 This may be necessary in particular if files include other files via
11573 @code{#+SETUPFILE:} or @code{#+INCLUDE:}.
11575 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11576 @comment Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11578 @node Working With Source Code, Miscellaneous, Publishing, Top
11579 @chapter Working with source code
11580 @cindex Schulte, Eric
11581 @cindex Davison, Dan
11582 @cindex source code, working with
11584 Source code can be included in Org-mode documents using a @samp{src} block,
11588 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
11589 (defun org-xor (a b)
11595 Org-mode provides a number of features for working with live source code,
11596 including editing of code blocks in their native major-mode, evaluation of
11597 code blocks, converting code blocks into source files (known as @dfn{tangling}
11598 in literate programming), and exporting code blocks and their
11599 results in several formats. This functionality was contributed by Eric
11600 Schulte and Dan Davison, and was originally named Org-babel.
11602 The following sections describe Org-mode's code block handling facilities.
11605 * Structure of code blocks:: Code block syntax described
11606 * Editing source code:: Language major-mode editing
11607 * Exporting code blocks:: Export contents and/or results
11608 * Extracting source code:: Create pure source code files
11609 * Evaluating code blocks:: Place results of evaluation in the Org-mode buffer
11610 * Library of Babel:: Use and contribute to a library of useful code blocks
11611 * Languages:: List of supported code block languages
11612 * Header arguments:: Configure code block functionality
11613 * Results of evaluation:: How evaluation results are handled
11614 * Noweb reference syntax:: Literate programming in Org-mode
11615 * Key bindings and useful functions:: Work quickly with code blocks
11616 * Batch execution:: Call functions from the command line
11619 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11620 @comment Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11622 @node Structure of code blocks, Editing source code, Working With Source Code, Working With Source Code
11623 @section Structure of code blocks
11624 @cindex code block, structure
11625 @cindex source code, block structure
11627 The structure of code blocks is as follows:
11631 #+begin_src <language> <switches> <header arguments>
11636 Switches and header arguments are optional. Code can also be embedded in text
11640 src_<language>@{<body>@}
11646 src_<language>[<header arguments>]@{<body>@}
11651 This name is associated with the code block. This is similar to the
11652 @samp{#+tblname} lines that can be used to name tables in Org-mode files.
11653 Referencing the name of a code block makes it possible to evaluate the
11654 block from other places in the file, other files, or from Org-mode table
11655 formulas (see @ref{The spreadsheet}). Names are assumed to be unique by
11656 evaluation functions and the behavior of multiple blocks of the same name is
11659 The language of the code in the block.
11661 Optional switches controlling exportation of the code block (see switches discussion in
11662 @ref{Literal examples})
11663 @item <header arguments>
11664 Optional header arguments control many aspects of evaluation, export and
11665 tangling of code blocks. See the @ref{Header arguments}.
11666 Header arguments can also be set on a per-buffer or per-subtree
11667 basis using properties.
11672 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11673 @comment Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11675 @node Editing source code, Exporting code blocks, Structure of code blocks, Working With Source Code
11676 @section Editing source code
11677 @cindex code block, editing
11678 @cindex source code, editing
11681 Use @kbd{C-c '} to edit the current code block. This brings up
11682 a language major-mode edit buffer containing the body of the code
11683 block. Saving this buffer will write the new contents back to the Org
11684 buffer. Use @kbd{C-c '} again to exit.
11686 The @code{org-src-mode} minor mode will be active in the edit buffer. The
11687 following variables can be used to configure the behavior of the edit
11688 buffer. See also the customization group @code{org-edit-structure} for
11689 further configuration options.
11692 @item org-src-lang-modes
11693 If an Emacs major-mode named @code{<lang>-mode} exists, where
11694 @code{<lang>} is the language named in the header line of the code block,
11695 then the edit buffer will be placed in that major-mode. This variable
11696 can be used to map arbitrary language names to existing major modes.
11697 @item org-src-window-setup
11698 Controls the way Emacs windows are rearranged when the edit buffer is created.
11699 @item org-src-preserve-indentation
11700 This variable is especially useful for tangling languages such as
11701 Python, in which whitespace indentation in the output is critical.
11702 @item org-src-ask-before-returning-to-edit-buffer
11703 By default, Org will ask before returning to an open edit buffer. Set this
11704 variable to nil to switch without asking.
11707 To turn on native code fontification in the @emph{Org} buffer, configure the
11708 variable @code{org-src-fontify-natively}.
11710 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11711 @comment Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11713 @node Exporting code blocks, Extracting source code, Editing source code, Working With Source Code
11714 @section Exporting code blocks
11715 @cindex code block, exporting
11716 @cindex source code, exporting
11718 It is possible to export the @emph{contents} of code blocks, the
11719 @emph{results} of code block evaluation, @emph{neither}, or @emph{both}. For
11720 most languages, the default exports the contents of code blocks. However, for
11721 some languages (e.g.@: @code{ditaa}) the default exports the results of code
11722 block evaluation. For information on exporting code block bodies, see
11723 @ref{Literal examples}.
11725 The @code{:exports} header argument can be used to specify export
11728 @subsubheading Header arguments:
11730 @item :exports code
11731 The default in most languages. The body of the code block is exported, as
11732 described in @ref{Literal examples}.
11733 @item :exports results
11734 The code block will be evaluated and the results will be placed in the
11735 Org-mode buffer for export, either updating previous results of the code
11736 block located anywhere in the buffer or, if no previous results exist,
11737 placing the results immediately after the code block. The body of the code
11738 block will not be exported.
11739 @item :exports both
11740 Both the code block and its results will be exported.
11741 @item :exports none
11742 Neither the code block nor its results will be exported.
11745 It is possible to inhibit the evaluation of code blocks during export.
11746 Setting the @code{org-export-babel-evaluate} variable to @code{nil} will
11747 ensure that no code blocks are evaluated as part of the export process. This
11748 can be useful in situations where potentially untrusted Org-mode files are
11749 exported in an automated fashion, for example when Org-mode is used as the
11750 markup language for a wiki.
11752 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
11753 @comment Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11754 @node Extracting source code, Evaluating code blocks, Exporting code blocks, Working With Source Code
11755 @section Extracting source code
11757 @cindex source code, extracting
11758 @cindex code block, extracting source code
11760 Creating pure source code files by extracting code from source blocks is
11761 referred to as ``tangling''---a term adopted from the literate programming
11762 community. During ``tangling'' of code blocks their bodies are expanded
11763 using @code{org-babel-expand-src-block} which can expand both variable and
11764 ``noweb'' style references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}).
11766 @subsubheading Header arguments
11769 The default. The code block is not included in the tangled output.
11771 Include the code block in the tangled output. The output file name is the
11772 name of the org file with the extension @samp{.org} replaced by the extension
11773 for the block language.
11774 @item :tangle filename
11775 Include the code block in the tangled output to file @samp{filename}.
11779 @subsubheading Functions
11781 @item org-babel-tangle
11782 Tangle the current file. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v t}.
11783 @item org-babel-tangle-file
11784 Choose a file to tangle. Bound to @kbd{C-c C-v f}.
11787 @subsubheading Hooks
11789 @item org-babel-post-tangle-hook
11790 This hook is run from within code files tangled by @code{org-babel-tangle}.
11791 Example applications could include post-processing, compilation or evaluation
11792 of tangled code files.
11795 @node Evaluating code blocks, Library of Babel, Extracting source code, Working With Source Code
11796 @section Evaluating code blocks
11797 @cindex code block, evaluating
11798 @cindex source code, evaluating
11800 Code blocks can be evaluated@footnote{Whenever code is evaluated there is a
11801 potential for that code to do harm. Org-mode provides a number of safeguards
11802 to ensure that it only evaluates code with explicit confirmation from the
11803 user. For information on these safeguards (and on how to disable them) see
11804 @ref{Code evaluation security}.} and the results placed in the Org-mode
11805 buffer. By default, evaluation is only turned on for @code{emacs-lisp} code
11806 blocks, however support exists for evaluating blocks in many languages. See
11807 @ref{Languages} for a list of supported languages. See @ref{Structure of
11808 code blocks} for information on the syntax used to define a code block.
11811 There are a number of ways to evaluate code blocks. The simplest is to press
11812 @kbd{C-c C-c} or @kbd{C-c C-v e} with the point on a code block@footnote{The
11813 @code{org-babel-no-eval-on-ctrl-c-ctrl-c} variable can be used to remove code
11814 evaluation from the @kbd{C-c C-c} key binding.}. This will call the
11815 @code{org-babel-execute-src-block} function to evaluate the block and insert
11816 its results into the Org-mode buffer.
11818 It is also possible to evaluate named code blocks from anywhere in an
11819 Org-mode buffer or an Org-mode table. @code{#+call} (or synonymously
11820 @code{#+function} or @code{#+lob}) lines can be used to remotely execute code
11821 blocks located in the current Org-mode buffer or in the ``Library of Babel''
11822 (see @ref{Library of Babel}). These lines use the following syntax to place
11823 a call on a line by itself.
11826 #+call: <name>(<arguments>)
11827 #+call: <name>[<header args>](<arguments>) <header args>
11830 The following syntax can be used to place these calls within a block of
11834 ...prose... call_<name>(<arguments>) ...prose...
11835 ...prose... call_<name>[<header args>](<arguments>)[<header args>] ...prose...
11840 The name of the code block to be evaluated.
11842 Arguments specified in this section will be passed to the code block. These
11843 arguments should relate to @code{:var} header arguments in the called code
11844 block expressed using standard function call syntax. For example if the
11845 original code block named @code{double} has the header argument @code{:var
11846 n=2}, then the call line passing the number four to that block would be
11847 written as @code{#+call: double(n=2)}.
11848 @item <header args>
11849 Header arguments can be placed either inside the call to the code block or at
11850 the end of the line as shown below.
11853 #+call: code_bloc_name[XXXX](arguments) YYYY
11856 Header arguments located in these two locations are treated differently.
11860 Those placed in the @code{XXXX} location are passed through and applied to
11861 the code block being called. These header arguments affect how the code
11862 block is evaluated, for example @code{[:results output]} will collect the
11863 results from @code{STDOUT} of the called code block.
11865 Those placed in the @code{YYYY} location are applied to the call line and do
11866 not affect the code block being called. These header arguments affect how
11867 the results are incorporated into the Org-mode buffer when the call line is
11868 evaluated, and how the call line is exported. For example @code{:results
11869 org} at the end of the call line will insert the results of the call line
11870 inside of an Org-mode block.
11873 For more examples of passing header arguments to @code{#+call:} lines see
11874 @ref{Header arguments in function calls}.
11877 @node Library of Babel, Languages, Evaluating code blocks, Working With Source Code
11878 @section Library of Babel
11879 @cindex babel, library of
11880 @cindex source code, library
11881 @cindex code block, library
11883 The ``Library of Babel'' is a library of code blocks
11884 that can be called from any Org-mode file. The library is housed in an
11885 Org-mode file located in the @samp{contrib} directory of Org-mode.
11886 Org-mode users can deposit functions they believe to be generally
11887 useful in the library.
11889 Code blocks defined in the ``Library of Babel'' can be called remotely as if
11890 they were in the current Org-mode buffer (see @ref{Evaluating code blocks}
11891 for information on the syntax of remote code block evaluation).
11894 Code blocks located in any Org-mode file can be loaded into the ``Library of
11895 Babel'' with the @code{org-babel-lob-ingest} function, bound to @kbd{C-c C-v
11898 @node Languages, Header arguments, Library of Babel, Working With Source Code
11900 @cindex babel, languages
11901 @cindex source code, languages
11902 @cindex code block, languages
11904 Code blocks in the following languages are supported.
11906 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.3 0.22 0.2
11907 @item @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier} @tab @b{Language} @tab @b{Identifier}
11908 @item Asymptote @tab asymptote @tab Awk @tab awk
11909 @item Emacs Calc @tab calc @tab C @tab C
11910 @item C++ @tab C++ @tab Clojure @tab clojure
11911 @item CSS @tab css @tab ditaa @tab ditaa
11912 @item Graphviz @tab dot @tab Emacs Lisp @tab emacs-lisp
11913 @item gnuplot @tab gnuplot @tab Haskell @tab haskell
11914 @item Java @tab java @tab @tab
11915 @item Javascript @tab js @tab LaTeX @tab latex
11916 @item Ledger @tab ledger @tab Lisp @tab lisp
11917 @item Lilypond @tab lilypond @tab MATLAB @tab matlab
11918 @item Mscgen @tab mscgen @tab Objective Caml @tab ocaml
11919 @item Octave @tab octave @tab Org-mode @tab org
11920 @item Oz @tab oz @tab Perl @tab perl
11921 @item Plantuml @tab plantuml @tab Python @tab python
11922 @item R @tab R @tab Ruby @tab ruby
11923 @item Sass @tab sass @tab Scheme @tab scheme
11924 @item GNU Screen @tab screen @tab shell @tab sh
11925 @item SQL @tab sql @tab SQLite @tab sqlite
11928 Language-specific documentation is available for some languages. If
11929 available, it can be found at
11930 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel/languages}.
11932 The @code{org-babel-load-languages} controls which languages are enabled for
11933 evaluation (by default only @code{emacs-lisp} is enabled). This variable can
11934 be set using the customization interface or by adding code like the following
11935 to your emacs configuration.
11938 The following disables @code{emacs-lisp} evaluation and enables evaluation of
11939 @code{R} code blocks.
11943 (org-babel-do-load-languages
11944 'org-babel-load-languages
11945 '((emacs-lisp . nil)
11949 It is also possible to enable support for a language by loading the related
11950 elisp file with @code{require}.
11953 The following adds support for evaluating @code{clojure} code blocks.
11957 (require 'ob-clojure)
11960 @node Header arguments, Results of evaluation, Languages, Working With Source Code
11961 @section Header arguments
11962 @cindex code block, header arguments
11963 @cindex source code, block header arguments
11965 Code block functionality can be configured with header arguments. This
11966 section provides an overview of the use of header arguments, and then
11967 describes each header argument in detail.
11970 * Using header arguments:: Different ways to set header arguments
11971 * Specific header arguments:: List of header arguments
11974 @node Using header arguments, Specific header arguments, Header arguments, Header arguments
11975 @subsection Using header arguments
11977 The values of header arguments can be set in six different ways, each more
11978 specific (and having higher priority) than the last.
11980 * System-wide header arguments:: Set global default values
11981 * Language-specific header arguments:: Set default values by language
11982 * Buffer-wide header arguments:: Set default values for a specific buffer
11983 * Header arguments in Org-mode properties:: Set default values for a buffer or heading
11984 * Code block specific header arguments:: The most common way to set values
11985 * Header arguments in function calls:: The most specific level
11989 @node System-wide header arguments, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments, Using header arguments
11990 @subsubheading System-wide header arguments
11991 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
11992 System-wide values of header arguments can be specified by customizing the
11993 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} variable:
11997 :results => "replace"
12004 @c org-babel-default-header-args is a variable defined in `org-babel.el'.
12006 @c ((:session . "none")
12007 @c (:results . "replace")
12008 @c (:exports . "code")
12010 @c (:noweb . "no"))
12014 @c Default arguments to use when evaluating a code block.
12017 For example, the following example could be used to set the default value of
12018 @code{:noweb} header arguments to @code{yes}. This would have the effect of
12019 expanding @code{:noweb} references by default when evaluating source code
12023 (setq org-babel-default-header-args
12024 (cons '(:noweb . "yes")
12025 (assq-delete-all :noweb org-babel-default-header-args)))
12028 @node Language-specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, System-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
12029 @subsubheading Language-specific header arguments
12030 Each language can define its own set of default header arguments. See the
12031 language-specific documentation available online at
12032 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/babel}.
12034 @node Buffer-wide header arguments, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Language-specific header arguments, Using header arguments
12035 @subsubheading Buffer-wide header arguments
12036 Buffer-wide header arguments may be specified through the use of a special
12037 line placed anywhere in an Org-mode file. The line consists of the
12038 @code{#+BABEL:} keyword followed by a series of header arguments which may be
12039 specified using the standard header argument syntax.
12041 For example the following would set @code{session} to @code{*R*}, and
12042 @code{results} to @code{silent} for every code block in the buffer, ensuring
12043 that all execution took place in the same session, and no results would be
12044 inserted into the buffer.
12047 #+BABEL: :session *R* :results silent
12050 @node Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Code block specific header arguments, Buffer-wide header arguments, Using header arguments
12051 @subsubheading Header arguments in Org-mode properties
12053 Header arguments are also read from Org-mode properties (see @ref{Property
12054 syntax}), which can be set on a buffer-wide or per-heading basis. An example
12055 of setting a header argument for all code blocks in a buffer is
12058 #+property: tangle yes
12061 When properties are used to set default header arguments, they are looked up
12062 with inheritance, so the value of the @code{:cache} header argument will default
12063 to @code{yes} in all code blocks in the subtree rooted at the following
12074 @vindex org-babel-default-header-args
12075 Properties defined in this way override the properties set in
12076 @code{org-babel-default-header-args}. It is convenient to use the
12077 @code{org-set-property} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-x p} to set properties
12078 in Org-mode documents.
12080 @node Code block specific header arguments, Header arguments in function calls, Header arguments in Org-mode properties, Using header arguments
12081 @subsubheading Code block specific header arguments
12083 The most common way to assign values to header arguments is at the
12084 code block level. This can be done by listing a sequence of header
12085 arguments and their values as part of the @code{#+begin_src} line.
12086 Properties set in this way override both the values of
12087 @code{org-babel-default-header-args} and header arguments specified as
12088 properties. In the following example, the @code{:results} header argument
12089 is set to @code{silent}, meaning the results of execution will not be
12090 inserted in the buffer, and the @code{:exports} header argument is set to
12091 @code{code}, meaning only the body of the code block will be
12092 preserved on export to HTML or LaTeX.
12095 #+source: factorial
12096 #+begin_src haskell :results silent :exports code :var n=0
12098 fac n = n * fac (n-1)
12101 Similarly, it is possible to set header arguments for inline code blocks:
12104 src_haskell[:exports both]@{fac 5@}
12107 Code block header arguments can span multiple lines using =#+header:= or
12108 =#+headers:= lines preceding a code block or nested in between the name and
12109 body of a named code block.
12111 Multi-line header arguments on an un-named code block:
12113 #+headers: :var data1=1
12114 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data2=2
12115 (message "data1:%S, data2:%S" data1 data2)
12122 Multi-line header arguments on a named code block:
12124 #+source: named-block
12125 #+header: :var data=2
12126 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
12127 (message "data:%S" data)
12130 #+results: named-block
12134 @node Header arguments in function calls, , Code block specific header arguments, Using header arguments
12135 @comment node-name, next, previous, up
12136 @subsubheading Header arguments in function calls
12138 At the most specific level, header arguments for ``Library of Babel'' or
12139 function call lines can be set as shown in the two examples below. For more
12140 information on the structure of @code{#+call:} lines see @ref{Evaluating code
12143 The following will apply the @code{:exports results} header argument to the
12144 evaluation of the @code{#+call:} line.
12146 #+call: factorial(n=5) :exports results
12149 The following will apply the @code{:session special} header argument to the
12150 evaluation of the @code{factorial} code block.
12152 #+call: factorial[:session special](n=5)
12155 @node Specific header arguments, , Using header arguments, Header arguments
12156 @subsection Specific header arguments
12157 The following header arguments are defined:
12160 * var:: Pass arguments to code blocks
12161 * results:: Specify the type of results and how they will
12162 be collected and handled
12163 * file:: Specify a path for file output
12164 * dir:: Specify the default (possibly remote)
12165 directory for code block execution
12166 * exports:: Export code and/or results
12167 * tangle:: Toggle tangling and specify file name
12168 * mkdirp:: Toggle creation of parent directories of target
12169 files during tangling
12170 * comments:: Toggle insertion of comments in tangled
12172 * padline:: Control insertion of padding lines in tangled
12174 * no-expand:: Turn off variable assignment and noweb
12175 expansion during tangling
12176 * session:: Preserve the state of code evaluation
12177 * noweb:: Toggle expansion of noweb references
12178 * noweb-ref:: Specify block's noweb reference resolution target
12179 * cache:: Avoid re-evaluating unchanged code blocks
12180 * sep:: Delimiter for writing tabular results outside Org
12181 * hlines:: Handle horizontal lines in tables
12182 * colnames:: Handle column names in tables
12183 * rownames:: Handle row names in tables
12184 * shebang:: Make tangled files executable
12185 * eval:: Limit evaluation of specific code blocks
12188 Additional header arguments are defined on a language-specific basis, see
12191 @node var, results, Specific header arguments, Specific header arguments
12192 @subsubsection @code{:var}
12193 The @code{:var} header argument is used to pass arguments to code blocks.
12194 The specifics of how arguments are included in a code block vary by language;
12195 these are addressed in the language-specific documentation. However, the
12196 syntax used to specify arguments is the same across all languages. The
12197 values passed to arguments can be literal values, values from org-mode tables
12198 and literal example blocks, the results of other code blocks, or Emacs Lisp
12199 code---see the ``Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables'' heading below.
12201 These values can be indexed in a manner similar to arrays---see the
12202 ``indexable variable values'' heading below.
12204 The following syntax is used to pass arguments to code blocks using the
12205 @code{:var} header argument.
12211 where @code{assign} can take one of the following forms
12214 @item literal value
12215 either a string @code{"string"} or a number @code{9}.
12220 #+tblname: example-table
12226 #+source: table-length
12227 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var table=example-table
12231 #+results: table-length
12235 a code block name, as assigned by @code{#+srcname:}, followed by
12239 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var length=table-length()
12247 In addition, an argument can be passed to the code block referenced
12248 by @code{:var}. The argument is passed within the parentheses following the
12253 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=8
12261 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var input=double(input=1)
12270 @subsubheading Alternate argument syntax
12271 It is also possible to specify arguments in a potentially more natural way
12272 using the @code{#+source:} line of a code block. As in the following
12273 example arguments can be packed inside of parenthesis, separated by commas,
12274 following the source name.
12277 #+source: double(input=0, x=2)
12278 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
12283 @subsubheading Indexable variable values
12284 It is possible to reference portions of variable values by ``indexing'' into
12285 the variables. Indexes are 0 based with negative values counting back from
12286 the end. If an index is separated by @code{,}s then each subsequent section
12287 will index into the next deepest nesting or dimension of the value. Note
12288 that this indexing occurs @emph{before} other table related header arguments
12289 like @code{:hlines}, @code{:colnames} and @code{:rownames} are applied. The
12290 following example assigns the last cell of the first row the table
12291 @code{example-table} to the variable @code{data}:
12294 #+results: example-table
12300 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[0,-1]
12308 Ranges of variable values can be referenced using two integers separated by a
12309 @code{:}, in which case the entire inclusive range is referenced. For
12310 example the following assigns the middle three rows of @code{example-table}
12314 #+results: example-table
12321 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[1:3]
12331 Additionally, an empty index, or the single character @code{*}, are both
12332 interpreted to mean the entire range and as such are equivalent to
12333 @code{0:-1}, as shown in the following example in which the entire first
12334 column is referenced.
12337 #+results: example-table
12343 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=example-table[,0]
12351 It is possible to index into the results of code blocks as well as tables.
12352 Any number of dimensions can be indexed. Dimensions are separated from one
12353 another by commas, as shown in the following example.
12357 #+begin_src emacs-lisp
12358 '(((1 2 3) (4 5 6) (7 8 9))
12359 ((10 11 12) (13 14 15) (16 17 18))
12360 ((19 20 21) (22 23 24) (25 26 27)))
12363 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var data=3D[1,,1]
12371 @subsubheading Emacs Lisp evaluation of variables
12373 Emacs lisp code can be used to initialize variable values. When a variable
12374 value starts with @code{(}, @code{[}, @code{'} or @code{`} it will be evaluated as
12375 Emacs Lisp and the result of the evaluation will be assigned as the variable
12376 value. The following example demonstrates use of this evaluation to reliably
12377 pass the file-name of the org-mode buffer to a code block---note that
12378 evaluation of header arguments is guaranteed to take place in the original
12379 org-mode file, while there is no such guarantee for evaluation of the code
12383 #+begin_src sh :var filename=(buffer-file-name) :exports both
12388 Note that values read from tables and lists will not be evaluated as
12389 Emacs Lisp, as shown in the following example.
12395 #+headers: :var data=table[0,0]
12404 @node results, file, var, Specific header arguments
12405 @subsubsection @code{:results}
12407 There are three classes of @code{:results} header argument. Only one option
12408 per class may be supplied per code block.
12412 @b{collection} header arguments specify how the results should be collected
12413 from the code block
12415 @b{type} header arguments specify what type of result the code block will
12416 return---which has implications for how they will be inserted into the
12419 @b{handling} header arguments specify how the results of evaluating the code
12420 block should be handled.
12423 @subsubheading Collection
12424 The following options are mutually exclusive, and specify how the results
12425 should be collected from the code block.
12429 This is the default. The result is the value of the last statement in the
12430 code block. This header argument places the evaluation in functional
12431 mode. Note that in some languages, e.g., Python, use of this result type
12432 requires that a @code{return} statement be included in the body of the source
12433 code block. E.g., @code{:results value}.
12434 @item @code{output}
12435 The result is the collection of everything printed to STDOUT during the
12436 execution of the code block. This header argument places the
12437 evaluation in scripting mode. E.g., @code{:results output}.
12440 @subsubheading Type
12442 The following options are mutually exclusive and specify what type of results
12443 the code block will return. By default, results are inserted as either a
12444 table or scalar depending on their value.
12447 @item @code{table}, @code{vector}
12448 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode table. If a single value is
12449 returned, it will be converted into a table with one row and one column.
12450 E.g., @code{:results value table}.
12452 The results should be interpreted as an Org-mode list. If a single scalar
12453 value is returned it will be converted into a list with only one element.
12454 @item @code{scalar}, @code{verbatim}
12455 The results should be interpreted literally---they will not be
12456 converted into a table. The results will be inserted into the Org-mode
12457 buffer as quoted text. E.g., @code{:results value verbatim}.
12459 The results will be interpreted as the path to a file, and will be inserted
12460 into the Org-mode buffer as a file link. E.g., @code{:results value file}.
12461 @item @code{raw}, @code{org}
12462 The results are interpreted as raw Org-mode code and are inserted directly
12463 into the buffer. If the results look like a table they will be aligned as
12464 such by Org-mode. E.g., @code{:results value raw}.
12466 Results are assumed to be HTML and will be enclosed in a @code{begin_html}
12467 block. E.g., @code{:results value html}.
12469 Results assumed to be LaTeX and are enclosed in a @code{begin_latex} block.
12470 E.g., @code{:results value latex}.
12472 Result are assumed to be parseable code and are enclosed in a code block.
12473 E.g., @code{:results value code}.
12475 The result is converted to pretty-printed code and is enclosed in a code
12476 block. This option currently supports Emacs Lisp, Python, and Ruby. E.g.,
12477 @code{:results value pp}.
12479 The result is wrapped in a @code{begin_result} block. This can be useful for
12480 inserting @code{raw} or @code{org} syntax results in such a way that their
12481 extend is known and they can be automatically removed or replaced.
12484 @subsubheading Handling
12485 The following results options indicate what happens with the
12486 results once they are collected.
12489 @item @code{silent}
12490 The results will be echoed in the minibuffer but will not be inserted into
12491 the Org-mode buffer. E.g., @code{:results output silent}.
12492 @item @code{replace}
12493 The default value. Any existing results will be removed, and the new results
12494 will be inserted into the Org-mode buffer in their place. E.g.,
12495 @code{:results output replace}.
12496 @item @code{append}
12497 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
12498 be appended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
12499 inserted as with @code{replace}.
12500 @item @code{prepend}
12501 If there are pre-existing results of the code block then the new results will
12502 be prepended to the existing results. Otherwise the new results will be
12503 inserted as with @code{replace}.
12506 @node file, dir, results, Specific header arguments
12507 @subsubsection @code{:file}
12509 The header argument @code{:file} is used to specify an external file in which
12510 to save code block results. After code block evaluation an Org-mode style
12511 @code{[[file:]]} link (see @ref{Link format}) to the file will be inserted
12512 into the Org-mode buffer. Some languages including R, gnuplot, dot, and
12513 ditaa provide special handling of the @code{:file} header argument
12514 automatically wrapping the code block body in the boilerplate code required
12515 to save output to the specified file. This is often useful for saving
12516 graphical output of a code block to the specified file.
12518 The argument to @code{:file} should be either a string specifying the path to
12519 a file, or a list of two strings in which case the first element of the list
12520 should be the path to a file and the second a description for the link.
12522 @node dir, exports, file, Specific header arguments
12523 @subsubsection @code{:dir} and remote execution
12525 While the @code{:file} header argument can be used to specify the path to the
12526 output file, @code{:dir} specifies the default directory during code block
12527 execution. If it is absent, then the directory associated with the current
12528 buffer is used. In other words, supplying @code{:dir path} temporarily has
12529 the same effect as changing the current directory with @kbd{M-x cd path}, and
12530 then not supplying @code{:dir}. Under the surface, @code{:dir} simply sets
12531 the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}.
12533 When using @code{:dir}, you should supply a relative path for file output
12534 (e.g.@: @code{:file myfile.jpg} or @code{:file results/myfile.jpg}) in which
12535 case that path will be interpreted relative to the default directory.
12537 In other words, if you want your plot to go into a folder called @file{Work}
12538 in your home directory, you could use
12541 #+begin_src R :file myplot.png :dir ~/Work
12542 matplot(matrix(rnorm(100), 10), type="l")
12546 @subsubheading Remote execution
12547 A directory on a remote machine can be specified using tramp file syntax, in
12548 which case the code will be evaluated on the remote machine. An example is
12551 #+begin_src R :file plot.png :dir /dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:
12552 plot(1:10, main=system("hostname", intern=TRUE))
12556 Text results will be returned to the local Org-mode buffer as usual, and file
12557 output will be created on the remote machine with relative paths interpreted
12558 relative to the remote directory. An Org-mode link to the remote file will be
12561 So, in the above example a plot will be created on the remote machine,
12562 and a link of the following form will be inserted in the org buffer:
12565 [[file:/scp:dand@@yakuba.princeton.edu:/home/dand/plot.png][plot.png]]
12568 Most of this functionality follows immediately from the fact that @code{:dir}
12569 sets the value of the Emacs variable @code{default-directory}, thanks to
12570 tramp. Those using XEmacs, or GNU Emacs prior to version 23 may need to
12571 install tramp separately in order for these features to work correctly.
12573 @subsubheading Further points
12577 If @code{:dir} is used in conjunction with @code{:session}, although it will
12578 determine the starting directory for a new session as expected, no attempt is
12579 currently made to alter the directory associated with an existing session.
12581 @code{:dir} should typically not be used to create files during export with
12582 @code{:exports results} or @code{:exports both}. The reason is that, in order
12583 to retain portability of exported material between machines, during export
12584 links inserted into the buffer will *not* be expanded against @code{default
12585 directory}. Therefore, if @code{default-directory} is altered using
12586 @code{:dir}, it is probable that the file will be created in a location to
12587 which the link does not point.
12590 @node exports, tangle, dir, Specific header arguments
12591 @subsubsection @code{:exports}
12593 The @code{:exports} header argument specifies what should be included in HTML
12594 or LaTeX exports of the Org-mode file.
12598 The default. The body of code is included into the exported file. E.g.,
12599 @code{:exports code}.
12600 @item @code{results}
12601 The result of evaluating the code is included in the exported file. E.g.,
12602 @code{:exports results}.
12604 Both the code and results are included in the exported file. E.g.,
12605 @code{:exports both}.
12607 Nothing is included in the exported file. E.g., @code{:exports none}.
12610 @node tangle, mkdirp, exports, Specific header arguments
12611 @subsubsection @code{:tangle}
12613 The @code{:tangle} header argument specifies whether or not the code
12614 block should be included in tangled extraction of source code files.
12617 @item @code{tangle}
12618 The code block is exported to a source code file named after the full path
12619 (including the directory) and file name (w/o extension) of the Org-mode file.
12620 E.g., @code{:tangle yes}.
12622 The default. The code block is not exported to a source code file.
12623 E.g., @code{:tangle no}.
12625 Any other string passed to the @code{:tangle} header argument is interpreted
12626 as a path (directory and file name relative to the directory of the Org-mode
12627 file) to which the block will be exported. E.g., @code{:tangle path}.
12630 @node mkdirp, comments, tangle, Specific header arguments
12631 @subsubsection @code{:mkdirp}
12633 The @code{:mkdirp} header argument can be used to create parent directories
12634 of tangled files when missing. This can be set to @code{yes} to enable
12635 directory creation or to @code{no} to inhibit directory creation.
12637 @node comments, padline, mkdirp, Specific header arguments
12638 @subsubsection @code{:comments}
12639 By default code blocks are tangled to source-code files without any insertion
12640 of comments beyond those which may already exist in the body of the code
12641 block. The @code{:comments} header argument can be set as follows to control
12642 the insertion of extra comments into the tangled code file.
12646 The default. No extra comments are inserted during tangling.
12648 The code block is wrapped in comments which contain pointers back to the
12649 original Org file from which the code was tangled.
12651 A synonym for ``link'' to maintain backwards compatibility.
12653 Include text from the org-mode file as a comment.
12655 The text is picked from the leading context of the tangled code and is
12656 limited by the nearest headline or source block as the case may be.
12658 Turns on both the ``link'' and ``org'' comment options.
12660 Turns on the ``link'' comment option, and additionally wraps expanded noweb
12661 references in the code block body in link comments.
12664 @node padline, no-expand, comments, Specific header arguments
12665 @subsubsection @code{:padline}
12666 Control in insertion of padding lines around code block bodies in tangled
12667 code files. The default value is @code{yes} which results in insertion of
12668 newlines before and after each tangled code block. The following arguments
12673 Insert newlines before and after each code block body in tangled code files.
12675 Do not insert any newline padding in tangled output.
12678 @node no-expand, session, padline, Specific header arguments
12679 @subsubsection @code{:no-expand}
12681 By default, code blocks are expanded with @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
12682 during tangling. This has the effect of assigning values to variables
12683 specified with @code{:var} (see @ref{var}), and of replacing ``noweb''
12684 references (see @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) with their targets. The
12685 @code{:no-expand} header argument can be used to turn off this behavior.
12687 @node session, noweb, no-expand, Specific header arguments
12688 @subsubsection @code{:session}
12690 The @code{:session} header argument starts a session for an interpreted
12691 language where state is preserved.
12693 By default, a session is not started.
12695 A string passed to the @code{:session} header argument will give the session
12696 a name. This makes it possible to run concurrent sessions for each
12697 interpreted language.
12699 @node noweb, noweb-ref, session, Specific header arguments
12700 @subsubsection @code{:noweb}
12702 The @code{:noweb} header argument controls expansion of ``noweb'' style (see
12703 @ref{Noweb reference syntax}) references in a code block. This header
12704 argument can have one of three values: @code{yes}, @code{no}, or @code{tangle}.
12708 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12709 expanded before the block is evaluated, tangled or exported.
12711 The default. No ``noweb'' syntax specific action is taken on evaluating
12712 code blocks, However, noweb references will still be expanded during
12714 @item @code{tangle}
12715 All ``noweb'' syntax references in the body of the code block will be
12716 expanded before the block is tangled, however ``noweb'' references will not
12717 be expanded when the block is evaluated or exported.
12720 @subsubheading Noweb prefix lines
12721 Noweb insertions are now placed behind the line prefix of the
12722 @code{<<reference>>}.
12723 This behavior is illustrated in the following example. Because the
12724 @code{<<example>>} noweb reference appears behind the SQL comment syntax,
12725 each line of the expanded noweb reference will be commented.
12738 -- multi-line body of example
12741 Note that noweb replacement text that does not contain any newlines will not
12742 be affected by this change, so it is still possible to use inline noweb
12745 @node noweb-ref, cache, noweb, Specific header arguments
12746 @subsubsection @code{:noweb-ref}
12747 When expanding ``noweb'' style references the bodies of all code block with
12748 @emph{either} a block name matching the reference name @emph{or} a
12749 @code{:noweb-ref} header argument matching the reference name will be
12750 concatenated together to form the replacement text.
12752 By setting this header argument at the sub-tree or file level, simple code
12753 block concatenation may be achieved. For example, when tangling the
12754 following Org-mode file, the bodies of code blocks will be concatenated into
12755 the resulting pure code file.
12758 #+begin_src sh :tangle yes :noweb yes :shebang #!/bin/sh
12761 * the mount point of the fullest disk
12763 :noweb-ref: fullest-disk
12766 ** query all mounted disks
12771 ** strip the header row
12776 ** sort by the percent full
12778 |awk '@{print $5 " " $6@}'|sort -n |tail -1 \
12781 ** extract the mount point
12783 |awk '@{print $2@}'
12787 @node cache, sep, noweb-ref, Specific header arguments
12788 @subsubsection @code{:cache}
12790 The @code{:cache} header argument controls the use of in-buffer caching of
12791 the results of evaluating code blocks. It can be used to avoid re-evaluating
12792 unchanged code blocks. This header argument can have one of two
12793 values: @code{yes} or @code{no}.
12797 The default. No caching takes place, and the code block will be evaluated
12798 every time it is called.
12800 Every time the code block is run a SHA1 hash of the code and arguments
12801 passed to the block will be generated. This hash is packed into the
12802 @code{#+results:} line and will be checked on subsequent
12803 executions of the code block. If the code block has not
12804 changed since the last time it was evaluated, it will not be re-evaluated.
12807 Code block caches notice if the value of a variable argument
12808 to the code block has changed. If this is the case, the cache is
12809 invalidated and the code block is re-run. In the following example,
12810 @code{caller} will not be re-run unless the results of @code{random} have
12811 changed since it was last run.
12815 #+begin_src R :cache yes
12819 #+results[a2a72cd647ad44515fab62e144796432793d68e1]: random
12823 #+begin_src emacs-lisp :var x=random :cache yes
12827 #+results[bec9c8724e397d5df3b696502df3ed7892fc4f5f]: caller
12831 @node sep, hlines, cache, Specific header arguments
12832 @subsubsection @code{:sep}
12834 The @code{:sep} header argument can be used to control the delimiter used
12835 when writing tabular results out to files external to Org-mode. This is used
12836 either when opening tabular results of a code block by calling the
12837 @code{org-open-at-point} function bound to @kbd{C-c C-o} on the code block,
12838 or when writing code block results to an external file (see @ref{file})
12841 By default, when @code{:sep} is not specified output tables are tab
12844 @node hlines, colnames, sep, Specific header arguments
12845 @subsubsection @code{:hlines}
12847 Tables are frequently represented with one or more horizontal lines, or
12848 hlines. The @code{:hlines} argument to a code block accepts the
12849 values @code{yes} or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12853 Strips horizontal lines from the input table. In most languages this is the
12854 desired effect because an @code{hline} symbol is interpreted as an unbound
12855 variable and raises an error. Setting @code{:hlines no} or relying on the
12856 default value yields the following results.
12859 #+tblname: many-cols
12866 #+source: echo-table
12867 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols
12871 #+results: echo-table
12878 Leaves hlines in the table. Setting @code{:hlines yes} has this effect.
12881 #+tblname: many-cols
12888 #+source: echo-table
12889 #+begin_src python :var tab=many-cols :hlines yes
12893 #+results: echo-table
12902 @node colnames, rownames, hlines, Specific header arguments
12903 @subsubsection @code{:colnames}
12905 The @code{:colnames} header argument accepts the values @code{yes},
12906 @code{no}, or @code{nil} for unassigned. The default value is @code{nil}.
12910 If an input table looks like it has column names
12911 (because its second row is an hline), then the column
12912 names will be removed from the table before
12913 processing, then reapplied to the results.
12916 #+tblname: less-cols
12922 #+srcname: echo-table-again
12923 #+begin_src python :var tab=less-cols
12924 return [[val + '*' for val in row] for row in tab]
12927 #+results: echo-table-again
12934 Please note that column names are not removed before the table is indexed
12935 using variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
12938 No column name pre-processing takes place
12941 Column names are removed and reapplied as with @code{nil} even if the table
12942 does not ``look like'' it has column names (i.e.@: the second row is not an
12946 @node rownames, shebang, colnames, Specific header arguments
12947 @subsubsection @code{:rownames}
12949 The @code{:rownames} header argument can take on the values @code{yes}
12950 or @code{no}, with a default value of @code{no}.
12954 No row name pre-processing will take place.
12957 The first column of the table is removed from the table before processing,
12958 and is then reapplied to the results.
12961 #+tblname: with-rownames
12962 | one | 1 | 2 | 3 | 4 | 5 |
12963 | two | 6 | 7 | 8 | 9 | 10 |
12965 #+srcname: echo-table-once-again
12966 #+begin_src python :var tab=with-rownames :rownames yes
12967 return [[val + 10 for val in row] for row in tab]
12970 #+results: echo-table-once-again
12971 | one | 11 | 12 | 13 | 14 | 15 |
12972 | two | 16 | 17 | 18 | 19 | 20 |
12975 Please note that row names are not removed before the table is indexed using
12976 variable indexing @xref{var, Indexable variable values}.
12980 @node shebang, eval, rownames, Specific header arguments
12981 @subsubsection @code{:shebang}
12983 Setting the @code{:shebang} header argument to a string value
12984 (e.g.@: @code{:shebang "#!/bin/bash"}) causes the string to be inserted as the
12985 first line of any tangled file holding the code block, and the file
12986 permissions of the tangled file are set to make it executable.
12988 @node eval, , shebang, Specific header arguments
12989 @subsubsection @code{:eval}
12990 The @code{:eval} header argument can be used to limit the evaluation of
12991 specific code blocks. @code{:eval} accepts two arguments ``never'' and
12992 ``query''. @code{:eval never} will ensure that a code block is never
12993 evaluated, this can be useful for protecting against the evaluation of
12994 dangerous code blocks. @code{:eval query} will require a query for every
12995 execution of a code block regardless of the value of the
12996 @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable.
12998 If this header argument is not set then evaluation is determined by the value
12999 of the @code{org-confirm-babel-evaluate} variable see @ref{Code evaluation
13002 @node Results of evaluation, Noweb reference syntax, Header arguments, Working With Source Code
13003 @section Results of evaluation
13004 @cindex code block, results of evaluation
13005 @cindex source code, results of evaluation
13007 The way in which results are handled depends on whether a session is invoked,
13008 as well as on whether @code{:results value} or @code{:results output} is
13009 used. The following table shows the table possibilities. For a full listing
13010 of the possible results header arguments see @ref{results}.
13012 @multitable @columnfractions 0.26 0.33 0.41
13013 @item @tab @b{Non-session} @tab @b{Session}
13014 @item @code{:results value} @tab value of last expression @tab value of last expression
13015 @item @code{:results output} @tab contents of STDOUT @tab concatenation of interpreter output
13018 Note: With @code{:results value}, the result in both @code{:session} and
13019 non-session is returned to Org-mode as a table (a one- or two-dimensional
13020 vector of strings or numbers) when appropriate.
13022 @subsection Non-session
13023 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
13024 This is the default. Internally, the value is obtained by wrapping the code
13025 in a function definition in the external language, and evaluating that
13026 function. Therefore, code should be written as if it were the body of such a
13027 function. In particular, note that Python does not automatically return a
13028 value from a function unless a @code{return} statement is present, and so a
13029 @samp{return} statement will usually be required in Python.
13031 This is the only one of the four evaluation contexts in which the code is
13032 automatically wrapped in a function definition.
13034 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
13035 The code is passed to the interpreter as an external process, and the
13036 contents of the standard output stream are returned as text. (In certain
13037 languages this also contains the error output stream; this is an area for
13040 @subsection Session
13041 @subsubsection @code{:results value}
13042 The code is passed to an interpreter running as an interactive Emacs inferior
13043 process. Only languages which provide tools for interactive evaluation of
13044 code have session support, so some language (e.g., C and ditaa) do not
13045 support the @code{:session} header argument, and in other languages (e.g.,
13046 Python and Haskell) which have limitations on the code which may be entered
13047 into interactive sessions, those limitations apply to the code in code blocks
13048 using the @code{:session} header argument as well.
13050 Unless the @code{:results output} option is supplied (see below) the result
13051 returned is the result of the last evaluation performed by the
13052 interpreter. (This is obtained in a language-specific manner: the value of
13053 the variable @code{_} in Python and Ruby, and the value of @code{.Last.value}
13056 @subsubsection @code{:results output}
13057 The code is passed to the interpreter running as an interactive Emacs
13058 inferior process. The result returned is the concatenation of the sequence of
13059 (text) output from the interactive interpreter. Notice that this is not
13060 necessarily the same as what would be sent to @code{STDOUT} if the same code
13061 were passed to a non-interactive interpreter running as an external
13062 process. For example, compare the following two blocks:
13065 #+begin_src python :results output
13076 In non-session mode, the `2' is not printed and does not appear.
13078 #+begin_src python :results output :session
13090 But in @code{:session} mode, the interactive interpreter receives input `2'
13091 and prints out its value, `2'. (Indeed, the other print statements are
13094 @node Noweb reference syntax, Key bindings and useful functions, Results of evaluation, Working With Source Code
13095 @section Noweb reference syntax
13096 @cindex code block, noweb reference
13097 @cindex syntax, noweb
13098 @cindex source code, noweb reference
13100 The ``noweb'' (see @uref{http://www.cs.tufts.edu/~nr/noweb/}) Literate
13101 Programming system allows named blocks of code to be referenced by using the
13102 familiar Noweb syntax:
13105 <<code-block-name>>
13108 When a code block is tangled or evaluated, whether or not ``noweb''
13109 references are expanded depends upon the value of the @code{:noweb} header
13110 argument. If @code{:noweb yes}, then a Noweb reference is expanded before
13111 evaluation. If @code{:noweb no}, the default, then the reference is not
13112 expanded before evaluation.
13114 Note: the default value, @code{:noweb no}, was chosen to ensure that
13115 correct code is not broken in a language, such as Ruby, where
13116 @code{<<arg>>} is a syntactically valid construct. If @code{<<arg>>} is not
13117 syntactically valid in languages that you use, then please consider setting
13120 @node Key bindings and useful functions, Batch execution, Noweb reference syntax, Working With Source Code
13121 @section Key bindings and useful functions
13122 @cindex code block, key bindings
13124 Many common Org-mode key sequences are re-bound depending on
13127 Within a code block, the following key bindings
13130 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
13132 @item @kbd{C-c C-c} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-src-block}
13134 @item @kbd{C-c C-o} @tab @code{org-babel-open-src-block-result}
13136 @item @kbd{C-@key{up}} @tab @code{org-babel-load-in-session}
13138 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @code{org-babel-pop-to-session}
13141 In an Org-mode buffer, the following key bindings are active:
13143 @multitable @columnfractions 0.45 0.55
13145 @kindex C-c C-v C-a
13146 @item @kbd{C-c C-v a} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
13148 @kindex C-c C-v C-b
13149 @item @kbd{C-c C-v b} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
13151 @kindex C-c C-v C-f
13152 @item @kbd{C-c C-v f} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
13154 @item @kbd{C-c C-v g} @tab @code{org-babel-goto-named-source-block}
13156 @item @kbd{C-c C-v h} @tab @code{org-babel-describe-bindings}
13158 @kindex C-c C-v C-l
13159 @item @kbd{C-c C-v l} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
13161 @kindex C-c C-v C-p
13162 @item @kbd{C-c C-v p} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13164 @kindex C-c C-v C-s
13165 @item @kbd{C-c C-v s} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
13167 @kindex C-c C-v C-t
13168 @item @kbd{C-c C-v t} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
13170 @kindex C-c C-v C-z
13171 @item @kbd{C-c C-v z} @ @ @r{or} @ @ @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
13174 @c When possible these keybindings were extended to work when the control key is
13175 @c kept pressed, resulting in the following additional keybindings.
13177 @c @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
13178 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-a} @tab @code{org-babel-sha1-hash}
13179 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-b} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-buffer}
13180 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-f} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle-file}
13181 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-l} @tab @code{org-babel-lob-ingest}
13182 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-p} @tab @code{org-babel-expand-src-block}
13183 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-s} @tab @code{org-babel-execute-subtree}
13184 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-t} @tab @code{org-babel-tangle}
13185 @c @item @kbd{C-c C-v C-z} @tab @code{org-babel-switch-to-session}
13188 @node Batch execution, , Key bindings and useful functions, Working With Source Code
13189 @section Batch execution
13190 @cindex code block, batch execution
13191 @cindex source code, batch execution
13193 It is possible to call functions from the command line. This shell
13194 script calls @code{org-babel-tangle} on every one of its arguments.
13196 Be sure to adjust the paths to fit your system.
13200 # -*- mode: shell-script -*-
13202 # tangle files with org-mode
13206 ORGINSTALL="~/src/org/lisp/org-install.el"
13208 # wrap each argument in the code required to call tangle on it
13210 FILES="$FILES \"$i\""
13213 emacs -Q --batch -l $ORGINSTALL \
13215 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/lisp/\"))
13216 (add-to-list 'load-path (expand-file-name \"~/src/org/contrib/lisp/\"))
13217 (require 'org)(require 'org-exp)(require 'ob)(require 'ob-tangle)
13218 (mapc (lambda (file)
13219 (find-file (expand-file-name file \"$DIR\"))
13221 (kill-buffer)) '($FILES)))" 2>&1 |grep tangled
13224 @node Miscellaneous, Hacking, Working With Source Code, Top
13225 @chapter Miscellaneous
13228 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
13229 * Easy Templates:: Quick insertion of structural elements
13230 * Speed keys:: Electric commands at the beginning of a headline
13231 * Code evaluation security:: Org mode files evaluate inline code
13232 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
13233 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
13234 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
13235 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
13236 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
13237 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
13238 * org-crypt.el:: Encrypting Org files
13242 @node Completion, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
13243 @section Completion
13244 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
13245 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
13246 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
13247 @cindex completion, of option keywords
13248 @cindex completion, of tags
13249 @cindex completion, of property keys
13250 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
13251 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
13252 @cindex TODO keywords completion
13253 @cindex dictionary word completion
13254 @cindex option keyword completion
13255 @cindex tag completion
13256 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
13258 Emacs would not be Emacs without completion, and Org-mode uses it whenever it
13259 makes sense. If you prefer an @i{iswitchb}- or @i{ido}-like interface for
13260 some of the completion prompts, you can specify your preference by setting at
13261 most one of the variables @code{org-completion-use-iswitchb}
13262 @code{org-completion-use-ido}.
13264 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
13265 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
13266 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
13269 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
13271 Complete word at point
13274 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
13276 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
13278 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
13279 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
13281 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
13282 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
13283 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
13284 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
13286 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
13287 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
13290 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
13292 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
13293 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org-mode. When the
13294 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
13295 will insert example settings for this keyword.
13297 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
13298 i.e.@: valid keys for this line.
13300 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
13304 @node Easy Templates, Speed keys, Completion, Miscellaneous
13305 @section Easy Templates
13306 @cindex template insertion
13307 @cindex insertion, of templates
13309 Org-mode supports insertion of empty structural elements (like
13310 @code{#+BEGIN_SRC} and @code{#+END_SRC} pairs) with just a few key
13311 strokes. This is achieved through a native template expansion mechanism.
13312 Note that Emacs has several other template mechanisms which could be used in
13313 a similar way, for example @file{yasnippet}.
13315 To insert a structural element, type a @samp{<}, followed by a template
13316 selector and @kbd{@key{TAB}}. Completion takes effect only when the above
13317 keystrokes are typed on a line by itself.
13319 The following template selectors are currently supported.
13321 @multitable @columnfractions 0.1 0.9
13322 @item @kbd{s} @tab @code{#+begin_src ... #+end_src}
13323 @item @kbd{e} @tab @code{#+begin_example ... #+end_example}
13324 @item @kbd{q} @tab @code{#+begin_quote ... #+end_quote}
13325 @item @kbd{v} @tab @code{#+begin_verse ... #+end_verse}
13326 @item @kbd{c} @tab @code{#+begin_center ... #+end_center}
13327 @item @kbd{l} @tab @code{#+begin_latex ... #+end_latex}
13328 @item @kbd{L} @tab @code{#+latex:}
13329 @item @kbd{h} @tab @code{#+begin_html ... #+end_html}
13330 @item @kbd{H} @tab @code{#+html:}
13331 @item @kbd{a} @tab @code{#+begin_ascii ... #+end_ascii}
13332 @item @kbd{A} @tab @code{#+ascii:}
13333 @item @kbd{i} @tab @code{#+index:} line
13334 @item @kbd{I} @tab @code{#+include:} line
13337 For example, on an empty line, typing "<e" and then pressing TAB, will expand
13338 into a complete EXAMPLE template.
13340 You can install additional templates by customizing the variable
13341 @code{org-structure-template-alist}. See the docstring of the variable for
13342 additional details.
13344 @node Speed keys, Code evaluation security, Easy Templates, Miscellaneous
13345 @section Speed keys
13347 @vindex org-use-speed-commands
13348 @vindex org-speed-commands-user
13350 Single keys can be made to execute commands when the cursor is at the
13351 beginning of a headline, i.e.@: before the first star. Configure the variable
13352 @code{org-use-speed-commands} to activate this feature. There is a
13353 pre-defined list of commands, and you can add more such commands using the
13354 variable @code{org-speed-commands-user}. Speed keys do not only speed up
13355 navigation and other commands, but they also provide an alternative way to
13356 execute commands bound to keys that are not or not easily available on a TTY,
13357 or on a small mobile device with a limited keyboard.
13359 To see which commands are available, activate the feature and press @kbd{?}
13360 with the cursor at the beginning of a headline.
13362 @node Code evaluation security, Customization, Speed keys, Miscellaneous
13363 @section Code evaluation and security issues
13365 Org provides tools to work with the code snippets, including evaluating them.
13367 Running code on your machine always comes with a security risk. Badly
13368 written or malicious code can be executed on purpose or by accident. Org has
13369 default settings which will only evaluate such code if you give explicit
13370 permission to do so, and as a casual user of these features you should leave
13371 these precautions intact.
13373 For people who regularly work with such code, the confirmation prompts can
13374 become annoying, and you might want to turn them off. This can be done, but
13375 you must be aware of the risks that are involved.
13377 Code evaluation can happen under the following circumstances:
13380 @item Source code blocks
13381 Source code blocks can be evaluated during export, or when pressing @kbd{C-c
13382 C-c} in the block. The most important thing to realize here is that Org mode
13383 files which contain code snippets are, in a certain sense, like executable
13384 files. So you should accept them and load them into Emacs only from trusted
13385 sources---just like you would do with a program you install on your computer.
13387 Make sure you know what you are doing before customizing the variables
13388 which take off the default security brakes.
13390 @defopt org-confirm-babel-evaluate
13391 When t (the default), the user is asked before every code block evaluation.
13392 When nil, the user is not asked. When set to a function, it is called with
13393 two arguments (language and body of the code block) and should return t to
13394 ask and nil not to ask.
13397 For example, here is how to execute "ditaa" code (which is considered safe)
13400 (defun my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate (lang body)
13401 (not (string= lang "ditaa"))) ; don't ask for ditaa
13402 (setq org-confirm-babel-evaluate 'my-org-confirm-babel-evaluate)
13405 @item Following @code{shell} and @code{elisp} links
13406 Org has two link types that can directly evaluate code (@pxref{External
13407 links}). These links can be problematic because the code to be evaluated is
13410 @defopt org-confirm-shell-link-function
13411 Function to queries user about shell link execution.
13413 @defopt org-confirm-elisp-link-function
13414 Functions to query user for Emacs Lisp link execution.
13417 @item Formulas in tables
13418 Formulas in tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}) are code that is evaluated
13419 either by the @i{calc} interpreter, or by the @i{Emacs Lisp} interpreter.
13422 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Code evaluation security, Miscellaneous
13423 @section Customization
13424 @cindex customization
13425 @cindex options, for customization
13426 @cindex variables, for customization
13428 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
13429 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
13430 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
13431 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
13432 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
13433 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
13434 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
13436 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
13437 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
13438 @cindex in-buffer settings
13439 @cindex special keywords
13441 Org-mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
13442 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
13443 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
13444 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
13445 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
13446 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
13447 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
13448 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
13449 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
13451 @vindex org-archive-location
13453 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
13454 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
13455 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
13456 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
13457 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
13459 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
13460 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
13461 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
13462 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
13463 @cindex property, COLUMNS
13464 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
13465 columns view is invoked in locations where no @code{COLUMNS} property
13467 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
13468 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13469 @vindex org-table-formula
13470 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
13471 line sets the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
13472 The global version of this variable is
13473 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
13474 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
13475 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
13477 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
13478 @vindex org-drawers
13479 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
13480 @code{org-drawers}.
13481 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
13482 @vindex org-link-abbrev-alist
13483 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
13484 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
13485 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
13486 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
13487 @vindex org-highest-priority
13488 @vindex org-lowest-priority
13489 @vindex org-default-priority
13490 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
13491 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
13492 have a lower ASCII number than the lowest priority.
13493 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
13494 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
13495 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
13496 @cindex #+SETUPFILE
13497 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
13498 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
13499 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
13500 (i.e.@: when starting Org-mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
13501 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
13502 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
13503 any other Org-mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
13504 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
13507 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org-mode, when an
13508 Org file is being visited.
13510 The first set of options deals with the initial visibility of the outline
13511 tree. The corresponding variable for global default settings is
13512 @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default value @code{t}, which means
13514 @vindex org-startup-folded
13515 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
13516 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
13517 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
13518 @cindex @code{showeverything}, STARTUP keyword
13520 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
13521 content @r{all headlines}
13522 showall @r{no folding of any entries}
13523 showeverything @r{show even drawer contents}
13526 @vindex org-startup-indented
13527 @cindex @code{indent}, STARTUP keyword
13528 @cindex @code{noindent}, STARTUP keyword
13529 Dynamic virtual indentation is controlled by the variable
13530 @code{org-startup-indented}@footnote{Emacs 23 and Org-mode 6.29 are required}
13532 indent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned on}
13533 noindent @r{start with @code{org-indent-mode} turned off}
13536 @vindex org-startup-align-all-tables
13537 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
13538 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
13539 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
13541 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
13542 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
13544 align @r{align all tables}
13545 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
13548 @vindex org-startup-with-inline-images
13549 When visiting a file, inline images can be automatically displayed. The
13550 corresponding variable is @code{org-startup-with-inline-images}, with a
13551 default value @code{nil} to avoid delays when visiting a file.
13552 @cindex @code{inlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
13553 @cindex @code{noinlineimages}, STARTUP keyword
13555 inlineimages @r{show inline images}
13556 noinlineimages @r{don't show inline images on startup}
13559 @vindex org-log-done
13560 @vindex org-log-note-clock-out
13561 @vindex org-log-repeat
13562 Logging the closing and reopening of TODO items and clock intervals can be
13563 configured using these options (see variables @code{org-log-done},
13564 @code{org-log-note-clock-out} and @code{org-log-repeat})
13565 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
13566 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
13567 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
13568 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
13569 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
13570 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
13571 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
13572 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
13573 @cindex @code{logreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
13574 @cindex @code{lognotereschedule}, STARTUP keyword
13575 @cindex @code{nologreschedule}, STARTUP keyword
13576 @cindex @code{logredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
13577 @cindex @code{lognoteredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
13578 @cindex @code{nologredeadline}, STARTUP keyword
13579 @cindex @code{logrefile}, STARTUP keyword
13580 @cindex @code{lognoterefile}, STARTUP keyword
13581 @cindex @code{nologrefile}, STARTUP keyword
13583 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
13584 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
13585 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
13586 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
13587 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
13588 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
13589 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
13590 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
13591 logreschedule @r{record a timestamp when scheduling time changes}
13592 lognotereschedule @r{record a note when scheduling time changes}
13593 nologreschedule @r{do not record when a scheduling date changes}
13594 logredeadline @r{record a timestamp when deadline changes}
13595 lognoteredeadline @r{record a note when deadline changes}
13596 nologredeadline @r{do not record when a deadline date changes}
13597 logrefile @r{record a timestamp when refiling}
13598 lognoterefile @r{record a note when refiling}
13599 nologrefile @r{do not record when refiling}
13601 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13602 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13603 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
13604 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
13605 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
13606 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
13607 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
13608 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
13609 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
13610 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
13612 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
13613 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
13614 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
13615 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
13616 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
13617 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
13619 @vindex org-put-time-stamp-overlays
13620 @vindex org-time-stamp-overlay-formats
13621 To turn on custom format overlays over timestamps (variables
13622 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
13623 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
13624 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
13626 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
13628 @vindex constants-unit-system
13629 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
13630 @code{constants-unit-system}).
13631 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
13632 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
13634 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
13635 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
13637 @vindex org-footnote-define-inline
13638 @vindex org-footnote-auto-label
13639 @vindex org-footnote-auto-adjust
13640 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
13641 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline},
13642 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}, and @code{org-footnote-auto-adjust}.
13643 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
13644 @cindex @code{nofninline}, STARTUP keyword
13645 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
13646 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
13647 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
13648 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
13649 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
13650 @cindex @code{fnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
13651 @cindex @code{nofnadjust}, STARTUP keyword
13653 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
13654 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
13655 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
13656 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
13657 fnauto @r{create @code{[fn:1]}-like labels automatically (default)}
13658 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
13659 fnplain @r{create @code{[1]}-like labels automatically}
13660 fnadjust @r{automatically renumber and sort footnotes}
13661 nofnadjust @r{do not renumber and sort automatically}
13663 @cindex org-hide-block-startup
13664 To hide blocks on startup, use these keywords. The corresponding variable is
13665 @code{org-hide-block-startup}.
13666 @cindex @code{hideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
13667 @cindex @code{nohideblocks}, STARTUP keyword
13669 hideblocks @r{Hide all begin/end blocks on startup}
13670 nohideblocks @r{Do not hide blocks on startup}
13672 @cindex org-pretty-entities
13673 The display of entities as UTF-8 characters is governed by the variable
13674 @code{org-pretty-entities} and the keywords
13675 @cindex @code{entitiespretty}, STARTUP keyword
13676 @cindex @code{entitiesplain}, STARTUP keyword
13678 entitiespretty @r{Show entities as UTF-8 characters where possible}
13679 entitiesplain @r{Leave entities plain}
13681 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
13682 @vindex org-tag-alist
13683 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
13684 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
13685 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
13687 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
13688 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+DATE:,
13689 @itemx #+OPTIONS:, #+BIND:, #+XSLT:,
13690 @itemx #+DESCRIPTION:, #+KEYWORDS:,
13691 @itemx #+LATEX_HEADER:, #+STYLE:, #+LINK_UP:, #+LINK_HOME:,
13692 @itemx #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:, #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
13693 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
13694 @ref{Export options}.
13695 @item #+TODO: #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
13696 @vindex org-todo-keywords
13697 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
13698 current file. The corresponding variable is @code{org-todo-keywords}.
13701 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
13702 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
13704 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
13706 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
13707 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
13708 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
13709 other circumstances it means something like @emph{``Hey Org, look
13710 here and update according to what you see here''}. Here is a summary of
13711 what this means in different contexts.
13715 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
13716 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
13718 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
13719 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
13722 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
13723 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
13725 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
13728 If the current buffer is a capture buffer, close the note and file it.
13729 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
13732 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
13733 corresponding links in this buffer.
13735 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
13736 drawer, offer property commands.
13738 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
13739 definition, and vice versa.
13741 If the cursor is on a statistics cookie, update it.
13743 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
13746 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
13749 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamic block, the
13753 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
13754 @section A cleaner outline view
13755 @cindex hiding leading stars
13756 @cindex dynamic indentation
13757 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
13758 @cindex clean outline view
13760 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines start with a
13761 potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines is not
13762 indented. While this is no problem when writing a @emph{book-like} document
13763 where the outline headings are really section headings, in a more
13764 @emph{list-oriented} outline, indented structure is a lot cleaner:
13768 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
13769 ** Second level | * Second level
13770 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13771 some text | some text
13772 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
13773 more text | more text
13774 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
13780 If you are using at least Emacs 23.2@footnote{Emacs 23.1 can actually crash
13781 with @code{org-indent-mode}} and version 6.29 of Org, this kind of view can
13782 be achieved dynamically at display time using @code{org-indent-mode}. In
13783 this minor mode, all lines are prefixed for display with the necessary amount
13784 of space@footnote{@code{org-indent-mode} also sets the @code{wrap-prefix}
13785 property, such that @code{visual-line-mode} (or purely setting
13786 @code{word-wrap}) wraps long lines (including headlines) correctly indented.
13787 }. Also headlines are prefixed with additional stars, so that the amount of
13788 indentation shifts by two@footnote{See the variable
13789 @code{org-indent-indentation-per-level}.} spaces per level. All headline
13790 stars but the last one are made invisible using the @code{org-hide}
13791 face@footnote{Turning on @code{org-indent-mode} sets
13792 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} to @code{t} and @code{org-adapt-indentation} to
13793 @code{nil}.} - see below under @samp{2.} for more information on how this
13794 works. You can turn on @code{org-indent-mode} for all files by customizing
13795 the variable @code{org-startup-indented}, or you can turn it on for
13796 individual files using
13802 If you want a similar effect in an earlier version of Emacs and/or Org, or if
13803 you want the indentation to be hard space characters so that the plain text
13804 file looks as similar as possible to the Emacs display, Org supports you in
13809 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
13810 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
13811 with the headline, like
13815 more text, now indented
13818 @vindex org-adapt-indentation
13819 Org supports this with paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure
13820 editing@footnote{See also the variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.},
13821 preserving or adapting the indentation as appropriate.
13824 @vindex org-hide-leading-stars
13825 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
13826 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
13827 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
13831 #+STARTUP: hidestars
13832 #+STARTUP: showstars
13835 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
13839 * Top level headline
13847 @vindex org-hide @r{(face)}
13848 The leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they are only
13849 fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the background color as
13850 font color. If you are not using either white or black background, you may
13851 have to customize this face to get the wanted effect. Another possibility is
13852 to set this font such that the extra stars are @i{almost} invisible, for
13853 example using the color @code{grey90} on a white background.
13856 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
13857 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
13858 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
13859 to the next@footnote{When you need to specify a level for a property search
13860 or refile targets, @samp{LEVEL=2} will correspond to 3 stars, etc@.}. In this
13861 way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of this section. In order
13862 to make the structure editing and export commands handle this convention
13863 correctly, configure the variable @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on
13864 a per-file basis with one of the following lines:
13871 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
13872 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
13873 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
13874 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
13877 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
13878 @section Using Org on a tty
13879 @cindex tty key bindings
13881 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default many of
13882 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
13883 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
13884 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
13885 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
13886 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
13887 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
13888 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
13889 customized workaround suits you better. For example, changing a timestamp
13890 is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
13891 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
13893 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.1 0.2
13894 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Speed key} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
13895 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C} @tab
13896 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
13897 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab @kbd{L} @tab
13898 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x r} @tab @kbd{r} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
13899 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab @kbd{R} @tab
13900 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
13901 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab @kbd{U} @tab
13902 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
13903 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab @kbd{D} @tab
13904 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13905 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{ } @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
13906 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13907 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13908 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13909 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13910 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13911 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13912 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab @kbd{ } @tab
13916 @node Interaction, org-crypt.el, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
13917 @section Interaction with other packages
13918 @cindex packages, interaction with other
13919 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
13920 with other code out there.
13923 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
13924 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
13927 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
13928 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
13931 @cindex @file{calc.el}
13932 @cindex Gillespie, Dave
13933 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
13934 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
13935 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
13936 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
13937 @code{calc-eval} which will have been autoloaded during setup if Calc has
13938 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
13939 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
13940 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
13941 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
13942 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
13943 @cindex @file{constants.el}
13944 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13945 @vindex org-table-formula-constants
13946 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
13947 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
13948 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
13949 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
13950 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
13951 @samp{Mega}, etc@. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
13952 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
13953 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
13954 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
13955 @file{constants.el}.
13956 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
13957 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
13958 @cindex Dominik, Carsten
13959 Org-mode can make use of the CDLa@TeX{} package to efficiently enter
13960 @LaTeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
13961 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
13962 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
13963 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org-mode
13964 supports Imenu---all you need to do to get the index is the following:
13966 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
13967 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
13969 @vindex org-imenu-depth
13970 By default the index is two levels deep---you can modify the depth using
13971 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
13972 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
13973 @cindex @file{remember.el}
13974 @cindex Wiegley, John
13975 Org used to use this package for capture, but no longer does.
13976 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
13977 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
13978 @cindex Ludlam, Eric M.
13979 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
13980 index items in files. Org-mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
13981 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows you to
13982 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
13983 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
13984 @cindex @file{table.el}
13985 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
13987 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
13988 @cindex @file{table.el}
13989 @cindex Ota, Takaaki
13991 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and row-spanning,
13992 and alignment can be created using the Emacs table package by Takaaki Ota
13993 (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table}, and also part of Emacs 22).
13994 Org-mode will recognize these tables and export them properly. Because of
13995 interference with other Org-mode functionality, you unfortunately cannot edit
13996 these tables directly in the buffer. Instead, you need to use the command
13997 @kbd{C-c '} to edit them, similar to source code snippets.
14000 @orgcmd{C-c ',org-edit-special}
14001 Edit a @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a table.el table.
14003 @orgcmd{C-c ~,org-table-create-with-table.el}
14004 Insert a @file{table.el} table. If there is already a table at point, this
14005 command converts it between the @file{table.el} format and the Org-mode
14006 format. See the documentation string of the command
14007 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
14010 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs since Emacs 22.
14011 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
14012 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
14013 @cindex Baur, Steven L.
14014 Org-mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
14015 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
14016 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
14019 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
14020 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org-mode
14024 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
14025 @vindex org-support-shift-select
14026 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
14027 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
14028 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
14029 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
14030 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
14031 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
14032 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
14033 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
14034 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
14035 cursor moves across a special context.
14037 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
14038 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
14039 @cindex Storm, Kim. F.
14040 @vindex org-replace-disputed-keys
14041 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
14042 (as well as @code{pc-select-mode} and @code{s-region-mode}) to select and extend the
14043 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
14044 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
14045 23, you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
14046 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
14047 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
14048 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
14049 buffer (but not during date selection).
14052 S-UP @result{} M-p S-DOWN @result{} M-n
14053 S-LEFT @result{} M-- S-RIGHT @result{} M-+
14054 C-S-LEFT @result{} M-S-- C-S-RIGHT @result{} M-S-+
14057 @vindex org-disputed-keys
14058 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
14059 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
14060 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
14062 @item @file{yasnippet.el}
14063 @cindex @file{yasnippet.el}
14064 The way Org mode binds the TAB key (binding to @code{[tab]} instead of
14065 @code{"\t"}) overrules YASnippet's access to this key. The following code
14066 fixed this problem:
14069 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
14071 (org-set-local 'yas/trigger-key [tab])
14072 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field-group)))
14075 The latest version of yasnippet doesn't play well with Org mode. If the
14076 above code does not fix the conflict, start by defining the following
14080 (defun yas/org-very-safe-expand ()
14081 (let ((yas/fallback-behavior 'return-nil)) (yas/expand)))
14084 Then, tell Org mode what to do with the new function:
14087 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
14089 (make-variable-buffer-local 'yas/trigger-key)
14090 (setq yas/trigger-key [tab])
14091 (add-to-list 'org-tab-first-hook 'yas/org-very-safe-expand)
14092 (define-key yas/keymap [tab] 'yas/next-field)))
14095 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
14096 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
14097 This package also uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
14098 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here. If you want make
14099 the windmove function active in locations where Org-mode does not have
14100 special functionality on @kbd{S-@key{cursor}}, add this to your
14104 ;; Make windmove work in org-mode:
14105 (add-hook 'org-shiftup-final-hook 'windmove-up)
14106 (add-hook 'org-shiftleft-final-hook 'windmove-left)
14107 (add-hook 'org-shiftdown-final-hook 'windmove-down)
14108 (add-hook 'org-shiftright-final-hook 'windmove-right)
14111 @item @file{viper.el} by Michael Kifer
14112 @cindex @file{viper.el}
14114 Viper uses @kbd{C-c /} and therefore makes this key not access the
14115 corresponding Org-mode command @code{org-sparse-tree}. You need to find
14116 another key for this command, or override the key in
14117 @code{viper-vi-global-user-map} with
14120 (define-key viper-vi-global-user-map "C-c /" 'org-sparse-tree)
14125 @node org-crypt.el, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
14126 @section org-crypt.el
14127 @cindex @file{org-crypt.el}
14128 @cindex @code{org-decrypt-entry}
14130 Org-crypt will encrypt the text of an entry, but not the headline, or
14131 properties. Org-crypt uses the Emacs EasyPG library to encrypt and decrypt
14134 Any text below a headline that has a @samp{:crypt:} tag will be automatically
14135 be encrypted when the file is saved. If you want to use a different tag just
14136 customize the @code{org-crypt-tag-matcher} setting.
14138 To use org-crypt it is suggested that you have the following in your
14142 (require 'org-crypt)
14143 (org-crypt-use-before-save-magic)
14144 (setq org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance (quote ("crypt")))
14146 (setq org-crypt-key nil)
14147 ;; GPG key to use for encryption
14148 ;; Either the Key ID or set to nil to use symmetric encryption.
14150 (setq auto-save-default nil)
14151 ;; Auto-saving does not cooperate with org-crypt.el: so you need
14152 ;; to turn it off if you plan to use org-crypt.el quite often.
14153 ;; Otherwise, you'll get an (annoying) message each time you
14156 ;; To turn it off only locally, you can insert this:
14158 ;; # -*- buffer-auto-save-file-name: nil; -*-
14161 Excluding the crypt tag from inheritance prevents already encrypted text
14162 being encrypted again.
14164 @node Hacking, MobileOrg, Miscellaneous, Top
14168 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
14172 * Hooks:: Who to reach into Org's internals
14173 * Add-on packages:: Available extensions
14174 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
14175 * Context-sensitive commands:: How to add functionality to such commands
14176 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for @LaTeX{} and other programs
14177 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
14178 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
14179 * Extracting agenda information:: Postprocessing of agenda information
14180 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
14181 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
14184 @node Hooks, Add-on packages, Hacking, Hacking
14188 Org has a large number of hook variables that can be used to add
14189 functionality. This appendix about hacking is going to illustrate the
14190 use of some of them. A complete list of all hooks with documentation is
14191 maintained by the Worg project and can be found at
14192 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-configs/org-hooks.php}.
14194 @node Add-on packages, Adding hyperlink types, Hooks, Hacking
14195 @section Add-on packages
14196 @cindex add-on packages
14198 A large number of add-on packages have been written by various authors.
14199 These packages are not part of Emacs, but they are distributed as contributed
14200 packages with the separate release available at the Org-mode home page at
14201 @uref{http://orgmode.org}. The list of contributed packages, along with
14202 documentation about each package, is maintained by the Worg project at
14203 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-contrib/}.
14207 @node Adding hyperlink types, Context-sensitive commands, Add-on packages, Hacking
14208 @section Adding hyperlink types
14209 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
14211 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
14212 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, Org
14213 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file,
14214 @file{org-man.el}, that will add support for creating links like
14215 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
14219 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
14223 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
14224 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
14226 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
14227 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
14229 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
14231 (defun org-man-open (path)
14232 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
14233 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
14234 (funcall org-man-command path))
14236 (defun org-man-store-link ()
14237 "Store a link to a manpage."
14238 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
14239 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
14240 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
14241 (link (concat "man:" page))
14242 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
14243 (org-store-link-props
14246 :description description))))
14248 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
14249 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
14250 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
14251 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
14252 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
14253 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
14257 ;;; org-man.el ends here
14261 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
14268 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
14271 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
14274 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
14275 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
14276 that will be called to follow such a link.
14278 @vindex org-store-link-functions
14279 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
14280 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
14281 buffer displaying a man page.
14284 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
14285 First there is a customization variable that determines which Emacs
14286 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
14287 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
14288 defined. It gets the link path as an argument---in this case the link
14289 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
14290 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
14292 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
14293 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, this function will be called to
14294 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
14295 create the link for this buffer type; we do this by checking the value
14296 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
14297 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
14298 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
14299 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
14300 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
14301 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
14302 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
14303 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
14305 When it makes sense for your new link type, you may also define a function
14306 @code{org-PREFIX-complete-link} that implements special (e.g.@: completion)
14307 support for inserting such a link with @kbd{C-c C-l}. Such a function should
14308 not accept any arguments, and return the full link with prefix.
14310 @node Context-sensitive commands, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
14311 @section Context-sensitive commands
14312 @cindex context-sensitive commands, hooks
14313 @cindex add-ons, context-sensitive commands
14314 @vindex org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook
14316 Org has several commands that act differently depending on context. The most
14317 important example it the @kbd{C-c C-c} (@pxref{The very busy C-c C-c key}).
14318 Also the @kbd{M-cursor} and @kbd{M-S-cursor} keys have this property.
14320 Add-ons can tap into this functionality by providing a function that detects
14321 special context for that add-on and executes functionality appropriate for
14322 the context. Here is an example from Dan Davison's @file{org-R.el} which
14323 allows you to evaluate commands based on the @file{R} programming language
14324 @footnote{@file{org-R.el} has been replaced by the org-mode functionality
14325 described in @ref{Working With Source Code} and is now obsolete.}. For this
14326 package, special contexts are lines that start with @code{#+R:} or
14330 (defun org-R-apply-maybe ()
14331 "Detect if this is context for org-R and execute R commands."
14332 (if (save-excursion
14333 (beginning-of-line 1)
14334 (looking-at "#\\+RR?:"))
14335 (progn (call-interactively 'org-R-apply)
14336 t) ;; to signal that we took action
14337 nil)) ;; to signal that we did not
14339 (add-hook 'org-ctrl-c-ctrl-c-hook 'org-R-apply-maybe)
14342 The function first checks if the cursor is in such a line. If that is the
14343 case, @code{org-R-apply} is called and the function returns @code{t} to
14344 signal that action was taken, and @kbd{C-c C-c} will stop looking for other
14345 contexts. If the function finds it should do nothing locally, it returns
14346 @code{nil} so that other, similar functions can have a try.
14349 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Context-sensitive commands, Hacking
14350 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
14351 @cindex tables, in other modes
14352 @cindex lists, in other modes
14353 @cindex Orgtbl mode
14355 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
14356 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
14357 specific languages, for example @LaTeX{}. However, this is extremely
14358 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
14359 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
14362 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
14363 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
14364 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
14365 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
14366 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
14367 for a very flexible system.
14369 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists, in Orgstruct mode. You
14370 can use Org's facilities to edit and structure lists by turning
14371 @code{orgstruct-mode} on, then locally exporting such lists in another format
14372 (HTML, @LaTeX{} or Texinfo.)
14376 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving radio tables
14377 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
14378 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
14379 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
14382 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
14383 @subsection Radio tables
14384 @cindex radio tables
14386 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
14387 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
14388 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
14389 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
14392 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
14393 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
14397 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
14398 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
14402 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
14406 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
14407 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
14408 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
14409 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
14410 passed as a property list to the translation function for
14411 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
14412 acted upon before the translation function is called:
14416 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
14419 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
14420 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
14421 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
14422 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
14423 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
14424 additional columns.
14428 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
14429 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
14430 compilation of a C file or processing of a @LaTeX{} file. There are a
14431 number of different solutions:
14435 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
14436 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
14437 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
14439 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
14440 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in @TeX{} and @samp{\end@{document@}}
14443 You can just comment the table line-by-line whenever you want to process
14444 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
14445 only sounds tedious---the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment}
14446 makes this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
14450 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
14451 @subsection A @LaTeX{} example of radio tables
14452 @cindex @LaTeX{}, and Orgtbl mode
14454 The best way to wrap the source table in @LaTeX{} is to use the
14455 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
14456 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
14457 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
14458 default this works only for @LaTeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
14459 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
14460 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
14461 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
14462 will then get the following template:
14464 @cindex #+ORGTBL, SEND
14466 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
14467 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
14469 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
14475 @vindex @LaTeX{}-verbatim-environments
14476 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
14477 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into @LaTeX{} and to put it
14478 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
14479 fill in the table---feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
14480 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
14481 this may cause problems with font-lock in @LaTeX{} mode. As shown in the
14482 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
14483 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
14484 expressions. If you are using AUC@TeX{} with the font-latex library, a
14485 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
14486 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
14489 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
14490 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
14492 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
14493 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
14494 |-------+------+---------+---------|
14495 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
14496 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
14497 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
14498 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
14499 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
14504 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
14505 table inserted between the two marker lines.
14507 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
14508 want to control how columns are aligned, etc@. In this case we make sure
14509 that the table translator skips the first 2 lines of the source
14510 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e.@: to not produce
14511 header and footer commands of the target table:
14514 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
14515 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
14516 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
14517 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
14521 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
14522 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
14523 |-------+------+---------+---------|
14524 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
14525 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
14526 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
14527 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
14531 The @LaTeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
14532 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
14533 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
14534 interprets the following parameters (see also @pxref{Translator functions}):
14537 @item :splice nil/t
14538 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
14539 tabular environment. Default is nil.
14542 A format to be used to wrap each field, it should contain @code{%s} for the
14543 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
14544 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
14545 column numbers and formats, for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
14546 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
14547 function must return a formatted string.
14550 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
14551 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
14552 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
14553 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
14554 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
14555 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
14556 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
14557 supplied instead of strings.
14560 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
14561 @subsection Translator functions
14562 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
14563 @cindex translator function
14565 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
14566 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
14567 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
14568 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
14569 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
14570 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
14571 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
14572 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
14573 hands processing over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
14577 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
14578 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
14579 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
14580 org-table-last-alignment ""))
14583 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
14584 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
14585 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
14586 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
14587 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
14591 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
14592 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
14593 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e.@: the
14594 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
14595 would like to use the @LaTeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
14596 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
14597 overrule the default with
14600 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
14603 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
14604 analogy with the @LaTeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
14605 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
14606 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
14607 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!}, and where the field
14608 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
14612 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
14613 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
14617 Please check the documentation string of the function
14618 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
14619 that function, and remember that you can pass each of them into
14620 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
14621 using the generic function.
14623 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
14624 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
14625 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
14626 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
14627 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
14628 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
14629 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
14630 translator, please post it on @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
14631 others can benefit from your work.
14633 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
14634 @subsection Radio lists
14635 @cindex radio lists
14636 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
14638 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way as sending and
14639 receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}). As for radio tables, you can
14640 insert radio list templates in HTML, @LaTeX{} and Texinfo modes by calling
14641 @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
14643 Here are the differences with radio tables:
14647 Orgstruct mode must be active.
14649 Use the @code{ORGLST} keyword instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
14651 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
14654 @kbd{C-c C-c} will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
14657 Here is a @LaTeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
14662 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
14663 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
14665 #+ORGLST: SEND to-buy org-list-to-latex
14674 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
14675 @LaTeX{} list between the two marker lines.
14677 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
14678 @section Dynamic blocks
14679 @cindex dynamic blocks
14681 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
14682 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
14683 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
14684 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
14686 Dynamic blocks are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
14687 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
14688 the content of the block.
14690 @cindex #+BEGIN:dynamic block
14692 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
14697 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
14700 @orgcmd{C-c C-x C-u,org-dblock-update}
14701 Update dynamic block at point.
14702 @orgkey{C-u C-c C-x C-u}
14703 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
14706 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
14707 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
14708 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
14709 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
14710 extra parameter @code{:content}.
14712 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
14713 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
14714 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
14715 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
14719 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
14725 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
14728 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
14729 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
14730 (insert "Last block update at: "
14731 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
14734 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
14735 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
14736 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
14737 written in a way such that it does nothing in buffers that are not in
14740 You can narrow the current buffer to the current dynamic block (like any
14741 other block) with @code{org-narrow-to-block}.
14743 @node Special agenda views, Extracting agenda information, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
14744 @section Special agenda views
14745 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
14747 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14748 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function-global
14749 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the selection
14750 made by these agenda views: @code{agenda}, @code{todo}, @code{alltodo},
14751 @code{tags}, @code{tags-todo}, @code{tags-tree}. You may specify a function
14752 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part of
14753 the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped. You can specify a
14754 global condition that will be applied to all agenda views, this condition
14755 would be stored in the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-function-global}. More
14756 commonly, such a definition is applied only to specific custom searches,
14757 using @code{org-agenda-skip-function}.
14759 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
14760 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
14761 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
14762 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
14763 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
14764 the subtree belonging to the project line.
14766 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
14767 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
14768 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
14769 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
14770 search should continue from there.
14773 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
14774 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
14775 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
14776 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
14777 nil ; tag found, do not skip
14778 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
14781 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
14785 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14786 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14787 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
14788 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14791 @vindex org-agenda-overriding-header
14792 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
14793 meaningful header in the agenda view.
14795 @vindex org-odd-levels-only
14796 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
14797 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
14798 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
14799 your custom search function, simply do a search for
14800 @samp{LEVEL>0}@footnote{Note that, when using @code{org-odd-levels-only}, a
14801 level number corresponds to order in the hierarchy, not to the number of
14802 stars.}, and then use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries
14803 you really want to have.
14805 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
14806 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
14807 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
14810 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
14811 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
14812 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
14813 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
14814 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
14815 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
14816 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
14817 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
14818 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo '("TODO" "WAITING"))
14819 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword is TODO or WAITING.
14820 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'todo 'done)
14821 Skip current entry if the TODO keyword marks a DONE state.
14822 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'timestamp)
14823 Skip current entry if it has any timestamp, may also be deadline or scheduled.
14824 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
14825 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
14826 @item (org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
14827 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
14828 @item (org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
14829 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
14832 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
14833 like this, even without defining a special function:
14836 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
14837 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
14838 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
14839 'regexp ":waiting:"))
14840 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
14843 @node Extracting agenda information, Using the property API, Special agenda views, Hacking
14844 @section Extracting agenda information
14845 @cindex agenda, pipe
14846 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
14848 @vindex org-agenda-custom-commands
14849 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
14850 line in Emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
14851 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
14852 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
14853 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
14854 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
14855 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
14856 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
14857 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
14858 current TODO list, you could use
14861 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
14864 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
14865 tags/TODO match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
14866 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
14867 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
14870 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14871 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
14875 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
14878 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
14879 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
14880 org-agenda-span month \
14881 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
14882 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
14887 which will produce a 30-day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
14888 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
14890 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
14891 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
14892 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
14893 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
14897 category @r{The category of the item}
14898 head @r{The headline, without TODO keyword, TAGS and PRIORITY}
14899 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
14900 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
14901 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
14902 diary @r{imported from diary}
14903 deadline @r{a deadline}
14904 scheduled @r{scheduled}
14905 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
14906 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
14907 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
14908 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
14909 block @r{entry has date block including date}
14910 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
14911 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
14912 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
14913 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
14914 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
14915 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
14916 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
14920 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
14921 led to the selection of the item.
14923 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post-processing script.
14924 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
14925 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
14930 # define the Emacs command to run
14931 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
14933 # run it and capture the output
14934 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
14936 # loop over all lines
14937 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
14938 # get the individual values
14939 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
14940 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
14941 # process and print
14942 print "[ ] $head\n";
14946 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Extracting agenda information, Hacking
14947 @section Using the property API
14948 @cindex API, for properties
14949 @cindex properties, API
14951 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
14954 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
14955 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.@*
14956 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
14957 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
14958 entry. The return value is an alist. Keys may occur multiple times
14959 if the property key was used several times.@*
14960 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
14961 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
14962 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
14964 @vindex org-use-property-inheritance
14965 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
14966 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
14967 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
14968 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
14969 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
14970 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
14971 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
14974 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
14975 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
14978 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
14979 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
14982 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
14983 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
14986 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
14987 Insert a property drawer at point.
14990 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
14991 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
14992 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
14995 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
14996 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
14997 values and return the values as a list of strings.
15000 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
15001 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
15002 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
15005 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
15006 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
15007 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
15010 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
15011 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
15012 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
15015 @defopt org-property-allowed-value-functions
15016 Hook for functions supplying allowed values for a specific property.
15017 The functions must take a single argument, the name of the property, and
15018 return a flat list of allowed values. If @samp{:ETC} is one of
15019 the values, use the values as completion help, but allow also other values
15020 to be entered. The functions must return @code{nil} if they are not
15021 responsible for this property.
15024 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
15025 @section Using the mapping API
15026 @cindex API, for mapping
15027 @cindex mapping entries, API
15029 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
15030 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
15031 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
15032 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
15035 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
15036 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
15038 FUNC is a function or a Lisp form. The function will be called without
15039 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
15040 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
15041 returned as a list.
15043 The call to FUNC will be wrapped into a save-excursion form, so FUNC
15044 does not need to preserve point. After evaluation, the cursor will be
15045 moved to the end of the line (presumably of the headline of the
15046 processed entry) and search continues from there. Under some
15047 circumstances, this may not produce the wanted results. For example,
15048 if you have removed (e.g.@: archived) the current (sub)tree it could
15049 mean that the next entry will be skipped entirely. In such cases, you
15050 can specify the position from where search should continue by making
15051 FUNC set the variable `org-map-continue-from' to the desired buffer
15054 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
15055 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
15056 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
15057 visited by the iteration.
15059 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
15062 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
15063 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
15064 region @r{The entries within the active region, if any}
15065 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
15067 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
15068 agenda @r{all agenda files}
15069 agenda-with-archives
15070 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
15072 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
15075 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
15076 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
15078 @vindex org-agenda-skip-function
15080 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
15081 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
15082 function or Lisp form
15083 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
15084 @r{so whenever the function returns t, FUNC}
15085 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
15086 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
15090 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
15091 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
15092 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
15093 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
15095 @defun org-todo &optional arg
15096 Change the TODO state of the entry. See the docstring of the functions for
15097 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
15100 @defun org-priority &optional action
15101 Change the priority of the entry. See the docstring of this function for the
15102 possible values for ACTION.
15105 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
15106 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
15107 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
15111 Promote the current entry.
15115 Demote the current entry.
15118 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
15119 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
15120 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
15124 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
15125 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
15128 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
15129 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
15132 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
15135 @node MobileOrg, History and Acknowledgments, Hacking, Top
15136 @appendix MobileOrg
15140 @uref{http://mobileorg.ncogni.to/, MobileOrg} is an application for the
15141 @i{iPhone/iPod Touch} series of devices, developed by Richard Moreland.
15142 @i{MobileOrg} offers offline viewing and capture support for an Org-mode
15143 system rooted on a ``real'' computer. It does also allow you to record
15144 changes to existing entries. Android users should check out
15145 @uref{http://wiki.github.com/matburt/mobileorg-android/, MobileOrg Android}
15148 This appendix describes the support Org has for creating agenda views in a
15149 format that can be displayed by @i{MobileOrg}, and for integrating notes
15150 captured and changes made by @i{MobileOrg} into the main system.
15152 For changing tags and TODO states in MobileOrg, you should have set up the
15153 customization variables @code{org-todo-keywords} and @code{org-tags-alist} to
15154 cover all important tags and TODO keywords, even if individual files use only
15155 part of these. MobileOrg will also offer you states and tags set up with
15156 in-buffer settings, but it will understand the logistics of TODO state
15157 @i{sets} (@pxref{Per-file keywords}) and @i{mutually exclusive} tags
15158 (@pxref{Setting tags}) only for those set in these variables.
15161 * Setting up the staging area:: Where to interact with the mobile device
15162 * Pushing to MobileOrg:: Uploading Org files and agendas
15163 * Pulling from MobileOrg:: Integrating captured and flagged items
15166 @node Setting up the staging area, Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg, MobileOrg
15167 @section Setting up the staging area
15169 MobileOrg needs to interact with Emacs through a directory on a server. If you
15170 are using a public server, you should consider to encrypt the files that are
15171 uploaded to the server. This can be done with Org-mode 7.02 and with
15172 @i{MobileOrg 1.5} (iPhone version), and you need an @file{openssl}
15173 installation on your system. To turn on encryption, set a password in
15174 @i{MobileOrg} and, on the Emacs side, configure the variable
15175 @code{org-mobile-use-encryption}@footnote{If you can safely store the
15176 password in your Emacs setup, you might also want to configure
15177 @code{org-mobile-encryption-password}. Please read the docstring of that
15178 variable. Note that encryption will apply only to the contents of the
15179 @file{.org} files. The file names themselves will remain visible.}.
15181 The easiest way to create that directory is to use a free
15182 @uref{http://dropbox.com,Dropbox.com} account@footnote{If you cannot use
15183 Dropbox, or if your version of MobileOrg does not support it, you can use a
15184 webdav server. For more information, check out the documentation of MobileOrg and also this
15185 @uref{http://orgmode.org/worg/org-faq.html#mobileorg_webdav, FAQ entry}.}.
15186 When MobileOrg first connects to your Dropbox, it will create a directory
15187 @i{MobileOrg} inside the Dropbox. After the directory has been created, tell
15191 (setq org-mobile-directory "~/Dropbox/MobileOrg")
15194 Org-mode has commands to put files for @i{MobileOrg} into that directory,
15195 and to read captured notes from there.
15197 @node Pushing to MobileOrg, Pulling from MobileOrg, Setting up the staging area, MobileOrg
15198 @section Pushing to MobileOrg
15200 This operation copies all files currently listed in @code{org-mobile-files}
15201 to the directory @code{org-mobile-directory}. By default this list contains
15202 all agenda files (as listed in @code{org-agenda-files}), but additional files
15203 can be included by customizing @code{org-mobile-files}. File names will be
15204 staged with paths relative to @code{org-directory}, so all files should be
15205 inside this directory. The push operation also creates a special Org file
15206 @file{agendas.org} with all custom agenda view defined by the
15207 user@footnote{While creating the agendas, Org-mode will force ID properties
15208 on all referenced entries, so that these entries can be uniquely identified
15209 if @i{MobileOrg} flags them for further action. If you do not want to get
15210 these properties in so many entries, you can set the variable
15211 @code{org-mobile-force-id-on-agenda-items} to @code{nil}. Org mode will then
15212 rely on outline paths, in the hope that these will be unique enough.}.
15213 Finally, Org writes the file @file{index.org}, containing links to all other
15214 files. @i{MobileOrg} first reads this file from the server, and then
15215 downloads all agendas and Org files listed in it. To speed up the download,
15216 MobileOrg will only read files whose checksums@footnote{stored automatically
15217 in the file @file{checksums.dat}} have changed.
15219 @node Pulling from MobileOrg, , Pushing to MobileOrg, MobileOrg
15220 @section Pulling from MobileOrg
15222 When @i{MobileOrg} synchronizes with the server, it not only pulls the Org
15223 files for viewing. It also appends captured entries and pointers to flagged
15224 and changed entries to the file @file{mobileorg.org} on the server. Org has
15225 a @emph{pull} operation that integrates this information into an inbox file
15226 and operates on the pointers to flagged entries. Here is how it works:
15230 Org moves all entries found in
15231 @file{mobileorg.org}@footnote{@file{mobileorg.org} will be empty after this
15232 operation.} and appends them to the file pointed to by the variable
15233 @code{org-mobile-inbox-for-pull}. Each captured entry and each editing event
15234 will be a top-level entry in the inbox file.
15236 After moving the entries, Org will attempt to implement the changes made in
15237 @i{MobileOrg}. Some changes are applied directly and without user
15238 interaction. Examples are all changes to tags, TODO state, headline and body
15239 text that can be cleanly applied. Entries that have been flagged for further
15240 action will receive a tag @code{:FLAGGED:}, so that they can be easily found
15241 again. When there is a problem finding an entry or applying the change, the
15242 pointer entry will remain in the inbox and will be marked with an error
15243 message. You need to later resolve these issues by hand.
15245 Org will then generate an agenda view with all flagged entries. The user
15246 should then go through these entries and do whatever actions are necessary.
15247 If a note has been stored while flagging an entry in @i{MobileOrg}, that note
15248 will be displayed in the echo area when the cursor is on the corresponding
15253 Pressing @kbd{?} in that special agenda will display the full flagging note in
15254 another window and also push it onto the kill ring. So you could use @kbd{?
15255 z C-y C-c C-c} to store that flagging note as a normal note in the entry.
15256 Pressing @kbd{?} twice in succession will offer to remove the
15257 @code{:FLAGGED:} tag along with the recorded flagging note (which is stored
15258 in a property). In this way you indicate that the intended processing for
15259 this flagged entry is finished.
15264 If you are not able to process all flagged entries directly, you can always
15265 return to this agenda view@footnote{Note, however, that there is a subtle
15266 difference. The view created automatically by @kbd{M-x org-mobile-pull
15267 @key{RET}} is guaranteed to search all files that have been addressed by the
15268 last pull. This might include a file that is not currently in your list of
15269 agenda files. If you later use @kbd{C-c a ?} to regenerate the view, only
15270 the current agenda files will be searched.} using @kbd{C-c a ?}.
15272 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, MobileOrg, Top
15273 @appendix History and acknowledgments
15274 @cindex acknowledgments
15278 Org was born in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface of the Emacs
15279 Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and projects, and using
15280 Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However, having to remember eleven
15281 different commands with two or three keys per command, only to hide and show
15282 parts of the outline tree, that seemed entirely unacceptable to me. Also,
15283 when using outlines to take notes, I constantly wanted to restructure the
15284 tree, organizing it parallel to my thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility
15285 cycling} and @emph{structure editing} were originally implemented in the
15286 package @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
15287 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project planning,
15288 the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{timestamps}, and
15289 @emph{table support}. These areas highlighted the two main goals that Org
15290 still has today: to be a new, outline-based, plain text mode with innovative
15291 and intuitive editing features, and to incorporate project planning
15292 functionality directly into a notes file.
15294 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or to
15295 @email{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
15296 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
15297 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
15298 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
15299 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
15300 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
15303 Before I get to this list, a few special mentions are in order:
15306 @item Bastien Guerry
15307 Bastien has written a large number of extensions to Org (most of them
15308 integrated into the core by now), including the LaTeX exporter and the plain
15309 list parser. His support during the early days, when he basically acted as
15310 co-maintainer, was central to the success of this project. Bastien also
15311 invented Worg, helped establishing the Web presence of Org, and sponsors
15312 hosting costs for the orgmode.org website.
15313 @item Eric Schulte and Dan Davison
15314 Eric and Dan are jointly responsible for the Org-babel system, which turns
15315 Org into a multi-language environment for evaluating code and doing literate
15316 programming and reproducible research.
15318 John has contributed a number of great ideas and patches directly to Org,
15319 including the attachment system (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with
15320 Apple Mail (@file{org-mac-message.el}), hierarchical dependencies of TODO
15321 items, habit tracking (@file{org-habits.el}), and encryption
15322 (@file{org-crypt.el}). Also, the capture system is really an extended copy
15323 of his great @file{remember.el}.
15324 @item Sebastian Rose
15325 Without Sebastian, the HTML/XHTML publishing of Org would be the pitiful work
15326 of an ignorant amateur. Sebastian has pushed this part of Org onto a much
15327 higher level. He also wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
15328 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like or a folding interface with
15329 single-key navigation.
15332 @noindent OK, now to the full list of contributions! Again, please let me
15333 know what I am missing here!
15338 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
15340 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
15342 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
15345 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding timestamps.
15347 @i{Jan Böcker} wrote @file{org-docview.el}.
15349 @i{Brad Bozarth} showed how to pull RSS feed data into Org-mode files.
15351 @i{Tom Breton} wrote @file{org-choose.el}.
15353 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
15354 for Remember, which are now templates for capture.
15356 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
15359 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for Lisp forms into table
15360 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
15361 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
15363 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested copying some linking code from Planner.
15365 @i{Baoqiu Cui} contributed the DocBook exporter.
15367 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
15368 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
15371 @i{Nick Dokos} tracked down several nasty bugs.
15373 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
15374 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
15375 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
15377 @i{Thomas S. Dye} contributed documentation on Worg and helped integrating
15378 the Org-Babel documentation into the manual.
15380 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format, inspired
15381 the agenda, patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and wrote
15382 @file{org-taskjuggler.el}.
15384 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
15387 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
15389 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
15391 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
15392 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
15394 @i{Raimar Finken} wrote @file{org-git-line.el}.
15396 @i{Mikael Fornius} works as a mailing list moderator.
15398 @i{Austin Frank} works as a mailing list moderator.
15400 @i{Eric Fraga} drove the development of BEAMER export with ideas and
15403 @i{Barry Gidden} did proofreading the manual in preparation for the book
15404 publication through Network Theory Ltd.
15406 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
15408 @i{Nicolas Goaziou} rewrote much of the plain list code.
15410 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
15412 @i{Brian Gough} of Network Theory Ltd publishes the Org mode manual as a
15415 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
15416 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
15417 been critical when we started to adopt the Git version control system.
15419 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixes and
15422 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
15424 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
15425 folded entries, and column view for properties.
15427 @i{Matt Jones} wrote @i{MobileOrg Android}.
15429 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
15431 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded @LaTeX{} and tested it. He also
15432 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
15434 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
15435 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
15437 @i{David Maus} wrote @file{org-atom.el}, maintains the issues file for Org,
15438 and is a prolific contributor on the mailing list with competent replies,
15439 small fixes and patches.
15441 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
15443 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
15445 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
15448 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
15451 @i{Richard Moreland} wrote @i{MobileOrg} for the iPhone.
15453 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed allowing multiple TODO sequences in a file
15454 and being able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
15456 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and Elisp forms.
15458 @i{Greg Newman} refreshed the unicorn logo into its current form.
15460 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
15461 file links, and TAGS.
15463 @i{Osamu Okano} wrote @file{orgcard2ref.pl}, a Perl program to create a text
15464 version of the reference card.
15466 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
15469 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
15471 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
15472 links, among other things.
15474 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
15475 provided frequent feedback.
15477 @i{Martin Pohlack} provided the code snippet to bundle character insertion
15478 into bundles of 20 for undo.
15480 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
15482 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
15485 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes. He
15486 also acted as mailing list moderator for some time.
15488 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
15490 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
15491 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
15493 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for Orgtbl tables with
15496 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
15497 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
15499 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
15502 @i{Paul Sexton} wrote @file{org-ctags.el}.
15504 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
15505 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
15507 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
15508 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
15510 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
15511 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
15513 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
15516 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
15518 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
15519 tweaks and features.
15521 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
15522 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
15524 @i{Ulf Stegemann} created the table to translate special symbols to HTML,
15525 LaTeX, UTF-8, Latin-1 and ASCII.
15527 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
15528 with links transformation to Org syntax.
15530 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
15531 chapter about publishing.
15533 @i{Jambunathan K} contributed the OpenDocumentText exporter.
15535 @i{Sebastien Vauban} reported many issues with LaTeX and BEAMER export and
15536 enabled source code highlighling in Gnus.
15538 @i{Stefan Vollmar} organized a video-recorded talk at the
15539 Max-Planck-Institute for Neurology. He also inspired the creation of a
15540 concept index for HTML export.
15542 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
15545 @i{Samuel Wales} has provided important feedback and bug reports.
15547 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
15550 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
15553 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
15556 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
15559 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
15560 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
15565 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
15566 @unnumbered Concept index
15570 @node Key Index, Command and Function Index, Main Index, Top
15571 @unnumbered Key index
15575 @node Command and Function Index, Variable Index, Key Index, Top
15576 @unnumbered Command and function index
15580 @node Variable Index, , Command and Function Index, Top
15581 @unnumbered Variable index
15583 This is not a complete index of variables and faces, only the ones that are
15584 mentioned in the manual. For a more complete list, use @kbd{M-x
15585 org-customize @key{RET}} and then click yourself through the tree.
15591 @c Local variables:
15593 @c indent-tabs-mode: nil
15594 @c paragraph-start: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|\f\\|[ ]*$"
15595 @c paragraph-separate: "
\b\\|^@[a-zA-Z]*[ \n]\\|^@x?org\\(key\\|cmd\\)\\|[ \f]*$"
15599 @c LocalWords: webdavhost pre